Annual Statements Open main menu

CAPITAL CITY BANK GROUP INC - Annual Report: 2020 (Form 10-K)

ccbg20201231
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON,
 
DC
 
20549
 
___________________________________
 
FORM
10-K
 
 
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended
December 31, 2020
OR
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period from ____________ to ____________
 
Capital City Bank Group, Inc.
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
 
Florida
0-13358
59-2273542
(State of Incorporation)
(Commission File Number)
(IRS Employer Identification No.)
217 North Monroe Street
,
Tallahassee
,
Florida
32301
(Address of principal executive offices)
(Zip Code)
(
850
)
402-7821
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
 
 
Title of Each Class
 
Trading Symbol(s)
 
Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered
Common Stock, $0.01 par value
 
CCBG
 
The
Nasdaq Stock Market
 
LLC
 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
 
None
 
Indicate
 
by check
 
mark if
 
the registrant
 
is a well-known
 
seasoned
 
issuer,
 
as defined
 
in Rule
 
405 of
 
the Securities
 
Act. Yes
No
 
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act. Yes
No
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to
such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes
 
No
 
 
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any,
 
every Interactive Data File
required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such
shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes
 
No
 
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer,
 
a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company,
or an emerging growth company.
 
See definition of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting
 
company,” and “emerging
growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act
Large accelerated filer
 
Accelerated filer
 
Non-accelerated filer
 
Smaller reporting company
 
Emerging growth company
 
 
If an emerging
 
growth company, indicate
 
by check mark
 
if the registrant has
 
elected not to use
 
the extended transition period
 
for complying with
any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.
 
 
 
Indicate
 
by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its
internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting
firm that prepared or issued its audit report.
 
 
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2
 
of the Exchange Act). Yes
No
 
 
The aggregate market value of the registrant’s common stock, $0.01 par value per share, held by non-affiliates of the registrant on June 30, 2020,
the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter,
 
was approximately $
277,245,803
 
(based on the closing sales
price of the registrant’s common stock on that date). Shares of the registrant’s
 
common stock held by each officer and director and each person
known to the registrant to own 10% or more of the outstanding voting power of the registrant have been excluded in that such
 
persons may be
deemed to be affiliates. This determination of affiliate status is not a determination for other purposes.
 
 
Indicate the number of shares outstanding of each of the issuer’s classes of common stock, as of the latest practicable date.
 
 
Class
Outstanding at February 25, 2021
Common Stock, $0.01 par value per share
16,840,267
 
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
 
Portions of our Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Shareowners to be held on April 27, 2021, are incorporated by reference in Part III.
 
3
INTRODUCTORY NOTE
 
This Annual Report on Form 10-K contains “forward-looking
 
statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation
Reform Act of 1995. These forward-looking statements include,
 
among others, statements about our beliefs, plans, objectives,
goals,
 
expectations, estimates and intentions that are subject to significant
 
risks and uncertainties and are subject to change based
on various factors, many of which are beyond our control.
 
The words “may,”
 
“could,” “should,” “would,” “believe,”
“anticipate,”
 
“estimate,” “expect,” “intend,” “plan,” “target,” “vision,”
 
“goal,” and similar expressions are intended to identify
forward-looking statements.
 
All forward-looking statements, by their nature, are subject
 
to risks and uncertainties.
 
Our actual future results may differ
materially
 
from those set forth in our forward-looking statements.
 
In addition to those risks discussed in this Annual Report
 
under Item 1A Risk Factors, factors that could cause our actual results
to differ materially from those in the forward
 
-looking statements, include, without limitation:
 
 
the magnitude and duration of the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic
 
and its impact on the global and local economies and
financial market conditions and our business, results of operations
 
and financial condition, including the impact of our
participation in government programs related to COVID-19;
 
our ability to successfully manage credit risk, interest rate risk,
 
liquidity risk, and other risks inherent to our industry;
 
legislative or regulatory changes;
 
changes in monetary and fiscal policies of the U.S. Government
 
;
 
inflation, interest rate, market and monetary fluctuations;
 
the effects of security breaches and com
 
puter viruses that may affect our computer systems or
 
fraud related to debit card
products;
 
the accuracy of our financial statement estimates and assumptions,
 
including the estimates used for our loan loss reserve,
deferred tax asset valuation and pension plan;
 
changes in accounting principles, policies, practices or
 
guidelines;
 
the frequency and magnitude of foreclosure of our loans;
 
the effects of our lack of a diversified loan portfolio,
 
including the risks of geographic and industry concentrations;
 
the strength of the United States economy in general and the strength
 
of the local economies in which we conduct
operations;
 
 
our ability to declare and pay dividends, the payment of which
 
is subject to our capital requirements;
 
changes in the securities and real estate markets;
 
structural changes in the markets for origination, sale and servicing
 
of residential mortgages;
 
uncertainty in the pricing of residential mortgage loans that
 
we sell, as well as competition for the mortgage servicing
rights related to these loans and related interest rate risk
 
or price risk resulting from retaining mortgage servicing
 
rights
and the potential effects of higher interest rates
 
on our loan origination volumes
 
the effect of corporate restructuring, acquisitions
 
or dispositions, including the actual restructuring and
 
other related
charges and the failure to achieve the expected
 
gains, revenue growth or expense savings from such corporate
restructuring, acquisitions or dispositions;
 
the effects of natural disasters, harsh weather
 
conditions (including hurricanes), widespread health emergencies,
 
military
conflict, terrorism, civil unrest or other geopolitical events;
 
our ability to comply with the extensive laws and regulations
 
to which we are subject, including the laws for each
jurisdiction where we operate;
 
the willingness of clients to accept third-party products and
 
services rather than our products and services and vice versa;
 
increased competition and its effect on pricing;
 
technological changes;
 
negative publicity and the impact on our reputation;
 
changes in consumer spending and saving habits;
 
growth and profitability of our noninterest income;
 
the limited trading activity of our common stock;
 
the concentration of ownership of our common stock;
 
anti-takeover provisions under federal and state law as well as our
 
Articles of Incorporation and our Bylaws;
 
other risks described from time to time in our filings with
 
the Securities and Exchange Commission; and
 
our ability to manage the risks involved in the foregoing.
 
However, other factors besides those
 
listed in
Item 1A Risk Factors
 
or discussed in this Annual Report also could adversely affect
our results, and you should not consider any such
 
list of factors to be a complete set of all potential risks or
 
uncertainties.
 
Any
forward-looking statements made by us or on our behalf
 
speak only as of the date they are made.
 
We do not undertake
 
to update
any forward-looking statement, except as required by applicable
 
law.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4
PART
 
I
 
Item 1.
 
Business
 
About Us
 
General
 
Capital City Bank Group, Inc. (“CCBG”) is a financial
 
holding company headquartered in Tallahassee,
 
Florida. CCBG was
incorporated under Florida law on December 13, 1982,
 
to acquire five national banks and one state bank that all subsequently
became part of CCBG’s bank
 
subsidiary, Capital City
 
Bank (“CCB” or the “Bank”). The Bank commenced
 
operations in 1895. In
this report, the terms “Company,”
 
“we,” “us,” or “our” mean CCBG and all subsidiaries included
 
in our consolidated financial
statements.
We provide
 
traditional deposit and credit services, mortgage banking, asset management,
 
trust, merchant services, bank cards,
data processing, and securities brokerage services through
 
57 banking offices in Florida, Georgia, and
 
Alabama operated by CCB.
 
Through Capital City Home Loans, LLC, a Georgia
 
limited liability company (“CCHL”), we have 29 additional offices
 
for our
mortgage banking business in the Southeast.
 
The majority of the revenue from Core CCBG (excludes CCHL),
 
approximately
88%, is derived from our Florida market areas while approximately
 
11%
 
and 1% of the revenue is derived from our Georgia
 
and
other market areas, respectively.
 
Approximately 61% of the revenue from CCHL is derived from
 
our Georgia market areas while
approximately 32% and 7% is derived from our Florida
 
and other market areas, respectively.
Below is a summary of our financial condition and results of operations
 
for the past three years, which we believe is a sufficient
period for understanding our general business development.
 
Our financial condition and results of operations are more
 
fully
discussed in our Management’s
 
Discussion and Analysis on page 33 and our consolidated
 
financial statements on page 67.
 
Dollars in millions
Year
 
Ended
December 31,
 
Assets
Deposits
Shareowners’
Equity
Revenue
(1)
Net Income
2020
$3,798.1
 
$3,217.6
 
$320.8
 
$217.4
 
$31.6
 
2019
$3,089.0
 
$2,645.5
 
$327.0
 
$165.9
 
$30.8
 
2018
$2,959.2
 
$2,531.9
 
$302.6
 
$151.0
 
$26.2
 
(1)
Revenue represents interest income plus noninterest income
 
Dividends and management fees received from the
 
Bank are CCBG’s primary source
 
of income. Dividend payments by the Bank
to CCBG depend on the capitalization, earnings and
 
projected growth of the Bank, and are limited by various regulatory
restrictions, including compliance with a minimum Common
 
Equity Tier 1 Capital conservation buffer.
 
See the section entitled
“Regulatory Considerations”
 
in this
Item 1
 
and Note 17 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for
 
a discussion of the
restrictions.
 
Item 6 contains other financial and statistical information
 
about us.
 
Subsidiaries of CCBG
 
CCBG’s principal asset is the capital
 
stock of CCB, our wholly owned banking subsidiary,
 
which accounted for nearly 100% of
consolidated assets and net income attributable to CCBG at December
 
31, 2020.
 
In addition to our banking subsidiary,
 
CCB has
two primary subsidiaries, which are wholly owned, Capital
 
City Trust Company and Capital City Investments,
 
Inc.
 
We also
maintain a 51% membership interest in a consolidated
 
subsidiary, CCHL, which we
 
acquired on March 1, 2020.
 
Refer to Note 1
– Significant Accounting Policies/Business Combination
 
in our Consolidated Financial Statements for additional information
 
on
this strategic alliance.
 
The nature of these subsidiaries is provided below.
 
 
Operating Segment
 
We have one
 
reportable segment with three principal services: Banking Services (CCB), Trust
 
and Asset Management Services
(Capital City Trust Company), and
 
Brokerage Services (Capital City Investments, Inc.).
 
Revenues from each of these principal
services for the year ended 2020 totaled approximately
 
94.7%, 2.7%, and 2.41% of our total revenue, respectively.
 
In 2019 and
2018, Banking Services (CCB) revenue was approximately
 
95.3% and 95.6% of our total revenue for each respective
 
year.
 
 
 
5
Capital City Bank
 
CCB is a Florida-chartered full-service bank engaged
 
in the commercial and retail banking business. Significant services
 
offered
by CCB include:
 
 
Business Banking
 
– We provide banking
 
services to corporations and other business clients. Credit products
 
are available
for a wide variety of general business purposes, including
 
financing for commercial business properties, equipment,
inventories and accounts receivable, as well as commercial
 
leasing and letters of credit. We
 
also provide treasury
management services, and, through a marketing alliance
 
with Elavon, Inc., merchant credit card transaction processing
services.
 
 
Commercial Real Estate Lending
 
– We provide
 
a wide range of products to meet the financing needs of commercial
developers and investors, residential builders and developers,
 
and community development. Credit products are available
to purchase land and build structures for business use and
 
for investors who are developing residential or commercial
property.
 
 
Residential Real Estate Lending
 
– We provide
 
products through our strategic alliance with CCHL and its existing
network of locations to help meet the home financing
 
needs of consumers, including conventional permanent and
construction/ permanent (fixed, adjustable, or variable rate)
 
financing arrangements, and FHA/VA
 
/GNMA loan products.
 
We offer
 
both fixed and adjustable
 
rate residential mortgage (ARM) loans.
 
We offer
 
these products through our existing
network of CCHL locations.
 
We do not
 
originate subprime residential real estate loans.
 
 
 
Retail Credit
 
– We provide
 
a full-range of loan products to meet the needs of consumers,
 
including personal loans,
automobile loans, boat/RV
 
loans, home equity loans, and through a marketing alliance with ELAN,
 
we offer credit card
programs.
 
 
Institutional Banking –
We provide
 
banking services to meet the needs of state and local governments,
 
public schools
and colleges, charities, membership and not-for-profit
 
associations including customized checking and savings accounts,
cash management systems, tax-exempt loans, lines of
 
credit, and term loans.
 
 
Retail Banking
– We provide
 
a full-range of consumer banking services, including checking
 
accounts, savings programs,
interactive/automated teller machines (ITMs/ATMs),
 
debit/credit cards, night deposit services, safe deposit facilities,
online banking, and mobile banking.
 
Capital City Trust Company
 
Capital City Trust Company,
 
or the Trust Company,
 
provides asset management for individuals through agency,
 
personal trust,
IRA, and personal investment management accounts.
 
Associations, endowments, and other nonprofit entities hire the
 
Trust
Company to manage their investment portfolios.
 
Additionally, a staff
 
of well-trained professionals serves individuals requiring
 
the
services of a trustee, personal representative, or a guardian.
 
The market value of trust assets under discretionary
 
management
exceeded $985.6 million at December 31, 2020
 
with total assets under administration exceeding $999.5 million.
 
Capital City Investments, Inc.
 
We offer
 
our customers access to retail investment products through
 
LPL Financial pursuant to which retail investment products
would be offered through LPL. LPL offers
 
a full line of retail securities products, including U.S. Government
 
bonds, tax-free
municipal bonds, stocks, mutual funds, unit investment
 
trusts, annuities, life insurance and long-term health care. Non-deposit
investment and insurance products are: (i) not FDIC
 
insured; (ii) not deposits, obligations, or guarantees by
 
any bank; and (iii)
subject to investment risk, including the possible loss of
 
principal amount invested.
 
Lending Activities
 
One of our core goals is to support the communities in which
 
we operate. We
 
seek loans from within our primary market area,
which is defined as the counties in which our banking
 
offices are located.
 
We will also originate
 
loans within our secondary
market area, defined as counties adjacent to those in
 
which we have banking offices.
 
There may also be occasions when we will
have opportunities to make loans that are out of both
 
the primary and secondary market areas, including participation
 
loans.
These loans are generally only approved if the applicant is known
 
to us, underwriting is consistent with our criteria, and the
applicant’s primary business is
 
in or near our primary or secondary market area.
 
Approval of all loans is subject to our policies
and standards described in more detail below.
 
We have adopted
 
comprehensive lending policies, underwriting standards
 
and loan review procedures. Management and our
Board of Directors reviews and approves these policies and
 
procedures on a regular basis (at least annually).
 
6
 
Management has also implemented reporting systems
 
designed to monitor loan originations, loan quality,
 
concentrations of
credit, loan delinquencies, nonperforming loans, and potential
 
problem loans. Our management and the Credit Risk Oversight
Committee periodically review our lines of business to
 
monitor asset quality trends and the appropriateness of
 
credit policies. In
addition, total borrower exposure limits are established and
 
concentration risk is monitored. As part of this process,
 
the overall
composition of the portfolio is reviewed to gauge
 
diversification of risk, client concentrations, industry group,
 
loan type,
geographic area, or other relevant classifications of loans.
 
Specific segments of the portfolio are monitored and reported
 
to our
Board on a quarterly basis and we have strategic plans
 
in place to supplement Board approved credit policies governing
 
exposure
limits and underwriting standards. We
 
recognize that exceptions to the below-listed policy guidelines
 
may occasionally occur and
have established procedures for approving exceptions to
 
these policy guidelines.
 
Residential Real Estate Loans
 
 
We originate
 
1-4 family, owner-occupied
 
residential real estate loans at CCHL for sale in the secondary market.
 
A vast majority
of residential loan originations are fixed-rate loans
 
which are sold in the secondary market on a non-recourse basis.
 
We will
frequently sell loans and retain the servicing rights.
 
Note 4 – Mortgage Banking Activities in the Notes to Our Consolidated
Financial Statements provides additional information
 
on our servicing portfolio.
 
 
CCB also maintains a portfolio of residential loans held
 
for investment and will periodically purchase newly originated
 
1-4
family secured adjustable rate loans from CCHL for
 
that portfolio.
 
Residential loans held for investment are generally
underwritten in accordance with secondary market
 
guidelines in effect at the time of origination, including
 
loan-to-value, or LTV,
and documentation requirements.
 
 
 
Residential real estate loans also include home equity
 
lines of credit, or HELOCs, and home equity loans. Our home
 
equity
portfolio includes revolving open-ended equity loans
 
with interest-only or minimal monthly principal payments and
 
closed-end
amortizing loans. Open-ended equity loans typically
 
have an interest only 10-year draw period followed by a five-year
 
repayment
period of 0.75% of principal balance monthly and balloon
 
payment at maturity.
 
As of December 31, 2020,
 
approximately 68%
 
of
our residential home equity loan portfolio consisted of
 
first mortgages.
 
Interest rates may be fixed or adjustable.
 
Adjustable-rate
loans are tied to the Prime Rate with a typical margin
 
of 1.0% or more.
 
Commercial Loans
 
Our policy sets forth guidelines for debt service coverage
 
ratios, LTV
 
ratios and documentation standards. Commercial loans are
primarily made based on identified cash flows of
 
the borrower with consideration given to underlying collateral
 
and personal or
other guarantees. We
 
have established debt service coverage ratio limits that require
 
a borrower’s cash flow to be sufficient to
cover principal and interest payments on all new
 
and existing debt. The majority of our commercial loans are secured
 
by the
assets being financed or other business assets such as accounts receivable
 
or inventory.
 
Many of the loans in the commercial
portfolio have variable interest rates tied to the Prime
 
Rate or U.S. Treasury indices.
 
Commercial Real Estate Loans
 
We have adopted
 
guidelines for debt service coverage ratios, LTV
 
ratios and documentation standards for commercial real estate
loans. These loans are primarily made based on identified
 
cash flows of the borrower with consideration given to underlying
 
real
estate collateral and personal guarantees. Our policy
 
establishes a maximum LTV
 
specific to property type and minimum debt
service coverage ratio limits that require a borrower’s
 
cash flow to be sufficient to cover principal and
 
interest payments on all
new and existing debt. Commercial real
 
estate loans may be fixed or variable-rate loans with interest rates
 
tied to the Prime Rate
or U.S. Treasury indices. We
 
require appraisals for loans in excess of $250,000 that
 
are secured by real property.
 
 
Consumer Loans
 
Our consumer loan portfolio includes personal installment loans,
 
direct and indirect automobile financing, and overdraft lines of
credit. The majority of the consumer loan portfolio consists of
 
indirect and direct automobile loans. The majority of our
 
consumer
loans are short-term and have fixed rates of interest that
 
are priced based on current market interest rates and the financial
strength of the borrower.
 
Our policy establishes maximum debt-to-income ratios,
 
minimum credit scores, and includes guidelines
for verification of applicants’ income and receipt
 
of credit reports.
 
 
7
Lending Limits and Extensions of Additional Credit
 
We have established
 
an internal lending limit of $10 million for the total aggregate
 
amount of credit that will be extended to a
client and any related entities within our Board approved
 
policies. This compares to our legal lending limit of approximately
 
$76
million.
 
 
Loan Modification and Restructuring
 
In the normal course of business, we receive requests from
 
our clients to renew,
 
extend, refinance, or otherwise modify their
current loan obligations. In most cases, this may be the result of
 
a balloon maturity that is common in most commercial loan
agreements, a request to refinance to obtain current market
 
rates of interest, competitive reasons, or the conversion of
 
a
construction loan to a permanent financing structure
 
at the completion or stabilization of the property.
 
In these cases, the request
is held to the normal underwriting standards and pricing
 
strategies as any other loan request, whether new or renewal.
 
In other cases, we may modify a loan because of a
 
reduction in debt service capacity experienced by the client
 
(i.e., a potentially
troubled loan whereby the client may be experiencing
 
financial difficulties). To
 
maximize the collection of loan balances, we
evaluate troubled loans on a case-by-case basis to determine
 
if a loan modification would be appropriate. We
 
pursue loan
modifications when there is a reasonable chance that an
 
appropriate modification would allow our client to continue servicing
 
the
debt.
 
 
The CARES Act permitted banks to suspend
 
requirements under GAAP for loan
 
modifications to borrowers affected by COVID-
19 that would otherwise be characterized
 
as Troubled Debt Restructurings
 
and suspend any determination related
 
thereto if (i) the
loan modification was made between March
 
1, 2020 and the earlier of December
 
31, 2020 or 60 days after the end of
 
the COVID-
19 emergency declaration, and (ii) the applicable
 
loan was not more than 30 days past
 
due as of December 31, 2019.
 
The federal
banking agencies also issued guidance
 
to encourage banks to make loan
 
modifications for borrowers affected
 
by COVID-19 and to
assure banks that they would not
 
be criticized by examiners for
 
doing so.
 
We applied this guidance to qualifying loan
modifications.
 
Expansion of Business
 
See MD&A (Business Overview) for disclosures regarding
 
the expansion of our Business.
 
Competition
 
We operate
 
in a highly competitive environment, especially with respect to
 
services and pricing, that has undergone significant
changes since the recent financial crisis. Since January
 
1, 2009, over 500 financial institutions have failed in the
 
U.S., including
85 in Georgia and 70 in Florida. Nearly all
 
of the failed banks were community banks. The assets and deposits
 
of many of these
failed community banks were acquired mostly by larger
 
financial institutions. The banking industry has also experienced
significant consolidation through mergers and
 
acquisition, which we expect will continue during 2021. However,
 
we believe that
the larger financial institutions acquiring banks
 
in our market areas are less familiar with the markets in
 
which we operate and
typically target a different client base.
 
We also believe
 
clients who bank at community banks tend to prefer the relationship
 
style
service of community banks compared to larger
 
banks.
 
As a result, we expect to be able to effectively
 
compete in our markets with larger financial institutions through
 
providing
superior client service and leveraging our knowledge
 
and experience in providing banking products and services in
 
our market
areas. Thus, a further reduction of the number of community
 
banks could continue
 
to enhance our competitive position and
opportunities in many of our markets. However,
 
larger financial institutions can benefit from economies of
 
scale. Therefore, these
larger institutions may be able to offer
 
banking products and services at more competitive prices than
 
us. Additionally, these
larger financial institutions may offer
 
financial products that we do not offer.
 
We may also
 
begin to see competition from new banks that are being
 
formed. In late 2016, the first
de novo
 
bank charter since the
downturn was approved for a Florida-based bank and one
 
new Florida charter was approved in 2019. While the
 
number of new
bank formations has not returned to pre-downturn
 
levels, increased
de novo
 
bank applications could signal additional competition
from new community banks.
 
Our primary market area consists of 20 counties in Florida,
 
four counties in Georgia, and one county in Alabama.
 
In these
markets, we compete against a wide range of banking
 
and nonbanking institutions including banks, savings and
 
loan associations,
credit unions, money market funds, mutual fund advisory
 
companies, mortgage banking companies, investment banking
companies, finance companies and other types of
 
financial institutions. Most of Florida’s
 
major banking concerns have a presence
in Leon County,
 
where our main office is located.
 
Our Leon County deposits totaled $1.232 billion, or 38% of
 
our consolidated
deposits at December 31, 2020.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8
The table below depicts our market share percentage within
 
each county,
 
based on commercial bank deposits within the county.
Market Share as of June 30,
(1)
County
2020
2019
2018
Florida
 
Alachua
4.5%
4.5%
4.7%
 
Bay
0.0%
N/A
N/A
 
Bradford
30.6%
40.2%
41.9%
 
Citrus
3.6%
3.4%
3.4%
 
Clay
2.0%
2.1%
2.1%
 
Dixie
18.7%
19.4%
20.8%
 
Gadsden
80.8%
81.6%
79.6%
 
Gilchrist
38.7%
39.7%
46.3%
 
Gulf
12.8%
12.6%
14.8%
 
Hernando
3.5%
2.9%
2.5%
 
Jefferson
23.0%
21.9%
19.7%
 
Leon
13.3%
13.1%
12.8%
 
Levy
24.2%
25.0%
26.8%
 
Madison
14.0%
13.7%
13.6%
 
Putnam
20.7%
20.8%
22.0%
 
St. Johns
0.6%
0.6%
0.8%
 
Suwannee
7.1%
6.7%
7.4%
 
Taylor
72.4%
23.0%
23.5%
 
Wakulla
8.3%
9.3%
8.9%
 
Washington
11.0%
13.1%
12.0%
Georgia
 
Bibb
3.2%
2.7%
2.9%
 
Grady
14.0%
13.0%
14.2%
 
Laurens
8.4%
8.3%
8.6%
 
Troup
6.5%
6.3%
5.5%
Alabama
 
Chambers
9.6%
8.7%
9.2%
(1)
Obtained from the FDIC Summary of Deposits Report for the year indicated.
 
Seasonality
 
We believe our
 
commercial banking operations are not generally seasonal in
 
nature; however, public deposits tend
 
to increase
with tax collections in the fourth and first quarters of
 
each year and decline as a result of governmental spending
 
thereafter.
 
Human Capital
 
 
We are dedicated
 
to creating personal relationships with our customers and
 
implementing solutions that are right for them. Our
associates (our employees) are critical to achieving this mission,
 
and it is crucial that we continue to attract and retain experienced
associates. As part of these efforts, we strive
 
to offer a competitive compensation and benefits program,
 
foster a community
where everyone feels included and empowered to do to
 
their best work, and give associates the opportunity to
 
give back to their
communities and make a social impact.
 
At February 9, 2021, we had approximately 773 associates,
 
which included approximately 727 full-time associates and
approximately 46 part-time associates.
 
None of our associates are represented by a labor
 
union or covered by a collective
bargaining agreement.
 
At February 9, 2021, approximately 74% of our current
 
workforce was female while 26% was male, and
the average tenure of our associates was approximately 11
 
years.
 
 
 
9
Compensation and Benefits Program
. Our compensation program is designed to attract and reward
 
talented individuals who
possess the skills necessary to support our business objectives,
 
assist in the achievement of our strategic goals and create
 
long-
term value for our shareowners. We
 
provide our associates with compensation packages
 
that include base salary, annual
 
incentive
bonuses, and equity awards tied to the value of our stock
 
price. We believe
 
that a compensation program with both short-term and
long-term awards provides fair and competitive
 
compensation and aligns associate and shareowner interests,
 
including by
incentivizing business and individual performance (pay
 
for performance), motivating based on long-term company
 
performance
and integrating compensation with our business plans. In
 
addition to cash and equity compensation, we also offer
 
associates
benefits such as life and health (medical, dental &
 
vision) insurance, paid time off, paid parental leave,
 
a 401(k) plan, and a
pension plan.
 
Diversity and Inclusion
. We believe that
 
an equitable and inclusive environment with diverse teams produces
 
more creative
solutions, results in better services and is crucial to our
 
efforts to attract and retain key talent. We
 
strive to promote inclusion
through our corporate values of integrity,
 
advocacy, partnership, relationships,
 
community, and exceptional
 
service. We are
focused on building an inclusive culture through
 
a variety of diversity and inclusion initiatives, including related to
 
internal
promotions and hiring practices. Our associate resource groups
 
also help to build an inclusive culture through company
 
events,
participation in our recruitment efforts,
 
and input into our hiring strategies.
 
Community Involvement
. We aim to give
 
back to the communities where we live and work, and
 
believe that this commitment
helps in our efforts to attract and retain associates.
 
Community involvement is a hallmark for our organization,
 
and it comes
naturally to our associates. We
 
encourage our associates to volunteer their hours with
 
service organizations and philanthropic
groups in the communities we serve.
 
Health and Safety
. The success of our business is fundamentally connected
 
to the well-being of our people. Accordingly,
 
we are
committed to the health, safety and wellness of our associates.
 
We provide
 
our associates and their families with access to a
variety of flexible and convenient health and welfare
 
programs, including benefits that support their physical and mental
 
health by
providing tools and resources to help them improve
 
or maintain their health status; and that offer choice
 
where possible so they
can customize their benefits to meet their needs and the
 
needs of their families. In response to the COVID-19 pandemic,
 
we
implemented significant operating environment
 
changes that we determined were in the best interest of our associates,
 
as well as
the communities in which we operate, and which comply
 
with government regulations. This includes having the majority
 
of our
associates work from home, while implementing additional
 
safety measures for associates continuing critical on-site work.
 
Regulatory Considerations
We must comply
 
with state and federal banking laws and regulations
 
that control virtually all aspects of our
 
operations. These
laws and regulations generally aim
 
to protect our depositors, not necessarily
 
our shareowners or our creditors.
 
Any changes in
applicable laws or regulations may
 
materially affect our business and prospects.
 
Proposed legislative or regulatory
 
changes may
also affect our operations. The following description
 
summarizes some of the laws and regulations
 
to which we are subject.
References to applicable statutes and
 
regulations are brief summaries,
 
do not purport to be complete, and are
 
qualified in their
entirety by reference
 
to such statutes and regulations.
 
 
Capital City Bank Group, Inc.
 
We are registered
 
with the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve as a financial
 
holding company under the Bank Holding
Company Act of 1956. As a result, we are subject to
 
supervisory regulation and examination by the Federal Reserve.
 
The Gramm-
Leach-Bliley Act, the Bank Holding Company Act, or BHC Act,
 
and other federal laws subject financial holding companies to
particular restrictions on the types of activities in which
 
they may engage, and to a range of supervisory requirements and
activities, including regulatory enforcement actions
 
for violations of laws and regulations.
 
 
Permitted Activities
 
The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act modernized the U.S.
 
banking system by: (i) allowing bank holding companies
 
that qualify as
“financial holding companies,” such as CCBG, to engage
 
in a broad range of financial and related activities; (ii) allowing insurers
and other financial service companies to acquire banks; (iii)
 
removing restrictions that applied to bank holding company
ownership of securities firms and mutual fund advisory
 
companies; and (iv) establishing the overall regulatory scheme applicable
to bank holding companies that also engage in insurance
 
and securities operations. The general effect of the law
 
was to establish a
comprehensive framework to permit affiliations
 
among commercial banks, insurance companies, securities firms, and
 
other
financial service providers. Activities that are financial
 
in nature are broadly defined to include not only banking,
 
insurance, and
securities activities, but also merchant banking and additional
 
activities that the Federal Reserve, in consultation with
 
the
Secretary of the Treasury,
 
determines to be financial in nature, incidental to such financial activities,
 
or complementary activities
that do not pose a substantial risk to the safety and soundness
 
of depository institutions or the financial system generally.
 
 
 
10
In contrast to financial holding companies, bank holding
 
companies are limited to managing or controlling banks, furnishing
services to or performing services for its subsidiaries, and
 
engaging in other activities that the Federal Reserve determines by
regulation or order to be so closely related to banking
 
or managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto.
 
In
determining whether a particular activity is permissible, the
 
Federal Reserve must consider whether the performance of
 
such an
activity reasonably can be expected to produce benefits
 
to the public that outweigh possible adverse effects.
 
Possible benefits
include greater convenience, increased competition,
 
and gains in efficiency.
 
Possible adverse effects include undue concentration
of resources, decreased or unfair competition, conflicts of
 
interest, and unsound banking practices. Despite prior approval, the
Federal Reserve may order a bank holding company or its subsidiaries
 
to terminate any activity or to terminate ownership or
control of any subsidiary when the Federal Reserve
 
has reasonable cause to believe that a serious risk to the financial
 
safety,
soundness or stability of any bank subsidiary of that
 
bank holding company may result from such an activity.
 
Changes in Control
 
Subject to certain exceptions, the BHC Act and the Change
 
in Bank Control Act, or CBCA, together with the applicable
regulations, require Federal Reserve approval (or,
 
depending on the circumstances, no notice of disapproval)
 
prior to any
acquisition of  “control” of a bank or bank holding company.
 
Under the BHC Act, a company (a broadly defined
 
term that
includes partnerships among other things) that acquires
 
the power, directly or indirectly,
 
to direct the management or policies of
an insured depository institution or to vote 25% or more
 
of any class of voting securities of any insured depository
 
institution is
deemed to control the institution and to be a bank holding
 
company. A company
 
that acquires less than 5% of any class of voting
security (and that does not exhibit the other control
 
factors) is presumed not to have control. For ownership levels
 
between the 5%
and 25% thresholds, the Federal Reserve has developed an
 
extensive body of law on the circumstances in which control may
 
or
may not exist.
 
Further, on January 30, 2020, the
 
Federal Reserve finalized a rule that simplifies and increases the
 
transparency of
its rules for determining when one company controls another
 
company for purposes of the BHC Act.
 
The rule became effective
September 30, 2020. The rule has and will likely continue
 
to have a meaningful impact on control determinations related
 
to
investments in banks and bank holding companies and
 
investments by bank holding companies in nonbank companies.
 
Under the CBCA, if an individual or a company that
 
acquires 10% or more of any class of voting securities of an
 
insured
depository institution or its holding company and
 
either that institution or company has registered securities under
 
Section 12 of
the Exchange Act, or no other person will own a
 
greater percentage of that class of voting securities immediately
 
after the
acquisition, then that investor is presumed to have control
 
and may be required to file a change in bank control notice
 
with the
institution’s or the holding
 
company’s primary federal
 
regulator. Our common
 
stock is registered under Section 12 of the
Exchange Act.
 
As a financial holding company,
 
we are required to obtain prior approval from the Federal
 
Reserve before (i) acquiring all or
substantially all of the assets of a bank or bank holding
 
company, (ii) acquiring direct
 
or indirect ownership or control of more
than 5% of the outstanding voting stock of any bank or
 
bank holding company (unless we own a majority of
 
such bank’s voting
shares), or (iii) acquiring, merging or consolidating
 
with any other bank or bank holding company.
 
In determining whether to
approve a proposed bank acquisition, federal bank
 
regulators will consider, among other factors,
 
the effect of the acquisition on
competition, the public benefits expected to be received
 
from the acquisition, the projected capital ratios and levels on a post-
acquisition basis, and the companies’ records of addressing
 
the credit needs of the communities they serve, including
 
the needs of
low and moderate income neighborhoods, consistent with
 
the safe and sound operation of the bank, under the Community
Reinvestment Act of 1977.
 
Under Florida law,
 
a person or entity proposing to directly or indirectly acquire control
 
of a Florida bank must also obtain
permission from the Florida Office of Financial
 
Regulation. Florida statutes define “control” as either (i) indirectly or
 
directly
owning, controlling or having power to vote 25% or more
 
of the voting securities of a bank; (ii) controlling the election of a
majority of directors of a bank; (iii) owning, controlling,
 
or having power to vote 10% or more of the voting securities
 
as well as
directly or indirectly exercising a controlling influence
 
over management or policies of a bank; or (iv) as
 
determined by the
Florida Office of Financial Regulation. These requirements
 
will affect us because the Bank is chartered
 
under Florida law and
changes in control of CCBG are indirect
 
changes in control of CCB.
 
Prohibitions Against Tying Arrangements
 
Banks are subject to the prohibitions of 12 U.S.C. Section
 
1972 on certain tying arrangements.
 
We are prohibited,
 
subject to
some exceptions, from extending credit to or offering
 
any other service, or fixing or varying the consideration for such
 
extension
of credit or service, on the condition that the customer
 
obtain some additional service from the institution or its affiliates
 
or not
obtain services of a competitor of the institution.
 
 
 
11
Capital; Dividends; Source of Strength
 
The Federal Reserve imposes certain capital requirements
 
on financial holding companies under the BHC Act, including
 
a
minimum leverage ratio and a minimum ratio
 
of “qualifying” capital to risk-weighted assets. These requirements
 
are described
below under “Capital Regulations.” Subject to its capita
 
l
 
requirements and certain other restrictions, we are generally
 
able to
borrow money to make a capital contribution to CCB, and
 
such loans may be repaid from dividends paid from CCB to us.
 
We are
also able to raise capital for contributions to CCB by issuing
 
securities without having to receive regulatory approval,
 
subject to
compliance with federal and state securities laws.
 
It is the Federal Reserve’s policy
 
that bank holding companies should generally pay dividends
 
on common stock only out of
income available over the past year,
 
and only if prospective earnings retention is consistent with the
 
organization’s
 
expected
future needs and financial condition. It is also the Federal
 
Reserve’s policy that bank holding
 
companies should not maintain
dividend levels that undermine their ability to be a source
 
of strength to its banking subsidiaries. Additionally,
 
the Federal
Reserve has indicated that bank holding companies
 
should carefully review their dividend policies and has discouraged
 
payment
ratios that are at maximum allowable levels unless both
 
asset quality and capital are very strong. The Federal Reserve
 
possesses
enforcement powers over bank holding companies and their
 
non-bank subsidiaries to prevent or remedy actions that
 
represent
unsafe or unsound practices or violations of applicable
 
statutes and regulations. Among these powers is the ability to proscribe
 
the
payment of dividends by banks and bank holding companies.
 
 
Bank holding companies are expected to consult with the
 
Federal Reserve before redeeming any equity or other capital instrument
included in Tier 1 or Tier
 
2 capital prior to stated maturity,
 
if such redemption could have a material effect on
 
the level or
composition of the organization’s
 
capital base. In addition, a bank holding company may not repurchase
 
shares equal to 10% or
more of its net worth if it would not be well-capitalized (as
 
defined by the Federal Reserve) after giving effect
 
to such repurchase.
Bank holding companies experiencing financial weaknesses,
 
or that are at significant risk of developing financial
 
weaknesses,
must consult with the Federal Reserve before redeeming
 
or repurchasing common stock or other regulatory capital instruments.
 
In accordance with Federal Reserve policy,
 
which has been codified by the Dodd-Frank Act, we are expected to
 
act as a source of
financial strength to CCB and to commit resources to support
 
CCB in circumstances in which we might not otherwise do
 
so. In
furtherance of this policy,
 
the Federal Reserve may require a financial holding company to
 
terminate any activity or relinquish
control of a nonbank subsidiary (other than a nonbank
 
subsidiary of a bank) upon the Federal Reserve’s
 
determination that such
activity or control constitutes a serious risk to the financial
 
soundness or stability of any subsidiary depository institution
 
of the
financial holding company.
 
Further, federal bank regulatory authorities
 
have additional discretion to require a financial holding
company to divest itself of any bank or nonbank subsidiary
 
if the agency determines that divestiture may aid the depository
institution’s financial condition.
 
 
Safe and Sound Banking Practices
 
Bank holding companies and their nonbanking subsidiaries
 
are prohibited from engaging in activities that represent unsafe and
unsound banking practices or that constitute a violation of
 
law or regulations. Under certain conditions the Federal Reserve may
conclude that some actions of a bank holding company,
 
such as a payment of a cash dividend, would constitute an
 
unsafe and
unsound banking practice. The Federal Reserve also has
 
the authority to regulate the debt of bank holding companies,
 
including
the authority to impose interest rate ceilings and reserve
 
requirements on such debt. The Federal Reserve may also require a bank
holding company to file written notice and obtain its approval
 
prior to purchasing or redeeming its equity securities,
 
unless certain
conditions are met.
 
 
Capital City Bank
 
Capital City Bank is a state-chartered commercial banking
 
institution that is chartered by and headquartered in the State of
Florida, and is subject to supervision and regulation by
 
the Florida Office of Financial Regulation. The Florida
 
Office of Financial
Regulation supervises and regulates all areas of our
 
operations including, without limitation, the making of loans,
 
the issuance of
securities, the conduct of our corporate affairs,
 
the satisfaction of capital adequacy requirements, the payment
 
of dividends, and
the establishment or closing of banking centers. We
 
are also a member bank of the Federal Reserve System, which makes
 
our
operations subject to broad federal regulation and oversight
 
by the Federal Reserve. In addition, our deposit accounts
 
are insured
by the FDIC up to the maximum extent permitted by law,
 
and the FDIC has certain supervisory enforcement powers
 
over us.
 
 
 
12
As a state-chartered bank in the State of Florida, we
 
are empowered by statute, subject to the limitations contained
 
in those
statutes, to take and pay interest on, savings and time deposits,
 
to accept demand deposits, to make loans on residential and
 
other
real estate, to make consumer and commercial loans,
 
to invest, with certain limitations, in equity securities and
 
in debt obligations
of banks and corporations and to provide various other banking
 
services for the benefit of our clients. Various
 
consumer laws and
regulations also affect our operations, including
 
state usury laws, laws relating to fiduciaries, consumer credit and
 
equal credit
opportunity laws, and fair credit reporting. In addition,
 
the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement
 
Act of 1991, or
FDICIA, prohibits insured state chartered institutions from
 
conducting activities as principal that are not permitted for national
banks. A bank, however, may
 
engage in an otherwise prohibited activity if it meets its minimum
 
capital requirements and the
FDIC determines that the activity does not present a
 
significant risk to the Deposit Insurance Fund.
 
Safety and Soundness Standards / Risk Management
 
 
The federal banking agencies have adopted guidelines
 
establishing operational and managerial standards to promote
 
the safety
and soundness of federally insured depository institutions. The
 
guidelines set forth standards for internal controls, information
systems, internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit
 
underwriting, interest rate exposure, asset growth, compensation,
 
fees
and benefits, asset quality and earnings.
 
In general, the safety and soundness guidelines prescribe
 
the goals to be achieved in each area, and each institution is responsible
for establishing its own procedures to achieve those goals.
 
If an institution fails to comply with any of the standards set forth
 
in
the guidelines, the financial institution’s
 
primary federal regulator may require the institution to
 
submit a plan for achieving and
maintaining compliance. If a financial institution fails to
 
submit an acceptable compliance plan, or fails in any mater
 
ial respect to
implement a compliance plan that has been accepted by its primary
 
federal regulator, the regulator is required
 
to issue an order
directing the institution to cure the deficiency.
 
Until the deficiency cited in the regulator’s order
 
is cured, the regulator may
restrict the financial institution’s
 
rate of growth, require the financial institution to increase its capital,
 
restrict the rates the
institution pays on deposits or require the institution to
 
take any action the regulator deems appropriate under
 
the circumstances.
Noncompliance with the standards established by the
 
safety and soundness guidelines may also constitute grounds for
 
other
enforcement action by the federal bank regulatory agencies,
 
including cease and desist orders and civil money
 
penalty
assessments.
 
 
During the past decade, the bank regulatory agencies have
 
increasingly emphasized the importance of sound risk management
processes and strong internal controls when evaluating
 
the activities of the financial institutions they supervise. Properly
managing risks has been identified as critical to the conduct
 
of safe and sound banking activities and has become even
 
more
important as new technologies, product innovation and
 
the size and speed of financial transactions have changed the nature
 
of
banking markets. The agencies have identified a spectrum
 
of risks facing a banking institution including, but not limited
 
to, credit,
market, liquidity,
 
operational, legal and reputational risk. In particular,
 
recent regulatory pronouncements have focused on
operational risk, which arises from the potential that inadequate
 
information systems, operational problems, breaches in internal
controls, fraud or unforeseen catastrophes will result in
 
unexpected losses. New products and services, third party
 
risk
management and cybersecurity are critical sources of operational
 
risk that financial institutions are expected to address in the
current environment. The Bank is expected to have active board
 
and senior management oversight; adequate policies, procedures
and limits; adequate risk measurement, monitoring and
 
management information systems; and comprehensive
 
internal controls.
 
Reserves
 
The Federal Reserve requires all depository institutions
 
to maintain reserves against transaction accounts (noninterest bearing
 
and
NOW checking accounts). The balances maintained
 
to meet the reserve requirements imposed by the Federal Reserve may be
used to satisfy liquidity requirements. An institution may
 
borrow from the Federal Reserve Bank “discount window”
 
as a
secondary source of funds, provided that the institution
 
meets the Federal Reserve Bank’s
 
credit standards.
 
Dividends
 
CCB is subject to legal limitations on the frequency
 
and amount of dividends that can be paid to CCBG. The Federal
 
Reserve may
restrict the ability of CCB to pay dividends if such
 
payments would constitute an unsafe or unsound banking
 
practice.
Additionally, as
 
of January 1, 2019, financial institutions are required to
 
maintain a capital conservation buffer of at least 2.5%
 
of
risk-weighted assets in order to avoid restrictions on
 
capital distributions and other payments. If a financial institution’s
 
capital
conservation buffer falls below the minimum
 
requirement, its maximum payout amount for capital distributions
 
and discretionary
payments declines to a set percentage of eligible retained
 
income based on the size of the buffer.
 
See “Capital Regulations,”
below for additional details on this new capital requirement.
 
 
13
In addition, Florida law and Federal regulation place
 
restrictions on the declaration of dividends from state chartered
 
banks to
their holding companies. Pursuant to the Florida Financial
 
Institutions Code, the board of directors of state-chartered banks,
 
after
charging off bad debts, depreciation and
 
other worthless assets, if any,
 
and making provisions for reasonably anticipated future
losses on loans and other assets, may quarterly,
 
semi-annually or annually declare a dividend of up to the aggregate
 
net profits of
that period combined with the bank’s
 
retained net profits for the preceding two years and, with the approval
 
of the Florida Office
of Financial Regulation and Federal Reserve, declare
 
a dividend from retained net profits which accrued prior to the
 
preceding
two years. Before declaring such dividends, 20% of the
 
net profits for the preceding period as is covered by the
 
dividend must be
transferred to the surplus fund of the bank until this fund
 
becomes equal to the amount of the bank’s
 
common stock then issued
and outstanding. A state-chartered bank may not
 
declare any dividend if (i) its net income (loss) from the
 
current year combined
with the retained net income (loss) for the preceding
 
two years aggregates a loss or (ii) the payment of such
 
dividend would cause
the capital account of the bank to fall below the minimum amount
 
required by law, regulation
 
,
 
order or any written agreement
with the Florida Office of Financial Regulation
 
or a federal regulatory agency.
 
Under Federal Reserve regulations, a state member
bank may, without
 
the prior approval of the Federal Reserve, pay a dividend in
 
an amount that, when taken together with all
dividends declared during the calendar year,
 
does not exceed the sum of the bank’s
 
net income during the current calendar year
and the retained net income of the prior two calendar years.
 
The Federal Reserve may approve greater amounts.
 
Insurance of Accounts and Other Assessments
 
 
Deposits at U.S. domiciled banks are insured by the FDIC, subject
 
to limits and conditions of applicable laws and regulations.
Our deposit accounts are insured by the Deposit Insurance
 
Fund, or DIF,
 
generally up to a maximum of $250,000 per separately
insured depositor. In order
 
to fund the DIF, all
 
insured depository institutions are required to pay quarterly
 
assessments to the
FDIC that are based on an institutions assignment to one
 
of four risk categories based on supervisory evaluations,
 
regulatory
capital levels and certain other factors.
 
The FDIC has the discretion to adjust an institution’s
 
risk rating and may terminate its
insurance of deposits upon a finding that the institution
 
engaged or is engaging in unsafe and unsound practices, is in an
 
unsafe or
unsound condition to continue operations, or violated
 
any applicable law, regulation,
 
rule, order or condition imposed by the
FDIC or written agreement entered into with the FDIC. The
 
FDIC may also prohibit any FDIC-insured institution from
 
engaging
in any activity it determines to pose a serious risk to
 
the DIF.
 
 
Transactions With Affiliates
 
and Insiders
 
Pursuant to Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve
 
Act and Regulation W,
 
the authority of CCB to engage in transactions
with related parties or “affiliates” or to make
 
loans to insiders is limited. Loan transactions with an affiliate
 
generally must be
collateralized and certain transactions between CCB and its affiliates,
 
including the sale of assets, the payment of money or the
provision of services, must be on terms and conditions that
 
are substantially the same, or at least as favorable to CCB, as those
prevailing for comparable nonaffiliated transactions.
 
In addition, CCB generally may not purchase securities issued or
underwritten by affiliates.
 
 
Loans to executive officers and directors of an
 
insured depository institution or any of its affiliates or to
 
any person who directly
or indirectly, or
 
acting through or in concert with one or more persons, owns, controls
 
or has the power to vote more than 10% of
any class of voting securities of a bank, which we refer
 
to as “10% Shareowners,” or to any political or campaign
 
committee the
funds or services of which will benefit those executive
 
officers, directors, or 10% Shareowners or which is controlled
 
by those
executive officers, directors or 10% Shareowners,
 
are subject to Sections 22(g) and 22(h) of the Federal Reserve
 
Act and the
corresponding regulations (Regulation O) and Section
 
13(k) of the Exchange Act relating to the prohibition on
 
personal loans to
executives (which exempts financial institutions in compliance
 
with the insider lending restrictions of Section 22(h) of
 
the Federal
Reserve Act). Among other things, these loans must be
 
made on terms substantially the same as those prevailing on transactions
made to unaffiliated
 
individuals and certain extensions of credit to those persons must
 
first be approved in advance by a
disinterested majority of the entire board of directors.
 
Section 22(h) of the Federal Reserve Act prohibits loans to
 
any of those
individuals where the aggregate amount exceeds an
 
amount equal to 15% of an institution’s
 
unimpaired capital and surplus plus
an additional 10% of unimpaired capital and surplus in
 
the case of loans that are fully secured by readily marketable
 
collateral, or
when the aggregate amount on all of the extensions of
 
credit outstanding to all of these persons would exceed our unimpaired
capital and unimpaired surplus. Section 22(g) identifies
 
limited circumstances in which we are permitted to extend
 
credit to
executive officers.
 
 
 
14
Community Reinvestment Act
 
The Community Reinvestment Act and its corresponding
 
regulations are intended to encourage banks to help meet
 
the credit
needs of the communities they serve, including low and
 
moderate income neighborhoods, consistent with safe and sound
 
banking
practices. These regulations provide for regulatory assessment
 
of a bank’s record in meeting
 
the credit needs of its market area.
Federal banking agencies are required to publicly disclose
 
each bank’s rating
 
under the Community Reinvestment Act. The
Federal Reserve considers a bank’s
 
Community Reinvestment Act rating when the bank submits an
 
application to establish bank
branches, merge with another bank, or
 
acquire the assets and assume the liabilities of another bank. In
 
the case of a financial
holding company,
 
the Community Reinvestment Act performance record of all banks involved
 
in a merger or acquisition are
reviewed in connection with the application to acquire
 
ownership or control of shares or assets of a bank or to
 
merge with another
bank or bank holding company.
 
An unsatisfactory record can substantially delay or block the transaction.
 
We received a
satisfactory rating on our most recent Community Reinvestment
 
Act assessment.
 
 
Capital Regulations
 
The federal banking regulators have adopted risk-based,
 
capital adequacy guidelines for financial holding companies
 
and their
subsidiary banks based on the Basel III standards. Under
 
these guidelines, assets and off-balance sheet items are assigned
 
to
specific risk categories each with designated risk weightings. The
 
new risk-based capital guidelines are designed to make
regulatory capital requirements more sensitive to diffe
 
rences in risk profiles among banks and bank holding companies,
 
to
account for off-balance sheet exposure, to minimize
 
disincentives for holding liquid assets, and to achieve
 
greater consistency in
evaluating the capital adequacy of major banks throughout
 
the world. The resulting capital ratios represent capital as a
 
percentage
of total risk-weighted assets and off-balance
 
sheet items. Final rules implementing the capital adequacy guidelines
 
became
effective, with various phase-in periods, on
 
January 1, 2015 for community banks. All of the rules were fully
 
phased in as of
January 1, 2019. These final rules represent a significant
 
change to the prior general risk-based capital rules and are designed
 
to
substantially conform to the Basel III international
 
standards.
 
 
In computing total risk-weighted assets, bank and bank holding
 
company assets are given risk-weights of 0%, 20%, 50%, 100%
and 150%. In addition, certain off-balance
 
sheet items are given similar credit conversion factors to convert
 
them to asset
equivalent amounts to which an appropriate risk-weight will
 
apply. Most loans
 
will be assigned to the 100% risk category,
 
except
for performing first mortgage loans fully secured by 1-to-4
 
family and certain multi-family residential property,
 
which carry a
50% risk rating. Most investment securities (including,
 
primarily, general obligation
 
claims on states or other political
subdivisions of the United States) will be assigned to the
 
20% category, except
 
for municipal or state revenue bonds, which have
a 50% risk-weight, and direct obligations of the U.S. Treasury
 
or obligations backed by the full faith and credit of the
 
U.S.
Government, which have a 0% risk-weight. In covering off-balance
 
sheet items, direct credit substitutes, including general
guarantees and standby letters of credit backing financial
 
obligations, are given a 100% conversion factor.
 
Transaction-related
contingencies such as bid bonds, standby letters of credit
 
backing nonfinancial obligations, and undrawn commitments
 
(including
commercial credit lines with an initial maturity of more
 
than one year) have a 50% conversion factor.
 
Short-term commercial
letters of credit are converted at 20% and certain short
 
-term unconditionally cancelable commitments have a 0% factor.
 
 
Under the final rules, minimum requirements increased
 
for both the quality and quantity of capital held by banking organizations.
 
In this respect, the final rules implement strict eligibility criteria
 
for regulatory capital instruments and improve the methodology
for
 
calculating risk-weighted assets to enhance risk sensitivity.
 
Consistent with the international Basel III framework, the rules
include a new minimum ratio of Common Equity Tier
 
1 Capital to Risk-Weighted
 
Assets of 4.5%. The rules also create a
Common Equity Tier 1 Capital conservation
 
buffer of 2.5% of risk-weighted assets. This buffer
 
is added to each of the three risk-
based capital ratios to determine whether an institution
 
has established the buffer.
 
The rules raise the minimum ratio of Tier 1
Capital to Risk-Weighted
 
Assets from 4% to 6% and include a minimum leverage
 
ratio of 4% for all banking organizations. If a
financial institution’s capital
 
conservation buffer falls below 2.5% (e.g., if the institution’s
 
Common Equity Tier 1 Capital to
Risk-Weighted Assets
 
is less than 7.0%) then capital distributions and discretionary
 
payments will be limited or prohibited based
on the size of the institution’s
 
buffer. The
 
types of payments subject to this limitation include dividends, share
 
buybacks,
discretionary payments on Tier 1 instruments,
 
and discretionary bonus payments.
 
The capital regulations may also impact
 
the treatment of accumulated other comprehensive income,
 
or AOCI, for regulatory
capital purposes. Under the recently implemented rules,
 
AOCI generally flows through to regulatory capital, however,
 
community
banks and their holding companies may make a
 
one-time irrevocable opt-out election to continue to treat AOCI
 
the same as under
the old regulations for regulatory capital purposes. This
 
election was required to be made on the first call report
 
or bank holding
company annual report (on form FR Y-9C)
 
filed after January 1, 2015. We
 
made the opt-out election. Additionally,
 
the new rules
also permit community banks with less than $15 billion in
 
total assets to continue to count certain non-qualifying
 
capital
instruments issued prior to May 19, 2010 as Tier
 
1 capital, including trust preferred securities and cumulative
 
perpetual preferred
stock (subject to a limit of 25% of Tier
 
1 capital). However, non-qualifying capital
 
instruments issued on or after May 19, 2010
do not qualify for Tier 1 capital treatment.
 
 
 
15
In February 2019, the federal bank regulatory agencies issued
 
a final rule (the “2019 CECL Rule”) that revised certain
 
capital
regulations to account for changes to credit loss accounting
 
under accounting principles generally accepted in the
 
United States
("GAAP").
 
The 2019 CECL Rule included a transition option that
 
allows banking organizations to phase in, over
 
a three-year
period, the day-one adverse effects of adopting
 
the new accounting standard related to the measurement of current
 
expected credit
losses (“CECL”) on their regulatory capital ratios (three-year
 
transition option).
 
In March 2020, the federal bank regulatory
agencies issued an interim final rule that maintains
 
the three-year transition option of the 2019 CECL Rule and also
 
provides
banking organizations that were required under
 
GAAP to implement CECL before the end of 2020 the option
 
to delay for two
years an estimate of the effect of CECL on regulatory
 
capital, relative to the incurred loss methodology’s
 
effect on regulatory
capital, followed by a three-year transition period (five-year
 
transition option). We
 
adopted CECL on January 1, 2020 and have
elected to utilize the three-year transition option.
 
Commercial Real Estate Concentration Guidelines
 
 
The federal banking regulators have implemented guidelines to
 
address increased concentrations in commercial real estate loans.
These
 
guidelines describe the criteria regulatory agencies will use as indicators
 
to identify institutions potentially exposed to
commercial real estate concentration risk. An institution
 
that has (i) experienced rapid growth in commercial real estate lending,
(ii) notable exposure to a specific type of
 
commercial real estate, (iii) total reported loans for construction,
 
land development, and
other land representing 100% or more of total risk-based
 
capital, or (iv) total commercial real estate (including construction)
 
loans
representing 300% or more of total risk-based capital
 
and the outstanding balance of the institutions commercial real
 
estate
portfolio has increased by 50% or more in the prior 36
 
months, may be identified for further supervisory analysis of
 
a potential
concentration risk.
 
 
At December 31, 2020, CCB’s ratio
 
of construction, land development and other land loans to
 
total risk-based capital was 65%,
its ratio of total commercial real estate loans to total risk-based
 
capital was 196% and, therefore, CCB was under the 100% and
300% thresholds, respectively,
 
set forth in clauses (iii) and (iv) above.
 
As a result, we are not deemed to have a concentration in
commercial real estate lending under applicable regulatory
 
guidelines.
 
Prompt Corrective Action
 
Federal law and regulations
 
establish a capital-based regulatory scheme designed
 
to promote early intervention for troubled banks
and require the FDIC to choose the least expensive resolution
 
of bank failures. The capital-based regulatory framework
 
contains
five categories of compliance with regulatory capital requirements,
 
including “well capitalized,” “adequately capitalized,”
“undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized,” and
 
“critically undercapitalized.” To
 
qualify as a “well-capitalized”
institution under the rules in effect as of
 
January 1, 2015, a bank must have a leverage ratio of not less than
 
5%, a Tier 1 Common
Equity ratio of not less than 6.5%, a Tier
 
1 Capital ratio of not less than 8%, and a total risk-based capital
 
ratio of not less than
10%, and the bank must not be under any order or
 
directive from the appropriate regulatory agency to meet
 
and maintain a
specific capital level.
 
 
Under the regulations, the applicable agency can treat
 
an institution as if it were in the next lower category if the
 
agency
determines (after notice and an opportunity for hearing)
 
that the institution is in an unsafe or unsound condition or is engaging
 
in
an unsafe or unsound practice. The degree of regulatory
 
scrutiny of a financial institution will increase, and the permissible
activities of the institution will decrease, as it moves downward
 
through the capital categories.
 
Immediately upon becoming undercapitalized, a depository
 
institution becomes subject to the provisions of Section 38
 
of the
Federal Deposit Insurance Act which: (i) restrict payment
 
of capital distributions and management fees; (ii) require that
 
the
appropriate federal banking agency monitor the condition
 
of the institution and its efforts to restore its capital; (iii)
 
require
submission of a capital restoration plan; (iv) restrict the
 
growth of the institution’s assets; and
 
(v) require prior approval of certain
expansion proposals. The appropriate federal banking
 
agency for an undercapitalized institution also may take any number of
discretionary supervisory actions if the agency determines
 
that any of these actions is necessary to resolve the problems of
 
the
institution at the least possible long-term cost to the
 
deposit insurance fund, subject in certain cases to specified procedures.
 
These
discretionary supervisory actions include: (i) requiring
 
the institution to raise additional capital; (ii) restricting transactions
 
with
affiliates; (iii) requiring divestiture of the institution
 
or the sale of the institution to a willing purchaser; and (iv)
 
any other
supervisory action that the agency deems appropriate. These
 
and additional mandatory and permissive supervisory
 
actions may be
taken with respect to significantly undercapitalized
 
and critically undercapitalized institutions.
 
 
 
16
In 2019, the federal banking regulators published final
 
rules implementing a simplified measure of capital adequacy for
 
certain
banking organizations that have less than $10
 
billion in total consolidated assets. Under the final rules,
 
which went into effect on
January 1, 2020, depository institutions and depository institution
 
holding companies that have less than $10 billion in total
consolidated assets and meet other qualifying criteria, including
 
a leverage ratio of greater than 9%, off-balance-sheet
 
exposures
of 25% or less of total consolidated assets and trading
 
assets plus trading liabilities of 5% or less of total consolidated
 
assets, are
deemed “qualifying community banking organizations”
 
and are eligible to opt into the “community bank leverage
 
ratio
framework.” A qualifying community banking organizati
 
on that elects to use the community bank leverage ratio framework
 
and
that maintains a leverage ratio of greater than 9% is considered
 
to have satisfied the generally applicable risk-based and
 
leverage
capital requirements under the Basel III capital rules and,
 
if applicable, is considered to have met the “well capitalized” ratio
requirements for purposes of its primary federal regulator’s
 
prompt corrective action rules, discussed above. The
 
final rules
include a two-quarter grace period during which a qualifying community
 
banking organization that temporarily fails to meet
 
any
of the qualifying criteria, including the greater-than-9%
 
leverage capital ratio requirement, is generally still deemed “well
capitalized” so long as the banking organization
 
maintains
 
a leverage capital ratio greater than 8%. A banking organization
 
that
fails to maintain a leverage capital ratio greater than 8%
 
is not permitted to use the grace period and must comply with
 
the
generally applicable requirements under the Basel III capital
 
rules and file the appropriate regulatory reports.
 
 
Pursuant to the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic
 
Security Act, or CARES Act, the federal banking agencies authorities
adopted a final rule, effective November
 
9, 2020, that (i) reduced the minimum community bank leverage
 
ratio to be deemed
“well capitalized” from 9% to 8% through calendar year 2020,
 
(ii) set the ratio at 8.5% for calendar year 2021, (iii) sets the ratio
back at 9% for 2022 and thereafter,
 
and (ii) gave community banks two-quarter grace period to
 
satisfy the ratio if the ratio falls
out of compliance by no more than 1%. We
 
have not elected to comply with the community bank leverage
 
ratio framework and
will remain subject to the Basel III capital requirements.
 
At December 31, 2020, we exceeded the requirements contained
 
in the applicable regulations, policies and directives pertaining
 
to
capital adequacy to be classified as “well capitalized” and
 
are unaware of any material violation or alleged violation of
 
these
regulations, policies or directives (see table below). Rapid
 
growth, poor loan portfolio performance, or poor earnings
performance, or a combination of these factors, could
 
change our capital position in a relatively short period of
 
time, making
additional capital infusions necessary.
 
Our capital ratios can be found in Note 17 to the Notes to our
 
Consolidated Financial
Statements.
 
Interstate Banking and Branching
 
The Dodd-Frank Act relaxed interstate branching restrictions by
 
modifying the federal statute governing de novo interstate
branching by state member banks. Consequently,
 
a state member bank may open its initial branch in a state
 
outside of the bank’s
home state by way of an interstate bank branch, so long as a
 
bank chartered under the laws of that state would be permitted
 
to
open a branch at that location.
 
 
Anti-money Laundering
 
The USA PATRIOT
 
Act, provides the federal government with additional
 
powers to address terrorist threats through enhanced
domestic security measures, expanded surveillance
 
powers, increased information sharing and broadened anti-money
 
laundering
requirements. By way of amendments to the Bank Secrecy
 
Act, or BSA, the USA PATRIOT
 
Act puts in place measures intended
to encourage information sharing among bank regulatory
 
and law enforcement agencies. In addition, certain provisions
 
of the
USA PATRIOT
 
Act impose affirmative obligations on a broad range
 
of financial institutions.
 
The USA PATRIOT
 
Act and the related Federal Reserve regulations require
 
banks to establish anti-money laundering programs
that include, at a minimum:
 
 
internal policies, procedures and controls designed
 
to implement and maintain the savings association’s
 
compliance with
all of the requirements of the USA PATRIOT
 
Act, the BSA and related laws and regulations;
 
systems and procedures for monitoring and reporting of suspicious
 
transactions and activities;
 
a designated compliance officer;
 
employee training;
 
an independent audit function to test the anti-money laundering
 
program;
 
procedures to verify the identity of each client upon the
 
opening of accounts; and
 
heightened due diligence policies, procedures and
 
controls applicable to certain foreign accounts and relationships.
 
 
17
Additionally, the
 
USA PATRIOT
 
Act requires each financial institution to develop a client identification
 
program, or CIP as part
of its anti-money laundering program. The key components
 
of the CIP are identification, verification, government
 
list
comparison, notice and record retention. The purpose
 
of the CIP is to enable the financial institution to determine
 
the true identity
and anticipated account activity of each client. To
 
make this determination, among other things, the financial institution
 
must
collect certain information from clients at the time they
 
enter into the client relationship with the financial institution.
 
This
information must be verified within a reasonable
 
time. Furthermore, all clients must be screened against any
 
CIP-related
government lists of known or suspected terrorists. In 2018,
 
the U.S. Treasury’s
 
Financial Crimes Enforcement Network issued a
final rule under the BSA requiring banks to identify and verify
 
the identity of the natural persons behind their clients that are legal
entities – the beneficial owners. We
 
and our affiliates have adopted policies, procedures
 
and controls designed to comply with the
BSA and the USA PATRIOT
 
Act.
 
Regulatory Enforcement Authority
 
Federal and state banking laws grant substantial regulatory
 
authority and enforcement powers to federal and state banking
regulators. This authority permits bank regulatory
 
agencies to assess civil money penalties, to issue cease and desist or
 
removal
orders, and to initiate injunctive actions against banking
 
organizations and institution-affiliated parties.
 
In general, these
enforcement actions may be initiated for either violations
 
of laws or regulations or for unsafe or unsound practices.
 
Other actions
or inactions may provide the basis for enforcement action,
 
including misleading or untimely reports filed with regulatory
authorities.
 
 
Privacy
 
A variety of federal and state privacy laws govern the collection,
 
safeguarding, sharing and use of customer information, and
require that financial institutions have policies regarding information
 
privacy and security. The
 
Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act and
related regulations require banks and their affiliated
 
companies to adopt and disclose privacy policies, including
 
policies
regarding the sharing of personal information with
 
third-parties. Some state laws also protect the privacy of information
 
of state
residents and require adequate security of such data,
 
and certain state laws may, in
 
some circumstances, require us to notify
affected individuals of security breaches
 
of computer databases that contain their personal information.
 
These laws may also
require us to notify law enforcement, regulators or consumer
 
reporting agencies in the event of a data breach, as well as
businesses and governmental agencies that own data.
 
Overdraft Fee Regulation
 
 
The Electronic Fund Transfer Act prohibits
 
financial institutions from charging consumers fees for
 
paying overdrafts on
automated teller machines, or ATM,
 
and one-time debit card transactions, unless a consumer consents,
 
or opts in, to the overdraft
service for those type of transactions.
 
If a consumer does not opt in, any ATM
 
transaction or debit that overdraws the consumer’s
account will be denied.
 
Overdrafts on the payment of checks and regular electronic bill
 
payments are not covered by this new
rule.
 
Before opting in, the consumer must be provided a notice that explains
 
the financial institution’s overdraft
 
services,
including the fees associated with the service, and the
 
consumer’s choices.
 
Financial institutions must provide consumers who do
not opt in with the same account terms,
 
conditions and features (including pricing) that they provide
 
to consumers who do opt in.
 
 
Consumer Laws and Regulations
 
CCB is also subject to other federal and state consumer
 
laws and regulations that are designed to protect consumers in
transactions with banks. While the list set forth below
 
is not
 
exhaustive, these laws and regulations include the Truth
 
in Lending
Act, the Truth in Savings Act, the Electronic
 
Fund Transfer Act, the Expedited Funds Availability
 
Act, the Check Clearing for the
21st Century Act, the Fair Credit Reporting Act, the
 
Fair Debt Collection Practices Act, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act,
 
the
Fair Housing Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure
 
Act, the Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act,
 
the Mortgage Disclosure
Improvement Act, and the Real Estate Settlement Procedures
 
Act, among others. These laws and regulations mandate
 
certain
disclosure requirements and regulate the manner
 
in which financial institutions must deal with clients when taking
 
deposits or
making loans to such clients. CCB must comply with the
 
applicable provisions of these consumer protection laws and
 
regulations
as part of its ongoing client relations.
 
 
In addition, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau
 
issues regulations and standards under these federal consumer protection
laws that affect our consumer businesses. These include
 
regulations setting “ability to repay” standards for residential
 
mortgage
loans and mortgage loan servicing and originator compensation
 
standards, which generally require creditors to make a reasonable,
good faith determination of a consumer’s
 
ability to repay any consumer credit transaction secured by a dwelling
 
(excluding an
open-end credit plan, timeshare plan, reverse mortgage,
 
or temporary loan) and establishes certain protections from
 
liability under
this requirement for loans that meet the requirements of the
 
“qualified mortgage” safe harbor.
 
Also, in, 2015, the new TILA-
RESPA Integrated
 
Disclosure, or TRID, rules for mortgage closings took
 
effect for new loan applications. The new TRID rules
were further amended in 2017. These new rules, including
 
the new required loan forms, generally increased the time
 
it takes to
approve mortgage loans.
 
18
 
Future Legislative Developments
 
 
Various
 
bills are from time to time introduced in Congress and the
 
Florida legislature. This legislation may change banking and
tax statutes and the environment in which our banking
 
subsidiary and we operate in substantial and unpredictable ways. We
cannot determine the ultimate effect that
 
potential legislation, if enacted, or implementing regulations with
 
respect thereto, would
have upon our financial condition or results of operations
 
or that of our banking subsidiary.
 
COVID-19 and the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and
 
Economic Security Act
 
In response to the COVID-19 pandemic,
 
the CARES Act was signed into law
 
on March 27, 2020 to provide national
 
emergency
economic relief measures. Many of the
 
CARES Act’s programs are dependent upon the direct
 
involvement of U.S. financial
institutions, such as the Company
 
and the Bank, and have been implemented
 
through rules and guidance adopted
 
by federal
departments and agencies, including
 
the U.S. Department of Treasury,
 
the Federal Reserve and other federal
 
banking agencies,
including those with direct supervisory
 
jurisdiction over the Company and
 
the Bank. Furthermore, as the on-going
 
COVID-19
pandemic evolves, federal regulatory
 
authorities continue to issue additional
 
guidance with respect to the implementation,
 
lifecycle,
and eligibility requirements for
 
the various CARES Act programs as well
 
as industry-specific recovery
 
procedures for COVID-19.
In addition, it is likely that
 
Congress will enact supplementary
 
COVID-19 response legislation,
 
including amendments to the
CARES Act or new bills comparable
 
in scope to the CARES Act. The Company
 
continues to assess the impact
 
of the CARES Act
and other statues, regulations and
 
supervisory guidance related to
 
the COVID-19 pandemic.
 
Paycheck Protection Program
. The CARES Act amended the SBA’s loan program, in which the Bank participates, to create
 
a
guaranteed, unsecured loan program, the
 
PPP, to fund operational costs of eligible businesses, organizations
 
and self-employed
persons during COVID-19. In June 2020,
 
the Paycheck Protection Program
 
Flexibility Act was enacted, which
 
among other things,
gave borrowers additional time and
 
flexibility to use PPP loan proceeds.
 
On June 5, 2020, the Paycheck Protection
 
Program
Flexibility Act (the “Flexibility
 
Act”) was signed into law, and made significant changes
 
to the PPP to provide additional relief
 
for
small businesses. The Flexibility
 
Act increased flexibility for small
 
businesses that have been unable to
 
rehire employees due to
lack of employee availability, or have been unable to
 
operate as normal due to COVID-19
 
related restrictions, extended the
 
period
that businesses have to use PPP
 
funds to qualify for loan forgiveness
 
to 24 weeks, up from 8 weeks under
 
the original rules, and
relaxed the requirements that loan
 
recipients must adhere to in order
 
to qualify for loan forgiveness. In
 
addition, the Flexibility Act
extended the payment deferral period
 
for PPP loans until the date when
 
the amount of loan forgiveness is
 
determined and remitted
to the lender.
 
For PPP recipients who do not apply
 
for forgiveness, the loan deferral
 
period is 10 months after the applicable
forgiveness period ends. On July 4,
 
2020, Congress enacted a new law
 
to extend the deadline for applying
 
for a PPP loan to August
8, 2020. The program was re-opened
 
on January 11, 2021 with updated guidance outlining
 
program changes to enhance its
effectiveness and accessibility. This round of the PPP will
 
serve new borrowers, as well
 
as allow certain existing PPP
 
borrowers to
apply for a second draw PPP Loan
 
and make a request to modify their
 
first draw PPP loan. As a participating
 
lender in the PPP, the
Bank continues to monitor legislative,
 
regulatory, and supervisory developments related thereto.
 
Troubled Debt Restructuring and Loan Modifications for Affected Borrower
s. The CARES Act permitted banks
 
to suspend
requirements under GAAP for loan modifications
 
to borrowers affected by COVID-19 that would
 
otherwise be characterized as
TDRs and suspend any determination related
 
thereto if (i) the loan modification
 
was made between March 1, 2020
 
and the earlier
of December 31, 2020 or 60 days
 
after the end of the COVID-19 emergency
 
declaration, and (ii) the applicable
 
loan was not more
than 30 days past due as of December
 
31, 2019. The federal banking agencies
 
also issued guidance to encourage
 
banks to make
loan modifications for borrowers
 
affected by COVID-19 and to assure banks
 
that they would not be criticized
 
by examiners for
doing so. We applied this guidance to qualifying loan modifications.
 
Main Street Lending Program.
 
The CARES Act encouraged the Federal
 
Reserve, in coordination with
 
the Secretary of the
Treasury, to establish or implement various programs to help
 
midsize businesses, nonprofits,
 
and municipalities. On April 9, 2020,
the Federal Reserve proposed the creation
 
of the Main Street Lending Program
 
(“MSLP”) to implement certain of these
recommendations. The MSLP supports lending
 
to small and medium-sized businesses
 
that were in sound financial condition
 
before
the onset of the COVID-19 pandemic. The
 
MSLP operates through five facilities:
 
the Main Street New Loan Facility, the Main
Street Priority Loan Facility, the Main Street Expanded
 
Loan Facility, the Nonprofit Organization New Loan Facility, and the
Nonprofit Organization Expanded Loan Facility. The Bank continues
 
to monitor developments related thereto.
 
 
19
C
urrent Expected Credit Loss Accounting
 
Standard
 
In 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board, or
 
FASB, issued a new current
 
expected credit loss rule, or CECL, which
required
 
banks to record, at the time of origination, credit losses expected
 
throughout the life of loans held for investment and
held-to-maturity securities, compared to the current practice
 
of recording
 
losses when it is probable that a loss event has occurred.
The update also amended the accounting for credit
 
losses on available-for-sale debt securities and financial
 
assets purchased with
credit deterioration.
 
We adopted this accounting
 
standard effective January 1, 2020.
 
See Note 1 – Significant Accounting
Policies/Adoption of New Accounting Standard for additional
 
information on this standard and its impact on our financial
statements.
 
Effect of Governmental Monetary Policies
 
The commercial banking business is affected not
 
only by general economic conditions, but also by the monetary policies
 
of the
Federal Reserve. Changes in the discount rate on member
 
bank borrowing, availability of borrowing at the “discount
 
window,”
open market operations, changes in the Fed Funds target
 
interest rate, changes in interest rates payable on reserve
 
accounts, the
imposition of changes in reserve requirements against member
 
banks’ deposits and assets of foreign banking centers and
 
the
imposition of and changes in reserve requirements against certain
 
borrowings by banks and their affiliates are some
 
of the
instruments of monetary policy available to the Federal
 
Reserve. These monetary policies are used in varying combinations
 
to
influence overall growth and distributions of bank loans,
 
investments and deposits, which may affect interest
 
rates charged on
loans or paid on deposits. The monetary policies of
 
the Federal Reserve have had a significant effect on the
 
operating results of
commercial banks and are expected to continue to
 
do so in the future. The Federal Reserve’s
 
policies are primarily influenced by
its dual mandate of price stability and full employment,
 
and to a lesser degree by short-term and long-term changes in the
international trade balance and in the fiscal policies of the
 
U.S. Government. Future changes in monetary policy and
 
the effect of
such changes on our business and earnings in the future cannot
 
be predicted.
 
London Inter-Bank Offered Rate (LIBOR)
 
 
We have contracts,
 
including loan agreements, which are currently indexed
 
to LIBOR. The use of LIBOR as a reference rate in
the banking industry is beginning to decline. In 2014,
 
a committee of private-market derivative participants and their
 
regulators,
the Alternative Reference Rate Committee, or ARRC, was convened
 
by the Federal Reserve to identify an alternative reference
interest rate to replace LIBOR.
 
In June 2017, the ARRC announced the Secured Overnight Funding
 
Rate, or SOFR, a broad
measure of the cost of borrowing cash overnight collateralized
 
by Treasury securities, as its preferred
 
alternative to LIBOR.
 
In
July 2017, the Chief Executive of the United Kingdom
 
Financial Conduct Authority,
 
which regulates LIBOR, announced its
intention to stop persuading or compelling banks to submit
 
rates for the calculation of LIBOR to the administrator of LIBOR after
2021.
 
In April 2018, the Federal Reserve Bank of New York
 
began to publish SOFR rates on a daily basis.
 
The International
Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. provided guidance
 
on fallback contract language related to derivative transactions
 
in late
2019.
 
The administrator of LIBOR has proposed to extend publication
 
of the most commonly used U.S. Dollar LIBOR settings to
June 30, 2023, and to cease publishing other LIBOR settings on
 
December 31, 2021.
 
The U.S. federal banking agencies have
issued guidance strongly encouraging banking organizations
 
to cease using U.S. dollar LIBOR as a reference rate
 
in new
contracts as soon as practicable and in any event by December
 
31, 2021.
 
It is not possible to know whether LIBOR will continue
to be viewed as an acceptable market benchmark, what
 
rate or rates may become accepted alternatives to LIBOR or what the
effect of any such changes in views or alternatives
 
may have on the financial markets for LIBOR-linked financial
 
instruments.
 
We are working
 
to ensure that our technology systems are prepared for the
 
transition, our loan documents that reference LIBOR-
based rates have been appropriately amended to reference
 
other methods of interest rate determination, and internal and
 
external
stakeholders are apprised of the transition.
 
Website Access to Company’s
 
Reports
 
Our Internet website is www.ccbg.com.
 
Our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form
 
10-Q, current reports on
Form 8-K, including any amendments to those reports filed
 
or furnished pursuant to section 13(a) or 15(d), and
 
reports filed
pursuant to Section 16, 13(d), and 13(g) of the Exchange
 
Act are available free of charge through our website
 
as soon as
reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed
 
with, or furnished to, the Securities and Exchange Commission.
 
The
information on our website is not incorporated by referenc
 
e
 
into this report.
 
 
 
20
Item 1A.
 
Risk Factors
 
An investment in our common stock contains a high
 
degree of risk. You
 
should consider carefully the following
 
risk factors before
deciding whether to invest in our common stock.
 
Our business, including our operating results and
 
financial condition, could be
harmed by any of these risks. Additional risks and uncertainties not
 
currently known to us or that we currently
 
deem to be
immaterial also may materially and adversely affect our
 
business. The trading price of our common stock could decline
 
due to
any of these risks, and you may lose all or part of your investment.
 
In assessing these risks, you should also refer
 
to the other
information contained in our filings with the SEC, including
 
our financial statements and related
 
notes.
 
Macroeconomic Risks
 
The impact of the COVID-19 pandemic on our customers, associates
 
and business operations has had, and will likely
continue to have, a significant adverse effect
 
on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
The COVID-19 pandemic created a global public
 
-health crisis that resulted in challenging economic conditions for
 
households
and businesses.
 
The economic impact of the COVID-19 pandemic impacted
 
a broad range of industries.
 
There is increasing
concern about the longer lasting impact on local business resulting
 
from the COVID-19 pandemic.
 
 
The Federal Reserve returned to a zero-interest rate policy
 
in March 2020 and the U.S. government enacted several fiscal stimulus
measures to counteract the economic disruption caused
 
by the COVID-19 pandemic and provide economic
 
assistance to
businesses and households. The dramatic lowering of
 
market interest rates in a short period of time had an adverse
 
effect on the
Company's asset yields.
 
The majority of the fiscal assistance provided
 
by the federal government to businesses and households
tapered off by December 31, 2020, which could
 
adversely impact the ability of borrowers to repay their loans. The
 
Company's
financial performance is dependent upon the ability of
 
borrowers to repay their loans.
 
 
The COVID-19 pandemic resulted in changes to our business operations
 
during the current year and could continue to result in
changes to operations in future periods.
 
Depending on the severity and length of the COVID-19 pandemic, which
 
is impossible to
predict, we could experience significant disruptions in our
 
business operations if key personnel or a significant number of
employees were to become unavailable due to the effects
 
of, and restrictions resulting from, the COVID-19 pandemic,
 
as well as
decreased demand for our products and services.
 
 
There is pervasive uncertainty surrounding the future
 
economic conditions that will emerge in the months and
 
years following the
start of the COVID-19 pandemic.
 
As a result, management is confronted with a significant degree
 
of uncertainty in estimating the
impact of the pandemic on credit quality,
 
revenues and asset values.
 
Asset quality may deteriorate and the amount of our
allowance for loan losses may not be sufficient
 
for future loan losses we may experience.
 
This could require us to increase our
reserves and recognize more expense in future periods.
 
The changes in market rates of interest and the impact
 
that has on our
ability to price our products may reduce our net interest income
 
in the future or negatively impact the demand for our products.
 
There is some risk that operational costs could further increase as we
 
maintain existing facilities in accordance with health
guidelines as well as have associates continue to work
 
remotely.
 
 
The extent to which the COVID-19 pandemic impacts our
 
business, results of operations and financial condition, as well as
 
our
regulatory capital and liquidity ratios, will depend on future developments,
 
which are highly uncertain and cannot be predicted,
including the scope and duration of the COVID-19 pandemic
 
and actions taken by governmental authorities and other
 
third
parties in response to the pandemic.
 
 
We may incur losses if we are
 
unable to successfully manage interest rate
 
risk.
 
Our profitability depends to a large extent
 
on Capital City Bank’s net
 
interest income, which is the difference between
 
income on
interest-earning assets, such as loans and investment securities,
 
and expense on interest-bearing liabilities such as deposits and
borrowings. We
 
are unable to predict changes in market interest rates, which are
 
affected by many factors beyond our control,
including inflation, recession, unemployment, federal funds
 
target rate, money supply,
 
domestic and international events and
changes in the United States and other financial markets.
 
Our net interest income may be reduced if: (i) more interest-earning
assets than interest-bearing liabilities reprice or mature
 
during a time when interest rates are declining or (ii) more
 
interest-bearing
liabilities than interest-earning assets reprice or mature
 
during a time when interest rates are rising.
 
 
 
21
Changes in the difference between short
 
-term and long-term interest rates may also harm our
 
business. We generally
 
use short-
term deposits to fund longer-term assets. When
 
interest rates change, assets and liabilities with shorter terms
 
reprice more quickly
than those with longer terms, which could have
 
a material adverse effect on our net interest margin.
 
If market interest rates rise
rapidly, interest rate
 
adjustment caps may also limit increases in the interest rates on
 
adjustable rate loans, which could further
reduce our net interest income. Additionally,
 
we believe that due to the recent historical low interest rate environment,
 
the effects
of the repeal of Regulation Q, which previously had prohibited
 
the payment of interest on demand deposits by member
 
banks of
the Federal Reserve System, have not been realized. The
 
increased price competition for deposits that may result upon
 
the return
to a historically normal interest rate environment could
 
adversely affect net interest margins of community
 
banks.
 
Although we continuously monitor interest rates and
 
have a number of tools to manage our interest rate risk
 
exposure, changes in
market assumptions regarding future interest rates could
 
significantly impact our interest rate risk strategy,
 
our financial position
and results of operations. If we do not properly monitor
 
our interest rate risk management strategies, these activities may not
effectively mitigate our interest rate sensitivity or
 
have the desired impact on our results of operations or financial
 
condition.
 
Interest rates and economic conditions affect
 
consumer demand for housing and can create volatility in the mortgage
 
industry.
 
These risk can have a material impact on the volume of mortgage
 
originations and refinancings, adversely affecting
 
our mortgage
banking revenues and the profitability of our mortgage
 
banking business.
 
 
We may be adversely
 
affected by changes in the method of determining LIBOR, or
 
the replacement of LIBOR with an
alternative reference rate.
 
 
Our business relies upon loans and other financial instruments that
 
are directly or indirectly dependent on LIBOR to establish
their interest rate and/or value. The administrator of LIBOR has
 
proposed to extend publication of the most commonly
 
used U.S.
Dollar LIBOR settings to June 30, 2023 and to cease
 
publishing other LIBOR settings on December 31, 2021.
 
The U.S. federal
banking agencies have issued guidance strongly encouraging
 
banking organizations to cease using U.S. dollar
 
LIBOR as a
reference rate in new contracts as soon as practicable
 
and in any event by December 31, 2021. We
 
do not know whether LIBOR
will continue to be viewed as an acceptable market benchmark,
 
what rate or rates may become accepted alternatives to LIBOR, or
what the effect of any such changes in views
 
or alternatives may have on the financial markets for LIBOR-linked
 
financial
instruments. The transition from LIBOR may cause us to
 
incur increased costs and face additional risks. Uncertainty
 
as to the
nature of alternative reference rates and as to potential
 
changes in or other reforms to LIBOR may adversely affect
 
LIBOR rates
and the value of LIBOR-based loans originated prior
 
to 2021. If LIBOR rates are no longer available, any successor or
replacement interest rates may perform differently,
 
which may affect our net interest income, change
 
our market risk profile and
require changes to our strategies. Any failure to adequately
 
manage this transition could adversely impact our
 
reputation.
 
Risks Related to Lending Activities
 
Our loan portfolio includes loans with a higher risk of
 
loss which could lead to higher loan losses and nonperforming
assets.
 
 
We originate
 
commercial real estate loans, commercial loans, construction loans,
 
vacant land loans, consumer loans, and
residential mortgage loans primarily within our market
 
area. Commercial real estate, commercial, construction, vacant
 
land, and
consumer loans may expose a lender to greater credit risk
 
than traditional fixed-rate fully amortizing loans secured
 
by single-
family residential real estate because the collateral securin
 
g
 
these loans may not be sold as easily as single-family residential real
estate. In addition, these loan types tend to involve larger
 
loan balances to a single borrower or groups of related borrowers and
are more susceptible to a risk of loss during a downturn
 
in the business cycle. These loans also have historically had
 
greater credit
risk than other loans for the following reasons:
 
 
Commercial Real Estate Loans
. Repayment is dependent on income being generated
 
in amounts sufficient to cover
operating expenses and debt service. These loans also involve
 
greater risk because they are generally not fully amortizing
over the loan period, but rather have a balloon payment due
 
at maturity. A borrower’s
 
ability to make a balloon payment
typically will depend on the borrower’s ability
 
to either refinance the loan or timely sell the underlying property.
 
At
December 31, 2020,
 
commercial mortgage loans comprised approximately 32.3% of
 
our total loan portfolio.
 
 
Commercial Loans
. Repayment is generally dependent upon the successful
 
operation of the borrower’s business. In
addition, the collateral securing the loans may depreciate
 
over time, be difficult to appraise, be illiquid,
 
or fluctuate in
value based on the success of the business. At December
 
31, 2020, commercial loans comprised approximately 19.6% of
our total loan portfolio.
 
 
22
 
Construction Loans
. The risk of loss is largely dependent
 
on our initial estimate of whether the property’s
 
value at
completion equals or exceeds the cost of property construction
 
and the availability of take-out financing. During the
construction phase, a number of factors can result in delays or
 
cost overruns. If our estimate is inaccurate or if actual
construction costs exceed estimates, the value of the property
 
securing our loan may be insufficient to ensure
 
full
repayment when completed through a permanent
 
loan, sale of the property,
 
or by seizure of collateral.
 
At December 31,
2020 construction loans comprised approximately 6.8% of
 
our total loan portfolio.
 
 
Vacant
 
Land Loans
. Because vacant or unimproved land is generally
 
held by the borrower for investment purposes or
future use, payments on loans secured by vacant or unimproved
 
land will typically rank lower in priority to the borrower
than a loan the borrower may have on their primary
 
residence or business. These loans are susceptible to adverse
conditions in the real estate market and local economy.
 
At December 31, 2020,
 
vacant land loans comprised
approximately 2.7% of our total loan portfolio.
 
 
HELOCs
. Our open-ended home equity loans have an interest-only
 
draw period followed by a five-year repayment
period of 0.75% of the principal balance monthly and a
 
balloon payment at maturity.
 
Upon the commencement of the
repayment period, the monthly payment can increase significantly,
 
thus, there is a heightened risk that the borrower will
be unable to pay the increased payment. Further,
 
these loans also involve greater risk because they are generally
 
not fully
amortizing over the loan period, but rather have a balloon
 
payment due at maturity.
 
A borrower’s ability to make a
balloon payment may depend on the borrower’s
 
ability to either refinance the loan or timely sell the underlying
 
property.
 
At December 31, 2020 HELOCs comprised approximately
 
10.2%
 
of our total loan portfolio.
 
 
Consumer Loans
. Consumer loans (such as automobile loans and
 
personal lines of credit) are collateralized, if at all,
with assets that may not provide an adequate source of
 
payment of the loan due to depreciation, damage, or
 
loss. At
December 31, 2020,
 
consumer loans comprised approximately 13.5%
 
of our total loan portfolio, with indirect auto loans
making up a majority of this portfolio at approximately
 
90.4% of the total balance.
 
The increased risks associated with these types of
 
loans result in a correspondingly higher probability of
 
default on such loans (as
compared to fixed-rate fully amortizing single-family
 
real estate loans). Loan defaults would likely increase our loan
 
losses and
nonperforming assets and could adversely affect
 
our allowance for loan losses and our results of operations
 
.
 
Our loan portfolio is heavily concentrated in mortgage
 
loans secured by properties in Florida and Georgia
 
which causes
our risk of loss to be higher than if we had a more
 
geographically diversified portfolio.
 
Our interest-earning assets are heavily concentrated in mortgage
 
loans secured by real estate, particularly real estate located in
Florida and Georgia.
 
At December 31, 2020, approximately 67%
 
of our loans included real estate as a primary,
 
secondary, or
tertiary component of collateral. The real estate collateral
 
in each case provides an alternate source of repayment in
 
the event of
default by the borrower; however,
 
the value of the collateral may decline during the time the credit
 
is extended. If we are required
to liquidate the collateral securing a loan during
 
a period of reduced real estate values to satisfy the debt, our earnings
 
and capital
could be adversely affected.
 
Additionally, at
 
December 31, 2020, substantially all of our loans secured by real
 
estate are secured by commercial and residential
properties located in Northern Florida and Middle Georgia.
 
The concentration of our loans in these areas subjects us to
 
risk that a
downturn in the economy or recession in these areas could
 
result in a decrease in loan originations and increases in delinquencies
and foreclosures, which would more greatly affect
 
us than if our lending were more geographically diversified.
 
In addition, since
a large portion of our portfolio is secured by
 
properties located in Florida and Georgia, the
 
occurrence of a natural disaster, such
as a hurricane, or a man-made disaster could result in
 
a decline in loan originations, a decline in the value or destruction
 
of
mortgaged properties and an increase in the risk of delinquencies,
 
foreclosures or loss on loans originated by us. We
 
may suffer
further losses due to the decline in the value of the properties
 
underlying our mortgage loans, which would have an adverse
impact on our results of operations and financial condition.
 
Our concentration in loans secured by real
 
estate may increase our credit losses, which
 
would negatively affect our
financial results.
 
Due to the lack of diversified industry within the markets
 
served by CCB and the relatively close proximity of our geographic
markets, we have both geographic concentrations as well as concentrations
 
in the types of loans funded. Specifically,
 
due to the
nature of our markets, a significant portion of the portfolio
 
has historically been secured with real estate. At December
 
31, 2020,
approximately 32%
 
and 28% of our $2.006 billion loan portfolio was secured by commercial
 
real estate and residential real estate,
respectively. As of
 
this same date, approximately 7% was secured by property under
 
construction.
 
 
23
In the event we are required to foreclose on a property securing
 
one of our mortgage loans or otherwise pursue our remedies in
order to protect our investment, we may be unable
 
to recover funds in an amount equal to our projected return
 
on our investment
or in an amount sufficient to prevent a loss to
 
us due to prevailing economic conditions, real estate values and
 
other factors
associated with the ownership of real property.
 
As a result, the market value of the real estate or other collateral
 
underlying our
loans may not, at any given time, be sufficient
 
to satisfy the outstanding principal amount of the loans, and consequently,
 
we
would sustain loan losses.
 
An inadequate allowance for credit losses would
 
reduce our earnings.
 
We are exposed
 
to the risk that our clients may be unable to repay their loans
 
according to their terms and that any collateral
securing the payment of their loans may not be sufficient
 
to assure full repayment. This could result in credit losses that are
inherent in the lending business. We
 
evaluate the collectability of our loan portfolio
 
and provide an allowance for credit losses
that we believe is adequate based upon such factors as:
 
 
the risk characteristics of various classifications of loans;
 
previous loan loss experience;
 
specific loans that have loss potential;
 
delinquency trends;
 
estimated fair market value of the collateral;
 
current and future economic conditions; and
 
geographic and industry loan concentrations.
 
At December 31, 2020, our allowance for credit losses was $23.8
 
million, which represented approximately 1.19%
 
of our total
loans held for investment.
 
We had $5.9
 
million in nonaccruing loans at December 31, 2020.
 
The allowance is based on
management’s reasonable
 
estimate and may not prove sufficient to cover future
 
loan losses.
 
Although management uses the best
information available to make determinations with respect
 
to the allowance for credit losses, future adjustments may be
 
necessary
if economic conditions differ substantially from
 
the assumptions used or adverse developments arise with respect to our
nonperforming or performing loans.
 
In addition, regulatory agencies, as an integral part of their
 
examination process, periodically
review our estimated losses on loans.
 
Our regulators may require us to recognize additional losses based
 
on their judgments about
information available to them at the time of their examination.
 
Accordingly, the allowance
 
for credit losses may not be adequate
to cover all future loan losses and significant increases to
 
the allowance may be required in the future if, for
 
example, economic
conditions worsen.
 
A material increase in our allowance for credit losses would adversely
 
impact our net income and capital in
future periods, while having the effect
 
of overstating our current period earnings.
 
Liquidity risk could impair our ability to fund operations and
 
jeopardize our financial condition.
 
 
Effective liquidity management is essential for the
 
operation of our business. We
 
require sufficient liquidity to meet client loan
requests, client deposit maturities and withdrawals, payments
 
on our debt obligations as they come due and other cash
commitments under both normal operating conditions and
 
other unpredictable circumstances causing industry or
 
general financial
market stress. If we are unable to raise funds through
 
deposits, borrowings, earnings and other sources,
 
it could have a substantial
negative effect on our liquidity.
 
In particular, a majority of our liabilities
 
during 2020 were checking accounts and other liquid
deposits, which are generally payable on demand
 
or upon short notice. By comparison, a substantial majority
 
of our assets were
loans, which cannot generally be called or sold in the
 
same time frame. Although we have historically been able to replace
maturing deposits and advances as necessary,
 
we might not be able to replace such funds in the future,
 
especially if a large
number of our depositors seek to withdraw their accounts
 
at the same time, regardless of the reason. Our access to funding
sources in amounts adequate to finance our activities on
 
terms that are acceptable to us could be impaired by factors that
 
affect us
specifically or the financial services industry or economy
 
in general. Factors that could negatively impact our access
 
to liquidity
sources include a decrease in the level of our business activity
 
as a result of a downturn in the markets in which our loans
 
are
concentrated, adverse regulatory action against us, or
 
our inability to attract and retain deposits. Our ability to borrow
 
could also
be impaired by factors that are not specific to us, such
 
as a disruption in the financial markets or negative views and
 
expectations
about the prospects for the financial services industry.
 
If we are unable to maintain adequate liquidity,
 
it could materially and
adversely affect our business, results of operations
 
or financial condition.
 
We may incur significant
 
costs associated with the ownership of real property
 
as a result of foreclosures, which could
reduce our net income.
 
Since we originate loans secured by real estate, we may
 
have to foreclose on the collateral property to protect our investment
 
and
may thereafter own and operate such property,
 
in which case we would be exposed to the risks inherent
 
in the ownership of real
estate.
 
 
 
 
24
The amount that we, as a mortgagee, may realize after
 
a foreclosure is dependent upon factors outside
 
of our control, including,
but not limited to:
 
 
general or local economic conditions;
 
environmental cleanup liability;
 
neighborhood values;
 
interest rates;
 
real estate tax rates;
 
operating expenses of the mortgaged properties;
 
supply of and demand for rental units or properties;
 
ability to obtain and maintain adequate occupancy of the
 
properties;
 
zoning laws;
 
governmental rules, regulations and fiscal policies; and
 
acts of God.
 
Certain expenditures associated with the ownership
 
of real estate, including real estate taxes, insurance and maintenance
 
costs,
may adversely affect the income from the real
 
estate. Furthermore, we may need to advance funds to continue
 
to operate or to
protect these assets. As a result, the cost of operating
 
real property assets may exceed the rental income earned
 
from such
properties or we may be required to dispose of the real property
 
at a loss.
 
Cybersecurity and Technology
 
Risks
 
We process, maintain,
 
and transmit confidential client information through
 
our information technology systems, such as
our online banking service.
 
Cybersecurity issues, such as security breaches and computer
 
viruses, affecting our
information technology systems or fraud related
 
to our debit card products could disrupt our business, result
 
in the
unintended disclosure or misuse of confidential or
 
proprietary information, damage our reputation,
 
increase our costs,
and cause losses.
 
We collect and
 
store sensitive data, including our proprietary business information
 
and that of our clients, and personally
identifiable information of our clients and employees, in
 
our
information technology systems
.
We also provide
 
our clients the
ability to bank online.
The secure processing, maintenance, and transmission of
 
this information is critical to our operations.
 
Our
network, or those of our clients, could be vulnerable to
 
unauthorized access, computer viruses, phishing schemes and
 
other
security problems.
 
Financial institutions and companies engaged in data processing
 
have increasingly reported breaches in the
security of their websites or other systems, some of which
 
have involved sophisticated and targeted attacks intended
 
to obtain
unauthorized access to confidential information, destroy
 
data, disrupt or degrade service, sabotage systems or cause
 
other damage.
 
We may be
 
required to spend significant capital and other resources to
 
protect against the threat of security breaches and
computer viruses or to alleviate problems caused by
 
security breaches or viruses.
 
Security breaches and viruses could expose us to
claims, litigation and other possible liabilities. Any inability
 
to prevent security breaches or computer viruses could
 
also cause
existing clients to lose confidence in our systems and
 
could adversely affect our reputation and our ability
 
to generate deposits.
 
Additionally, fraud
 
losses related to debit and credit cards have risen in recent years due
 
in large part to growing and evolving
schemes to illegally use cards or steal consumer credit card
 
information despite risk management practices employed
 
by the debit
and credit card industries. Many issuers of debit and
 
credit cards have suffered significant losses in recent years due
 
to the theft of
cardholder data that has been illegally exploited for
 
personal gain.
 
The potential for debit and credit card fraud against us or
 
our clients and our third-party service providers is a serious
 
issue. Debit
and credit card fraud is pervasive and the risks of
 
cybercrime are complex and continue to evolve. In view
 
of the recent high-
profile retail data breaches involving client personal and
 
financial information, the potential impact on us and any exposure
 
to
consumer losses and the cost of technology investments
 
to improve security could cause losses to us or our clients,
 
damage to our
brand, and an increase in our costs.
 
Investment Risks
 
The fair value of our investments could decline which would cause
 
a reduction in shareowners’ equity.
 
A large portion of our investment securities portfolio
 
at December 31, 2020 has been designated as available-for-sale
 
pursuant to
U.S. generally accepted accounting principles relating
 
to accounting for investments. Such principles require that
 
unrealized gains
and losses in the estimated value of the available-for-sale
 
portfolio be “marked to market” and reflected as a separate
 
item in
shareowners’ equity (net of tax) as accumulated
 
other comprehensive income/losses. Shareowners’ equity will
 
continue to reflect
the unrealized gains and losses (net of tax) of these investments.
 
The fair value of our investment portfolio may decline, causing
 
a
corresponding decline in shareowners’ equity.
 
 
25
 
Management believes that several factors will affect
 
the fair values of our investment portfolio. These include, but are
 
not limited
to, changes in interest rates or expectations of changes
 
in interest rates, the degree of volatility in the securities markets,
 
inflation
rates or expectations of inflation and the slope of the
 
interest rate yield curve (the yield curve refers to the differences
 
between
short-term and long-term interest rates; a positively sloped yield
 
curve means short-term rates are lower than long-term rates).
These and other factors may impact specific categories
 
of the portfolio differently,
 
and we cannot predict the effect these factors
may have on any specific category.
 
Regulatory and Legislative Risks
 
We are subject to
 
extensive regulation, which could restrict
 
our activities and impose financial requirements
 
or limitations
on the conduct of our business.
 
We are subject
 
to extensive regulation, supervision and examination
 
by our regulators, including the Florida Office
 
of Financial
Regulation, the Federal Reserve, and the FDIC. Our
 
compliance with these industry regulations is costly and restricts
 
certain of
our activities, including payment of dividends, mergers
 
and acquisitions, investments, lending and interest rates charged
 
on loans,
interest rates paid on deposits, access to capital and brokered
 
deposits and locations of banking offices. If
 
we are unable to meet
these regulatory requirements, our financial condition,
 
liquidity and results of operations would be materially and adversely
affected.
 
Our activities are also regulated under consumer protection
 
laws applicable to our lending, deposit and other activities. Many
 
of
these regulations are intended primarily for the
 
protection of our depositors and the Deposit Insurance
 
Fund and not for the
benefit of our shareowners. In addition to the regulations
 
of the bank regulatory agencies, as a member of the Federal
 
Home Loan
Bank, we must also comply with applicable regulations
 
of the Federal Housing Finance Agency and the Federal Home Loan
Bank.
 
Our failure to comply with these laws and regulations
 
could subject us to restrictions on our business activities, fines and
 
other
penalties, any of which could adversely affect
 
our results of operations, capital base and the price of our
 
securities. Further, any
new laws, rules and regulations could make compliance
 
more difficult or expensive or otherwise adversely
 
affect our business and
financial condition. Please refer to the Section entitled “Business
 
– Regulatory Considerations” on page 9.
 
U.S. federal banking agencies may require
 
us to increase our regulatory capital,
 
long-term debt or liquidity requirements,
which could result in the need to issue additional qualifying
 
securities or to take other actions, such as to sell company
assets.
 
We are subject
 
to U.S. regulatory capital and liquidity rules. These rules,
 
among other things, establish minimum requirements to
qualify as a well-capitalized institution. If CCB fails to maintain
 
its status as well capitalized under the applicable regulatory
capital rules, the Federal Reserve will require us to agree
 
to bring the bank back to well-capitalized status. For the duration
 
of
such an agreement, the Federal Reserve may impose restrictions
 
on our activities. If we were to fail to enter into or comply with
such an agreement, or fail to comply with the terms of
 
such agreement, the Federal Reserve may impose more severe restrictions
on our activities, including requiring us to cease and
 
desist activities permitted under the Bank Holding Company
 
Act of 1956.
 
Capital and liquidity requirements are frequently introduced
 
and amended. It is possible that regulators may increase
 
regulatory
capital requirements, change how regulatory capital is calculated
 
or increase liquidity requirements.
 
 
In 2013, the Federal Reserve Board released its final rules
 
which implement in the United States the Basel III regulatory
 
capital
reforms from the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision
 
and certain changes required by the Dodd-Frank Act. Under
 
the final
rule, minimum requirements increased for both the quality
 
and quantity of capital held by banking organizations.
 
Consistent with
the international Basel framework, the rule includes a new
 
minimum ratio of Common Equity Tier
 
1 Capital, or CET1, to Risk-
Weighted Assets, or
 
RWA,
 
of 4.5% and a CET1 conservation buffer
 
of 2.5% of RWA
 
(which was fully phased-in in 2019) that
apply to all supervised financial institutions.
 
The CET1 conservation buffer requirement
 
requires us to hold additional CET1
capital in excess of the minimum required to meet the CET1 to
 
RWA
 
ratio requirement. The rule also, among other
 
things, raised
the minimum ratio of Tier 1 Capital to
 
RWA
 
from 4% to 6% and included a minimum leverage ratio
 
of 4% for all banking
organizations. The impact of the new capital
 
rules requires us to maintain higher levels of capital, which
 
we expect will lower our
return on equity.
 
Additionally, if our CET1
 
to RWA
 
ratio does not exceed the minimum required plus the additional
 
CET1
conservation buffer,
 
we may be restricted in our ability to pay dividends or make other
 
distributions of capital to our shareowners.
 
Further changes to and compliance with the regulatory
 
capital and liquidity requirements may impact our operations
 
by requiring
us to liquidate assets, increase borrowings, issue additional
 
equity or other securities, cease or alter certain operations, sell
company assets or hold highly liquid assets, which may
 
adversely affect our results of operations. We
 
may be prohibited from
taking capital actions such as paying or increasing dividends
 
or repurchasing securities.
 
 
 
26
Changes in accounting standards or assumptions in applying
 
accounting policies could adversely affect us.
 
Our accounting policies and methods are fundamental to
 
how we record and report our financial condition and results of
operations. Some of these policies require use of estimates and
 
assumptions that may affect the reported value of
 
our assets or
liabilities and results of operations and are critical because
 
they require management to make difficult, subjective
 
and complex
judgments about matters that are inherently uncertain.
 
If those assumptions, estimates or judgments were incorrectly
 
made, we
could be required to correct and restate prior-period financial
 
statements. Accounting standard-setters and those who
 
interpret the
accounting standards, the SEC, banking regulators and our
 
independent registered public accounting firm may also amend or
 
even
reverse their previous interpretations or positions on how
 
various standards should be applied. These changes may be difficult
 
to
predict and could impact how we prepare and report
 
our financial statements. In some cases, we could be
 
required to apply a new
or revised standard retrospectively,
 
resulting in us revising prior-period financial statements.
 
 
Florida financial institutions, such as CCB, face a
 
higher risk of noncompliance and enforcement actions with
 
the Bank
Secrecy Act and other anti-money laundering
 
statutes and regulations.
 
 
Since September 11, 2001, banking
 
regulators have intensified their focus on anti-money laundering
 
and Bank Secrecy Act
compliance requirements, particularly the anti-money laundering
 
provisions of the USA PATRIOT
 
Act. There is also increased
scrutiny of compliance with the rules enforced by the
 
Office of Foreign Assets Control, or OFAC.
 
Since 2004, federal banking
regulators and examiners have been extremely aggressive
 
in their supervision and examination of financial institutions located
 
in
the State of Florida with respect to the institution’s
 
Bank Secrecy Act/anti-money laundering compliance. Consequently,
numerous formal enforcement actions have been instituted
 
against financial institutions. If CCB’s po
 
licies, procedures and
systems are deemed deficient or the policies, procedures
 
and systems of the financial institutions that it has already
 
acquired or
may acquire in the future are deficient, CCB would be subject
 
to liability, including
 
fines and regulatory actions such as
restrictions on its ability to pay dividends and the necessity
 
to obtain regulatory approvals to proceed with certain
 
aspects of its
business plan, including its acquisition plans.
 
Structural and Organizational Risks
 
Our directors, executive officers, and principal
 
shareowners, if acting together,
 
have substantial control over all matters
requiring shareowner approval,
 
including changes of control. Because Mr.
 
William G. Smith, Jr.
 
is a principal
shareowner and our Chairman, President,
 
and Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of CCB, he
 
has substantial control
over all matters on a day to day basis.
 
Our directors, executive officers, and principal
 
shareowners beneficially owned approximately 20.1% of the
 
outstanding shares of
our common stock at December 31, 2020.
 
William G. Smith, Jr.,
 
our Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer
beneficially owned 17.1% of our shares as of that date.
 
Accordingly, these directors,
 
executive officers, and principal
shareowners, if acting together,
 
may be able to influence or control matters requiring approval
 
by our shareowners, including the
election of directors and the approval of mergers,
 
acquisitions or other extraordinary transactions. Moreover,
 
because William G.
Smith, Jr. is the Chairman,
 
President, and Chief Executive Officer of CCBG and Chairman
 
of CCB, he has substantial control
over all matters on a day-to-day basis, including the
 
nomination and election of directors.
 
These directors, executive officers, and
 
principal shareowners may also have interests that differ
 
from yours and may vote in a
way with which you disagree and which may be adverse
 
to your interests. The concentration of ownership may have the effect
 
of
delaying, preventing or deterring a change of control
 
of our company, could deprive
 
our shareowners of an opportunity to receive
a premium for their common stock as part of a sale of
 
our Company and might ultimately affect the
 
market price of our common
stock. You
 
may also have difficulty changing management, the composition
 
of the Board of Directors, or the general direction of
our Company.
 
Our Articles of Incorporation, Bylaws, and certain laws and
 
regulations may prevent or delay
 
transactions you might
favor,
 
including a sale or merger of CCBG.
 
CCBG is registered with the Federal Reserve as a financial
 
holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act, or
 
BHC Act.
As a result, we are subject to supervisory regulation
 
and examination by the Federal Reserve. The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act,
 
the
BHC Act, and other federal laws subject financial holding
 
companies to particular restrictions on the types of activities in
 
which
they may engage, and to a range of supervisory requirements and
 
activities, including regulatory enforcement actions for
violations of laws and regulations.
 
Provisions of our Articles of Incorporation, Bylaws, certain
 
laws and regulations and various other factors may make
 
it more
difficult and expensive for companies or persons
 
to acquire control of us without the consent of our Board of
 
Directors. It is
possible, however, that you would
 
want a takeover attempt to succeed because, for example, a potential
 
buyer could offer a
premium over the then prevailing price of our common
 
stock.
 
 
 
27
For example, our Articles of Incorporation permit our
 
Board of Directors to issue preferred stock without shareowner
 
action. The
ability to issue preferred stock could discourage a company
 
from attempting to obtain control of us by means of a tender
 
offer,
merger, proxy contest or
 
otherwise. Additionally, although
 
there is a proposal to declassify our Board of Directors that
 
is to be
voted upon and potentially implemented at our 2021 annual
 
meeting of shareowners, our Articles of Incorporation
 
and Bylaws
currently divide our Board of Directors into three classes, as nearly
 
equal in size as possible, with staggered three-year terms. One
class is elected each year.
 
The classification of our Board of Directors could make it more
 
difficult for a company to acquire
control of us. We
 
are also subject to certain provisions of the Florida Business Corporation
 
Act and our Articles of Incorporation
that relate to business combinations with interested shareowners.
 
Other provisions in our Articles of Incorporation or
 
Bylaws that
may discourage takeover attempts or make them more
 
difficult include:
 
 
Supermajority voting requirements to remove a director from office;
 
 
Provisions regarding the timing and content of shareowner
 
proposals and nominations;
 
Supermajority voting requirements to amend Articles of Incorporation
 
unless approval is received by a majority of
“disinterested directors”
 
Absence of cumulative voting; and
 
Inability for shareowners to take action by written consent.
 
 
General Risks
 
 
Risk of Pandemic.
 
In recent years the outbreak of a number of diseases including
 
COVID-19, Avian
 
Bird Flu, H1N1, and various other "super bugs"
have increased the risk of a pandemic. As seen with the
 
ongoing COVID-19 pandemic and prior pandemics, global
 
events like
these could impact interest rates, energy
 
prices, the value of financial assets and ultimately economic
 
activity in our markets.
 
The
adverse effect of these events may include narrowing
 
of the spread between interest income and expense, a
 
reduction in fee
income, an increase in credit losses, and a decrease in
 
demand for loans and other products and services.
 
We may be unable to
 
pay dividends in the future.
 
In 2020, our Board of Directors declared four quarterly
 
cash dividends. Declarations of any future dividends will be contingent
 
on
our ability to earn sufficient profits and
 
to remain well capitalized, including our ability to hold and generate
 
sufficient capital to
comply with the CET1 conservation buffer
 
requirement. In addition, due to our contractual obligations
 
with the holders of our
trust preferred securities, if we defer the payment of accrued
 
interest owed to the holders of our trust preferred securities,
 
we may
not make dividend payments to our shareowners.
 
Further, under applicable statutes and
 
regulations, CCB’s board
 
of directors, after charging-off bad debts,
 
depreciation and other
worthless assets, if any,
 
and making provisions for reasonably anticipated future losses on
 
loans and other assets, may quarterly,
semi-annually,
 
or annually declare and pay dividends to CCBG of up
 
to the aggregate net income of that period combined with
the CCB’s retained net
 
income for the preceding two years and, with the approval
 
of the Florida Office of Financial Regulation
and Federal Reserve, declare a dividend from retained net
 
income which accrued prior to the preceding
 
two years.
 
Additional
state laws generally applicable to Florida corporations may
 
also limit our ability to declare and pay dividends. Thus, our ability to
fund future dividends may be restricted by state and
 
federal laws and regulations.
 
 
 
28
Our future success is dependent on our ability
 
to compete effectively in the highly competitive banking
 
industry.
 
We face vigorous
 
competition for deposits, loans and other financial services in
 
our market area from other banks and financial
institutions, including savings and loan associations, savings
 
banks, finance companies and credit unions. A number
 
of our
competitors
 
are significantly larger than we are and have greater access
 
to capital and other resources. Many of our competitors
also have higher lending limits, more expansive branch
 
networks, and offer a wider array of financial
 
products and services. To
 
a
lesser extent, we also compete with other providers of
 
financial services, such as money market mutual funds, brokerage
 
firms,
consumer finance companies, insurance companies and
 
governmental organizations, which may offer
 
financial products and
services on more favorable terms than we are able
 
to. Many of our non-bank competitors are not subject to the same extensive
regulations that govern our activities. As a result, these non
 
-bank competitors have advantages over us in providing certain
services. The effect of this competition may
 
reduce or limit our margins or our market share and
 
may adversely affect our results
of operations and financial condition.
 
Limited trading activity for shares of our common
 
stock may contribute to price volatility.
 
While our common stock is listed and traded on the
 
Nasdaq Global Select Market, there has historically been limited
 
trading
activity in our common stock.
 
The average daily trading volume of our common stock
 
over the 12-month period ending
December 31, 2020 was approximately 35,125 shares. Due
 
to the limited trading activity of our common stock, relativity small
trades may have a significant impact on the price of
 
our common stock.
 
Securities analysts may not initiate coverage or continue to
 
cover our common stock, and this may have a negative impact
on its market price.
 
The trading market for our common stock will depend
 
in part on the research and reports that securities analysts publish
 
about us
and our business. We
 
do not have any control over securities analysts and
 
they may not initiate coverage or continue to cover our
common stock. If securities analysts do not cover our
 
common stock, the lack of research coverage may adversely
 
affect its
market price. If we are covered by securities analysts, and
 
our common stock is the subject of an unfavorable report, our stock
price would likely decline. If one or more of these
 
analysts ceases to cover our Company or fails to publish regular reports on
 
us,
we could lose visibility in the financial markets,
 
which may cause our stock price or trading volume to decline.
 
Shares of our common stock are not
 
an insured deposit and may lose value.
 
 
The shares of our common stock are not a bank deposit and
 
will not be insured or guaranteed by the FDIC or any
 
other
government agency.
 
Your
 
investment will be subject to investment risk, and you must be capable
 
of affording the loss of your
entire investment.
 
Item 1B.
 
Unresolved Staff Comments
 
 
None.
 
Item 2.
 
Properties
 
 
We are headquartered
 
in Tallahassee, Florida.
 
Our executive office is in the Capital City Bank building
 
located on the corner of
Tennessee and
 
Monroe Streets in downtown Tallahassee.
 
The building is owned by CCB, but is located on land
 
leased under a
long-term agreement.
 
At December 31, 2020,
 
Capital City Bank had 57 banking offices.
 
Of the 57 locations, we lease the land, buildings, or both
 
at six
locations and own the land and buildings at the remaining
 
51.
 
In addition, CCHL had 29 loan production offices,
 
all of which
were leased.
 
 
Item 3.
 
Legal Proceedings
 
 
We are party
 
to lawsuits and claims arising out of the normal course of
 
business. In management’s opinion,
 
there are no known
pending claims or litigation, the outcome of which
 
would, individually or in the aggregate, have a material effect
 
on our
consolidated results of operations, financial position, or
 
cash flows.
 
Item 4
.
Mine Safety Disclosure
 
 
Not applicable.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
29
PART
 
II
 
 
Item 5.
 
Market for the Registrant's Common Equity,
 
Related Shareowner Matters, and Issuer Purchases of
 
Equity
Securities
 
 
Common Stock Market Prices and Dividends
 
 
Our common stock trades on the Nasdaq Global Select
 
Market under the symbol “CCBG.”
 
We had a
 
total of 1,201 shareowners
of record at February 25, 2021.
 
The following table presents the range of high and low
 
closing sales prices reported on the Nasdaq Global Select Market and
 
cash
dividends declared for each quarter during the past two
 
years.
 
 
2020
2019
Fourth
Quarter
Third
Quarter
Second
Quarter
First
Quarter
Fourth
Quarter
Third
Quarter
Second
Quarter
First
Quarter
Common stock price:
High
 
$
26.35
$
21.71
$
23.99
$
30.62
$
30.95
$
28.00
$
25.00
$
25.87
Low
 
18.14
17.55
16.16
15.61
25.75
23.70
21.57
21.04
Close
 
24.58
18.79
20.95
20.12
30.50
27.45
24.85
21.78
Cash dividends per share
 
0.15
0.14
0.14
0.14
0.13
0.13
0.11
0.11
 
Florida law and Federal regulations impose restrictions on
 
our ability to pay dividends and limitations on the amount
 
of dividends
that the Bank can pay annually to us.
 
See Item 1. “Capital; Dividends; Sources of Strength” and “Dividends”
 
in the Business
section on page 11 and 12, Item 1A.
 
“Investment Risks” in the Risk Factors section on page 24,
 
Item 7. “Liquidity and Capital
Resources – Dividends” – in Management's Discussion and Analysis
 
of Financial Condition and Operating Results on page
 
58
and Note 17 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
Performance Graph
 
 
This performance graph compares the cumulative
 
total shareowner return on our common stock with the cumulative
 
total
shareholder return of the Nasdaq Composite Index
 
and the SNL Financial LC $1B-$5B Bank Index for the past five
 
years.
 
The
graph assumes that $100 was invested on December
 
31, 2015 in our common stock and each of the above indices,
 
and that all
dividends were reinvested.
 
The shareowner return shown below represents past performance
 
and should not be considered
indicative of future performance.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ccbg20201231p30i0.jpg
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
30
 
 
 
Period Ending
Index
12/31/15
12/31/16
12/31/17
12/31/18
12/31/19
12/31/20
Capital City Bank Group, Inc.
 
$
100.00
$
134.86
$
152.76
$
156.54
$
209.68
$
173.24
Nasdaq Composite
 
100.00
108.87
141.13
137.12
187.44
271.64
SNL $1B-$5B Bank Index
 
100.00
143.87
153.37
134.37
163.35
138.81
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
31
Item 6.
 
Selected Financial Data
 
 
 
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Per Share Data)
2020
2019
2018
2017
2016
Interest Income
$
106,197
$
112,836
$
99,395
$
86,930
$
81,154
Net Interest Income
101,326
103,343
92,504
82,982
77,965
Provision for Credit Losses
9,645
2,027
2,921
2,215
819
Noninterest Income
(1)
111,165
53,053
51,565
51,746
53,681
Noninterest Expense
149,962
113,609
111,503
109,447
113,213
Income Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests
(2)
(11,078)
-
-
-
-
Net Income Attributable to CCBG
(3)
31,576
30,807
26,224
10,863
11,746
Per Common Share:
Basic Net Income
$
1.88
$
1.84
$
1.54
$
0.64
$
0.69
Diluted Net Income
1.88
1.83
1.54
0.64
0.69
Cash Dividends Declared
0.57
0.48
0.32
0.24
0.17
Diluted Book Value
19.05
19.40
18.00
16.65
16.23
Diluted Tangible Book Value
(4)
13.76
14.37
12.96
11.68
11.23
Performance Ratios:
Return on Average Assets
0.93
%
1.03
%
0.92
%
0.39
%
0.43
%
Return on Average Equity
9.36
9.72
8.89
3.83
4.22
Net Interest Margin (FTE)
3.30
3.85
3.64
3.37
3.25
Noninterest Income as % of Operating Revenues
52.32
33.92
35.79
38.41
40.78
Efficiency Ratio
70.43
72.40
77.05
80.50
85.34
Asset Quality:
Allowance for Credit Losses ("ACL")
$
23,816
$
13,905
$
14,210
$
13,307
$
13,431
ACL to Loans Held for Investment ("HFI")
1.19
%
0.75
%
0.80
%
0.80
%
0.86
%
Nonperforming Assets ("NPAs")
6,679
5,425
9,101
11,100
19,171
NPAs to Total
 
Assets
0.18
0.18
0.31
0.38
0.67
NPAs to Loans HFI plus OREO
0.33
0.29
0.51
0.67
1.21
ACL to Non-Performing Loans
405.66
310.99
206.79
185.87
157.40
Net Charge-Offs to Average
 
Loans HFI
0.12
0.13
0.12
0.14
0.09
Capital Ratios:
Tier 1 Capital
16.19
%
17.16
%
16.36
%
16.33
%
15.51
%
Total Capital
17.30
17.90
17.13
17.10
16.28
Common Equity Tier 1 Capital
13.71
14.47
13.58
13.42
12.61
Tangible Common Equity
(4)
6.25
8.06
7.58
7.09
6.90
Leverage
9.33
11.25
10.89
10.47
10.23
Equity to Assets
8.45
10.59
10.23
9.80
9.67
Dividend Pay-Out
30.32
26.23
20.78
37.50
24.64
Averages for the Year:
Loans Held for Investment
$
1,957,576
$
1,811,738
$
1,711,635
$
1,610,127
$
1,530,260
Earning Assets
3,083,675
2,697,098
2,561,884
2,502,231
2,432,392
Total Assets
3,391,071
2,987,056
2,857,148
2,816,096
2,752,309
Deposits
2,844,347
2,537,489
2,422,973
2,371,871
2,282,785
Shareowners’ Equity
337,313
317,072
294,864
283,404
278,335
Year-End
 
Balances:
Loans Held for Investment
$
2,006,427
$
1,835,929
$
1,774,225
$
1,653,492
$
1,561,289
Earning Assets
3,475,904
2,806,913
2,658,539
2,582,922
2,520,053
Total Assets
3,798,071
3,088,953
2,959,183
2,898,794
2,845,197
Deposits
3,217,560
2,645,454
2,531,856
2,469,877
2,412,286
Shareowners’ Equity
320,837
327,016
302,587
284,210
275,168
Other Data:
Basic Average Shares Outstanding
16,784,711
16,769,507
17,029,420
16,951,663
16,988,747
Diluted Average Shares Outstanding
16,821,950
16,827,413
17,072,329
17,012,637
17,061,186
Shareowners of Record
(5)
1,201
1,243
1,312
1,389
1,489
Banking Locations
(5)
57
57
59
59
60
Full-Time Equivalent Associates
(5)(6)
954
796
801
789
820
(1)
 
Includes $2.5 million gain from sale of trust preferred securities in 2016.
(2)
 
Acquired 51% membership interest in Brand Mortgage Group, LLC , re-named as Capital City Home Loans, on March 1, 2020 - fully consolidated
(3)
 
For 2017, includes $4.1 million, or $0.24 per diluted share, income tax expense
 
adjustment related to the Tax
 
Cuts and Jobs Act of 2017.
 
For 2018, includes $3.3 million, or $0.19 per diluted share, income tax benefit for
 
2017 plan year pension contributions made in 2018.
(4)
 
Diluted tangible book value and tangible common equity ratio are non-GAAP financial measures. For additional
 
information, including a reconciliation
 
to GAAP, refer
 
to page 32
(5)
 
As of February 25th of the following year.
(6)
 
Reflects 756 full-time equivalent associates at Core CCBG and 198 full-time
 
equivalent associates at CCHL.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
32
NON-GAAP FINANCIAL MEASURES
We present a
 
tangible common equity ratio and a tangible book value per
 
diluted share that, in each case, removes the effect of
goodwill that resulted from merger and acquisition
 
activity. We
 
believe these measures
 
are useful to investors because it allows
investors to more easily compare our capital adequacy
 
to other companies in the industry.
 
The GAAP to non-GAAP
reconciliation for selected year-to-date
 
financial data and quarterly financial data is provided below.
 
Non-GAAP Reconciliation - Selected Financial Data
(Dollars in Thousands, except per share data)
2020
2019
2018
2017
2016
Shareowners' Equity (GAAP)
$
320,837
$
327,016
$
302,587
$
284,210
$
275,168
Less: Goodwill (GAAP)
89,095
84,811
84,811
84,811
84,811
Tangible Shareowners' Equity (non-GAAP)
A
231,742
242,205
217,776
199,399
190,357
Total Assets (GAAP)
3,798,071
3,088,953
2,959,183
2,898,794
2,845,197
Less: Goodwill (GAAP)
89,095
84,811
84,811
84,811
84,811
Tangible Assets (non-GAAP)
B
$
3,708,976
$
3,004,142
$
2,874,372
$
2,813,983
$
2,760,386
Tangible Common Equity Ratio (non-GAAP)
A/B
6.25%
8.06%
7.58%
7.09%
6.90%
Actual Diluted Shares Outstanding (GAAP)
C
16,844,997
16,855,161
16,808,542
17,071,107
16,949,359
Tangible Book Value
 
per Diluted Share
 
(non-GAAP)
A/C
13.76
14.37
12.96
11.68
11.23
 
Non-GAAP Reconciliation - Quarterly Financial Data
(Dollars in Thousands, except
per share data)
2020
2019
Fourth
Third
Second
First
Fourth
Third
Second
First
Shareowners' Equity (GAAP)
$
320,837
$
339,425
$
335,057
$
328,507
$
327,016
$
321,562
$
314,595
$
308,986
Less: Goodwill (GAAP)
89,095
89,095
89,095
89,275
84,811
84,811
84,811
84,811
Tangible Shareowners' Equity
(non-GAAP)
A
231,742
250,330
245,962
239,232
242,205
236,751
229,784
224,175
Total Assets (GAAP)
3,798,071
3,587,041
3,499,524
3,086,523
3,088,953
2,934,513
3,017,654
3,052,051
Less: Goodwill (GAAP)
89,095
89,095
89,095
89,275
84,811
84,811
84,811
84,811
Tangible Assets (non-GAAP)
B
$
3,708,976
$
3,497,946
$
3,410,429
$
2,997,248
$
3,004,142
$
2,849,702
$
2,932,843
$
2,967,240
Tangible Common Equity
Ratio (non-GAAP)
A/B
6.25%
7.16%
7.21%
7.98%
8.06%
8.31%
7.83%
7.56%
Actual Diluted Shares
Outstanding (GAAP)
C
16,844,997
16,800,563
16,821,743
16,845,462
16,855,161
16,797,241
16,773,449
16,840,496
Tangible Book Value per
Diluted Share (non-GAAP)
A/C
13.76
14.90
14.62
14.20
14.37
14.09
13.70
13.31
 
33
Item 7.
 
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
 
and Results of Operations
 
 
Management’s discussion
 
and analysis (“MD&A”) provides supplemental information,
 
which sets forth the major factors that
have affected our financial condition and results
 
of operations and should be read in conjunction with the
 
Consolidated Financial
Statements and related notes included in the Annual Report
 
on Form 10-K.
 
The MD&A is divided into subsections entitled
“Business Overview,” “Executive
 
Overview,” “Results of
 
Operations,” “Financial Condition,” “Liquidity and Capital Resources,”
“Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements,” “Fourth
 
Quarter, 2020 Financial Results,” and “Accounting
 
Policies.”
 
The following
information should provide a better understanding
 
of the major factors and trends that affect our earnings
 
performance and
financial condition, and how our performance during
 
2020 compares with prior years.
 
Throughout this section, Capital City Bank
Group, Inc., and its subsidiaries, collectively,
 
are referred to as “CCBG,” “Company,”
 
“we,” “us,” or “our.”
 
CAUTION CONCERNING FORWARD
 
-LOOKING STATEMENTS
 
 
This Annual Report on Form 10-K, including this MD&A section,
 
contains “forward-looking statements” within the meaning
 
of
the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995.
 
These forward-looking statements include, among others, statements about
our beliefs, plans, objectives, goals, expectations, estimates
 
and intentions that are subject to significant risks and
 
uncertainties
and are subject to
 
change based on various factors, many of which are beyond
 
our control. The words “may,”
 
“could,” “should,”
“would,” “believe,” “anticipate,” “estimate,” “expect,”
 
“intend,” “plan,” “target,” “vision,” “goal,” and similar
 
expressions are
intended to identify forward-looking statements.
 
All forward-looking statements, by their nature, are subject
 
to risks and uncertainties.
 
Our actual future results may differ
materially from those set forth in our forward-looking
 
statements.
 
Please see the Introductory Note and
Item 1A Risk Factors
 
of
this Annual Report for a discussion of factors that
 
could cause our actual results to differ materially from
 
those in the forward-
looking statements.
 
However, other factors besides those
 
listed in
Item 1A Risk Factors
 
or discussed in this Annual Report also could adversely affect
our results, and you should not consider any such
 
list of factors to be a complete set of all potential risks or
 
uncertainties.
 
Any
forward-looking statements made by us or on our behalf
 
speak only as of the date they are made.
 
We do not undertake
 
to update
any forward-looking statement, except as required by applicable
 
law.
 
BUSINESS OVERVIEW
 
Our Business
 
We are a financial
 
holding company headquartered in Tallahassee,
 
Florida, and we are the parent of our wholly owned subsidiary,
Capital City Bank (the “Bank” or “CCB”).
 
We offer
 
a broad array of products and services, including commercial
 
and retail
banking services, trust and asset management, and retail securities
 
brokerage through a total of 57 banking offices
 
and 86
ATMs/ITMs
 
located in Florida, Georgia, and Alabama.
 
Please see the section captioned “About Us” beginning
 
on page 4 for
more detailed information about our business.
 
Our profitability,
 
like most financial institutions, is dependent to a large
 
extent upon net interest income, which is the difference
between the interest and fees received on interest earning
 
assets, such as loans and securities, and the interest paid on
 
interest-
bearing liabilities, principally deposits and borrowings.
 
Results of operations are also affected by the provision
 
for credit losses,
operating expenses such as salaries and employee benefits,
 
occupancy and other operating expenses including income taxes,
 
and
noninterest income such as mortgage banking revenues,
 
wealth management fees, deposit fees, and bank card fees.
 
 
Strategic Review
 
Operating Philosophy
.
 
Our philosophy is to build long-term client relationships based
 
on quality service, high ethical standards,
and safe and sound banking practices.
 
We maintain a
 
locally oriented, community-based focus, which is augmented
 
by
experienced, centralized support in select specialized areas.
 
Our local market orientation is reflected in our network of
 
banking
office locations, experienced community executives
 
with a dedicated President for each market, and community
 
boards which
support our focus on responding to local banking needs.
 
We strive to offer
 
a broad array of sophisticated products and to provide
quality service by empowering associates to make decisions
 
in their local markets.
 
 
Strategic Initiatives
.
 
In 2020, we celebrated
 
our 125
th
 
anniversary and reflected on our past history and what has fostered
 
our
longevity – client relationships, community service,
 
and our people have allowed us to evolve, change,
 
and thrive over time.
 
In
2020, we completed a five year strategic plan “Vision
 
2020” and initiated a new five year strategic plan “2025 In
 
Focus” that will
guide us in the areas of client experience, channel optimization,
 
market expansion, and culture.
 
As part of 2025 In Focus, we will
aim to take our brand of relationship banking to the
 
next level, further deepen relationships within our communities,
 
expand into
new higher growth markets, diversify our revenue
 
sources, invest in new technology that will support the expansion
 
of client
relationships and scale within our lines of business and
 
drive higher profitability.
 
 
34
 
Markets
.
 
We maintain a
 
blend of large and small markets in Florida
 
and Georgia all in close proximity to major interstate
thoroughfares such as Interstates I-10 and I-75.
 
Our larger markets include Tallahassee
 
(Leon County, Florida),
 
Gainesville
(Alachua County,
 
Florida), Macon (Bibb County,
 
Georgia),
 
and Seacoast (Hernando/Pasco/Citrus, Florida).
 
The larger
employers in these markets are state and local governments,
 
healthcare providers, educational institutions, and small
 
businesses,
providing stability and good growth dynamics that have
 
historically grown in excess of the national average.
 
We serve an
additional fifteen smaller, less competitive,
 
rural markets located on the outskirts of and centered between
 
our larger markets
where we are positioned as a market leader.
 
In 12 of 18 markets in Florida and two of four Georgia
 
markets, we frequently rank
within the top four banks in terms of deposit market
 
share.
 
Furthermore, in the counties in which we operate, we maintain
 
an
8.3%
 
deposit market share in the Florida counties and 2.4%
 
in the Georgia counties.
 
Our markets provide for a strong core
deposit funding base, a key differentiator
 
and driver of our profitability and franchise value.
 
 
Acquisitions/Expansion Focus
.
 
Prior to 2005, we were an active acquirer of banks which
 
is reflected in the strong core deposit
franchise we enjoy today.
 
During the Great Recession, we navigated this historical period
 
in our industry focused on protecting
shareowner value and resolved our problem assets without
 
raising capital.
 
We also pivoted to
 
an intense focus on organic growth
and operational improvements.
 
While we have not completed a whole bank transaction since 2005,
 
we have completed a total of
nine whole bank acquisitions and this component
 
of our strategy is still in place.
 
The focus of potential acquisition opportunities
(including management lift-outs) will be in Florida, Georgia,
 
and Alabama with a particular focus on financial institutions
 
located
in markets on the outskirts of larger,
 
metropolitan areas, including Alachua, Marion, Hernando/Pasco counties
 
in Florida, the
western panhandle of Florida, Bibb and surrounding
 
counties in central Georgia and the northern arc of
 
Atlanta, leveraging the
presence of our recent strategic alliance with CCHL.
 
Our focus on some of these markets may change as we
 
continue to evaluate
our strategy and the economic conditions and demographics
 
of any individual market.
 
We will also continue
 
to evaluate de novo
banking office expansion opportunities in attractive
 
new markets where acquisition opportunities are not feasible
 
,
 
and expansion
opportunities in asset management, insurance, mortgage
 
banking, and other financial businesses that are closely aligned with
 
the
business of banking.
 
Embedded in our acquisition and expansion strategy is our desire
 
to partner with institutions that are
culturally similar, have experienced
 
management and possess either established market presence
 
or have potential for improved
profitability through growth, economies of scale, or
 
expanded services.
 
Generally, these potential target
 
institutions will range in
asset size from
 
$100 million to $600 million.
 
 
Recent Acquisition/Expansion Activity
.
 
In 2020 we began our expansion into the western panhandle
 
area of Florida by opening a
full-service banking office in Bay County,
 
Florida and a loan production office in Walton
 
County with plans to open a full-service
banking office in Walton
 
County in late 2021.
 
Further, we will expand our presence and
 
commitment to our Gainesville market,
opening a third full-service banking office in late
 
2021 to early 2022.
 
On March 1, 2020, CCB completed its acquisition of
 
a 51% membership interest in Brand Mortgage Group, LLC (“Brand”)
which is now operated as a Capital City Home Loans
 
(“CCHL”) – Refer to Note 1 – Significant Accounting Policies/Business
Combination for additional information on this transaction.
 
The primary reasons for the strategic alliance with Brand
 
were to
scale our mortgage banking business, gain access to an expanded
 
residential mortgage product line-up and investor base
(including mandatory delivery channel for loan sales),
 
to hedge our net interest income business and to generate
 
other operational
synergies and cost savings.
 
We realized
 
significant benefits from this transaction in 2020.
 
The strategic alliance with CCHL and
its strong presence and leadership within the Northern Arc
 
area (Gwinnett and Cobb counties) of Atlanta positions us to
 
further
evaluate expansion of our traditional banking services to
 
this area via de-novo banking office expansion
 
,
 
whole bank acquisition,
or the recruitment/hiring of banking teams
 
in the area as opportunities arise.
 
 
EXECUTIVE OVERVIEW
 
 
For 2020, we realized net income of $31.6 million,
 
or $1.88 per diluted share, compared to $30.8 million, or $1.83
 
per diluted
share for 2019.
 
The increase in net income for 2020 was attributable
 
to higher noninterest income of $58.1 million, partially
 
offset by higher
noninterest expense of $36.4 million, a $7.6 million
 
increase in the provision for credit losses, lower net interest income
 
of $2.0
million, and higher income taxes of $0.2 million.
 
For reporting purposes, CCHL is fully consolidated in CCBG’s
 
financial
statements and, for the full year 2020,
 
net income included an $11.1 million deduction
 
to record the 49% non-controlling interest
in the earnings of CCHL.
 
 
Below are summary highlights that impacted our performance
 
for the year:
 
 
Operating revenues (excluding mortgage
 
fees) held firm as unfavorable asset re-pricing
 
was offset by SBA PPP loan fees
and higher other fee revenues
 
 
Loan balances buoyed by SBA PPP
 
loan originations which totaled $190 million
-
 
Core loan balances (excluding SBA
 
PPP) held firm due to stronger loan production
 
in the fourth quarter
 
35
 
Reserve build of $6.6 million (loan HFI provision
 
of $9.0 million less net charge-offs of $2.4 million)
 
in response to potential
credit losses related
 
to the pandemic
-
 
Allowance coverage ratio (excluding SBA PPP) was 1.30%
 
at year-end
 
Deposits grew $572 million (period-end)
 
and $307 million (average) and reflected
 
stimulus inflows as well as strong core
deposit growth
 
Acquired 51% ownership in Brand
 
Mortgage, LLC on March 1, 2020 (renamed
 
CCHL) – contributed $0.52 per share
 
 
In 2020,
 
despite pressure from the economic effects of the
 
COVID-19 pandemic and a 150 basis point emergency
 
Federal Open
Market Committee rate reduction in March, our earnings
 
held firm and came in slightly above 2019.
 
Our strategic alliance with
CCHL was timely and those earnings provided a hedge
 
against our net interest income.
 
 
Period-end loans grew $170 million, or 9.3%, in 2020 aided
 
by our involvement in the SBA PPP loan program as we
 
generated
$190 million in loans ($178 million balance at December
 
31, 2020) to support our clients during this unprecedented
 
time.
 
Core
loan balances held firm despite the stressed economy buoyed
 
by our relationship with CCHL and the larger
 
pool of loan purchase
opportunities that strategic alliance provides us.
 
We also generated
 
a total of $5.0 million in net SBA PPP loan fees of which $1.8
million was recognized in 2020.
 
Our deposit balances saw unprecedented growth in
 
2020 as average balances grew $307 million, or 12% driven
 
by the stimulus
provided by various government programs throughout
 
the year as well as core deposit growth as our clients
 
sought a flight to
safety.
 
2020 continued our seventh consecutive year of deposit growth
 
which has averaged 4.1% per year.
 
 
Noninterest income was very strong in 2020 driven by higher
 
mortgage banking revenues attributable to the strategic alliance
with CCHL, and a very robust mortgage market.
 
Other fee revenues held firm despite pressure on our deposit
 
fees attributable to
the pandemic.
 
Wealth management
 
fees and bank card fees grew 4.5%
 
and 8.3%, respectively in 2020.
 
 
Expenses at our core bank (excluding CCHL) declined
 
by $3.6 million in 2020,
 
primarily attributable to lower pension plan
expense.
 
We continued
 
our ongoing commitment to expense management as a component
 
of improving our efficiency ratio and
elevated our commitment in 2020 by allocating dedicated
 
resources focused on identifying opportunities to reduce
 
the cost of our
banking office network and occupancy costs.
 
In 2020, we continued our multi-year investment in ITM/SATM
 
technology and
enhancements to our electronic banking platform which
 
greatly benefited our ability to improve service quality
 
for our clients
during the pandemic.
 
 
The pandemic provided significant challenges on the credit
 
front in 2020.
 
We supported
 
our clients, providing short-term loan
extensions for loan balances totaling $333 million, of
 
which $324 million had returned to normal scheduled payments by year-
end.
 
Despite the stressed environment for our borrowers, our credit quality
 
metrics remained very stable throughout the year with
minimal defaults and credit losses of 12 basis points of
 
average loans held for investment (“HFI”).
 
In response to the great
uncertainty regarding potential loan defaults related to the
 
stressed economy, we built
 
significant credit loss reserves in response
during 2020,
 
and continued to carry those reserves through year-end.
 
 
Key components of our 2020 financial performance are
 
summarized below:
 
 
Results of Operations
 
Net Interest Income.
 
For 2020, tax-equivalent net interest income totaled $101.8
 
million,
 
a $2.1 million, or 2.0%, decrease from
2019 driven primarily by lower rates for most of the
 
year, which negatively impacted
 
our variable and adjustable rate earning
assets. Partially offsetting this decline was a lower
 
cost of funds.
 
Provision and Allowance for Credit
 
Losses.
 
For 2020, our provision for credit losses was $9.6
 
million compared to $2.0 million
for 2019.
 
The higher provision in 2020 reflected expected potential losses due
 
to deterioration in economic conditions related to
the COVID-19 pandemic.
 
Net loan losses for 2020 totaled $2.4 million, or 0.12% of average loans
 
held for investment compared
to $2.3 million, or 0.13%, in 2019.
 
At December 31, 2020, excluding SBA PPP loans (100% government
 
guaranteed),
 
the
allowance represented 1.30% of loans held for investment.
 
 
Noninterest Income and Noninterest
 
Expense
.
 
The consolidation of CCHL’s
 
mortgage banking operations on March 1, 2020
impacted our noninterest income and noninterest expense
 
comparisons for 2020 versus 2019.
 
To better understand the
 
impact, we
provide an analysis of Noninterest Income and Noninterest
 
Expense for CCBG excluding CCHL (“Core CCBG”) and
 
CCHL
under those respective headings below (Pages 39 and
 
41).
 
CCHL operations contributed $8.7 million, or $0.52 per
 
diluted share,
to our earnings for 2020 driven by robust mortgage production
 
and efficiencies gained with the strategic alliance
 
.
 
 
 
36
At Core CCBG, deposit fees declined $1.7 million
 
in 2020 primarily due to the impact of government stimulus in
 
the second
quarter related to the COVID-19 pandemic, but increased
 
for the second half of the year as the economy and consumer
 
spending
improved.
 
Strong debit card fee growth
 
of $1.0 million and a $0.6 million increase in wealth management
 
fees substantially
offset the aforementioned decline in deposit fees.
 
Core CCBG noninterest expense decreased $3.6 million and
 
reflected lower
compensation expense of $2.5 million, ORE expense
 
of $0.4 million, and other expense of $2.2 million, partially
 
offset by higher
occupancy expense of $1.5 million.
 
 
Financial Condition
 
Earning Assets
.
 
Average earning
 
assets were $3.391 billion for 2020, an increase of $404.0 million,
 
or 13.5%, over 2019.
 
The
increase was primarily driven by higher deposit balances
 
and reflected strong core deposit growth and funding retained
 
at the
bank from SBA PPP loans and various other government
 
stimulus programs.
 
Loans
.
 
In 2020, average loans HFI totaled $1.993 billion, an increase
 
of $159.4 million, or 8.0% over 2019 and reflected growth
in all loan categories except institutional loans, home
 
equity loans, and consumer loans.
 
During 2020, we originated SBA PPP
loans which averaged $128 million in 2020 and totaled
 
$178 million at December 31, 2020.
 
SBA PPP loan fees totaled
approximately $1.8 million in 2020.
 
At December 31, 2020 we had $3.2 million (net) in deferred
 
SBA PPP loan fees.
 
Credit Quality
.
 
Nonaccrual loans totaled $5.9 million (0.29% of HFI loans)
 
at December 31, 2020 compared to $4.5 million
(0.24% of HFI loans) at December 31, 2019.
 
Classified loans totaled $17.6 million and $20.8 million at the
 
same respective
periods.
 
We continue to
 
closely monitor borrowers and loan portfolio segments impacted
 
by the pandemic.
 
Of the $333 million
in loans extended in 2020, approximately $9 million was
 
still on extension at December 31, 2020, none of which were
 
classified.
 
Of the $324 million in loans extended in 2020, that have
 
resumed payments, loan balances totaling $3.5 million
 
were over 30
days delinquent and an additional $0.4 million was on
 
nonaccrual status at December 31, 2020.
 
 
Deposits
.
 
Average total
 
deposits for 2020 were $2.844 billion, an increase of $306.9
 
million, or 12.1%, over 2019.
 
We realized
increases in all
deposit types except certificates of deposit, with the largest
 
increases occurring in noninterest bearing and savings
accounts.
 
The strong deposit growth that
occurred during the year reflected inflows from various government
 
stimulus programs
as well as strong core deposit growth.
 
 
Capital
.
 
At December 31, 2020, we were well-capitalized with a total risk-based
 
capital ratio of 17.30% and a tangible common
equity ratio (a non-GAAP financial measure) of 6.25
 
%
 
compared to 17.90% and 8.06%, respectively,
 
at December 31, 2019.
 
At
December 31, 2020, all of our regulatory capital ratios
 
exceeded the threshold to be well-capitalized under the Basel III
 
capital
standards.
 
Our tangible common equity ratio was unfavorably impacted
 
at December 31, 2020 by the annual adjustment to the
other comprehensive loss for our pension plan, which
 
was negatively impacted due to the lower discount rate used to
 
calculate the
present value of the pension obligation.
 
The lower discount rate reflected the significant decline in long-term
 
interest rates in
2020.
 
The pension plan, on an actuarial basis, continues to be sufficiently
 
funded in accordance with IRS regulation.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
37
RESULTS
 
OF OPERATIONS
 
 
A condensed earnings summary for the last three
 
years is presented in Table
 
1 below:
 
Table 1
CONDENSED SUMMARY OF EARNINGS
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Per Share
 
Data)
2020
2019
2018
Interest Income
$
106,197
$
112,836
$
99,395
Taxable Equivalent
 
Adjustments
430
526
654
Total Interest Income
 
(FTE)
106,627
113,362
100,049
Interest Expense
4,871
9,493
6,891
Net Interest Income (FTE)
101,756
103,869
93,158
Provision for Credit Losses
9,645
2,027
2,921
Taxable Equivalent
 
Adjustments
430
526
654
Net Interest Income After Provision for Credit Losses
91,681
101,316
89,583
Noninterest Income
111,165
53,053
51,565
Noninterest Expense
149,962
113,609
111,503
Income Before Income Taxes
52,884
40,760
29,645
Income Tax Expense
 
10,230
9,953
3,421
Pre-Tax Income
 
Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests
(11,078)
-
-
Net Income Attributable to Common Shareowners
$
31,576
$
30,807
$
26,224
Basic Net Income Per Share
$
1.88
$
1.84
$
1.54
Diluted Net Income Per Share
$
1.88
$
1.83
$
1.54
 
Net Interest Income
 
 
Net interest income represents our single largest
 
source of earnings and is equal to interest income and fees
 
generated by earning
assets, less interest expense paid on interest bearing
 
liabilities.
 
We provide
 
an analysis of our net interest income, including
average yields and rates in Tables
 
2 and 3 below.
 
We provide this
 
information on a "taxable equivalent" basis to reflect the
 
tax-
exempt status of income earned on certain loans and
 
investments.
 
 
For 2020, our taxable equivalent net interest income
 
decreased $2.1 million, or 2.0%. This follows an increase of $10.7
 
million, or
11.5%
 
in 2019.
 
The decrease in 2020 was driven primarily by lower rates for most of
 
the year, which negatively impacted our
variable and adjustable rate earning assets.
 
Partially offsetting this decline was a lower
 
cost of funds.
 
The increase in 2019 was
due to generally higher rates which continued to
 
migrate through the earning asset portfolios.
 
 
For 2020, taxable equivalent interest income decreased
 
$6.7 million, or 5.9%, from 2019.
 
For 2019, taxable equivalent interest
income increased $13.3 million, or 13.3%, over 2018.
 
The decline in 2020 was primarily due to lower rates on earning
 
assets.
The increase for 2019 was primarily due to higher
 
loan balances coupled with higher interest rates.
 
 
For 2020, interest expense decreased $4.6 million, or
 
48.7%, from 2019.
 
For 2019, interest expense increased $2.6 million, or
37.8%, over 2018.
 
The decline in 2020 was primarily due to lower rates on our negotiated
 
rate deposits which are tied to an
adjustable rate index, whereas the increase for 2019 primarily
 
reflected increases to our negotiated rate deposits.
 
Our cost of
funds decreased 19 basis points to 16 basis points in 2020,
 
and increased eight basis points to 35 basis points in 2019.
 
The
decrease in 2020 was primarily due to lower interest
 
rates paid on our negotiated rate products.
 
The increase in 2019 was
primarily due to higher interest rates paid on our
 
negotiated rate products due to the average increase in interest rates
 
over the
period.
 
 
 
Our interest rate spread (defined as the taxable-equivalent
 
yield on average earning assets less the average rate
 
paid on interest
bearing liabilities) decreased 43 basis points in 2020 and
 
increased 15 basis points in 2019.
 
Our net interest margin (defined as
taxable-equivalent interest income less interest expense divided
 
by average earning assets) of 3.30%
 
in 2020 was a 55 basis point
decrease from 2019.
 
The net interest margin of 3.85%
 
in 2019 was a 21 basis point increase over 2018.
 
The decline in the
interest rate spread and net interest margin
 
in 2020 was primarily due to lower yielding earning assets due
 
to lower rates, in
addition to strong growth in lower yielding overnight funds.
 
The increase in the interest rate spread and net interest margin
 
in
2019 was attributable to rising rates and an improving
 
mix of earning assets driven by loan growth.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
38
The Federal Open Market Committee (FOMC) decreased the
 
federal funds target rate 150 basis points in March
 
2020 to a target
rate in the range of 0.00%-0.25%, resulting in lower yields
 
as our variable and adjustable rate earning assets reprice.
 
As we
continue to closely monitor and manage our net interest
 
margin,
 
we review and implement various loan strategies that align with
our overall risk appetite to enhance our performance
 
on an ongoing basis.
 
We continue
 
to maintain relatively short duration
portfolios on both sides of the balance sheet and
 
believe we are well positioned to respond to changing market
 
conditions.
 
 
Table 2
AVERAGE
 
BALANCES AND INTEREST RATES
2020
2019
2018
(Taxable Equivalent Basis - Dollars
in Thousands)
Average
Balance
Interest
Average
Rate
Average
Balance
Interest
Average
Rate
Average
Balance
Interest
Average
Rate
ASSETS
Loans Held for Sale
(1)(2)
$
81,125
$
2,895
3.57
%
$
10,349
$
471
4.55
%
$
 
6,713
$
350
5.21
%
Loans Held for Investment
(1)(2)
1,957,576
92,261
4.71
1,811,738
94,191
5.20
1,711,635
84,200
4.92
Taxable Investment Securities
574,199
10,176
1.77
612,541
13,123
2.14
641,120
12,083
1.88
Tax-Exempt Investment Securities
(2)
5,123
124
2.42
24,471
390
1.60
67,037
1,006
1.50
Funds Sold
465,652
1,171
0.25
237,999
5,187
2.18
135,379
2,410
1.78
Total Earning Assets
3,083,675
106,627
3.46
%
2,697,098
113,362
4.20
%
2,561,884
100,049
3.91
%
Cash & Due From Banks
68,386
52,453
51,222
Allowance for Credit Losses
(20,690)
(14,622)
(13,993)
Other Assets
259,700
252,127
258,035
TOTAL ASSETS
$
3,391,071
$
2,987,056
$
2,857,148
LIABILITIES
NOW Accounts
$
826,280
$
930
0.11
%
$
805,134
$
5,502
0.68
%
$
 
781,026
$
3,152
0.40
%
Money Market Accounts
235,931
223
0.09
235,845
946
0.40
251,175
675
0.27
Savings Accounts
423,529
207
0.05
370,430
182
0.05
351,341
172
0.05
Time Deposits
104,393
188
0.18
113,499
210
0.19
131,860
244
0.18
Total Interest Bearing Deposits
1,590,133
1,548
0.10
%
1,524,908
6,840
0.45
%
1,515,402
4,243
0.29
%
Short-Term Borrowings
69,119
1,690
2.44
9,275
109
1.19
10,992
110
0.99
Subordinated Notes Payable
52,887
1,472
2.74
52,887
2,287
4.26
52,887
2,167
4.04
Other Long-Term Borrowings
5,304
161
3.03
7,393
257
3.48
12,387
371
3.00
Total Interest Bearing Liabilities
1,717,443
4,871
0.28
%
1,594,463
9,493
0.60
%
1,591,668
6,891
0.45
%
Noninterest Bearing Deposits
1,254,214
1,012,581
907,571
Other Liabilities
72,400
62,940
63,045
TOTAL LIABILITIES
3,044,057
2,669,984
2,562,284
Temporary Equity
9,701
-
-
TOTAL SHAREOWNERS’
EQUITY
337,313
317,072
294,864
TOTAL LIABILITIES,
TEMPORARY EQUITY AND
SHAREOWNERS' EQUITY
$
3,391,071
$
2,987,056
$
2,857,148
Interest Rate Spread
3.18
%
3.61
%
3.46
%
Net Interest Income
$
101,756
$
103,869
$
93,158
Net Interest Margin
(3)
3.30
%
3.85
%
3.64
%
(1)
 
Average balances include net loan fees, discounts and premiums, and nonaccrual loans.
 
Interest income includes loan fees of $2.6 million for 2020,
 
 
$0.9 million for 2019, and $1.0 million for 2018.
(2)
 
Interest income includes the effects of taxable equivalent adjustments using a 21% tax rate.
(3)
 
Taxable equivalent net interest income divided by average earning assets.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
39
Table 3
RATE/VOLUME
 
ANALYSIS
(1)
2020 vs. 2019
2019 vs. 2018
(Taxable
 
Equivalent Basis -
Dollars in Thousands)
Increase (Decrease) Due to Change In
Increase (Decrease) Due to Change In
Total
 
Calendar
(3)
 
Volume
 
Rate
 
Total
 
Volume
 
Rate
Earnings Assets:
Loans Held for Sale
(2)
$
2,452
$
1
$
3,222
$
(771)
$
121
$
190
$
(69)
Loans Held for Investment
(2)
$
(1,958)
$
258
$
7,773
$
(9,989)
$
9,991
$
4,914
$
5,077
Taxable
(2,947)
36
(857)
(2,126)
1,040
(539)
1,579
Tax-Exempt
(2)
(266)
1
(309)
42
(616)
(641)
25
Funds Sold
(4,016)
14
4,948
(8,978)
2,777
1,827
950
Total
(6,735)
310
14,777
(21,822)
13,313
5,751
7,562
Interest Bearing Liabilities:
NOW Accounts
(4,572)
15
130
(4,717)
2,350
97
2,253
Money Market Accounts
(723)
3
-
(726)
271
(41)
312
Savings Accounts
25
1
24
-
10
10
-
Time Deposits
(22)
1
(18)
(5)
(34)
(40)
6
Short-Term
 
Borrowings
1,581
1
716
864
(1)
(19)
18
Subordinated Notes Payable
(815)
6
-
(821)
120
-
120
Other Long-Term
 
Borrowings
(96)
1
(73)
(24)
(114)
(150)
36
Total
(4,622)
28
779
(5,429)
2,602
(143)
2,745
Changes in Net Interest Income
$
(2,113)
$
282
$
13,998
$
(16,393)
$
10,711
$
5,894
$
4,817
(1)
 
This table shows the change in taxable equivalent net interest
 
income for comparative periods based on either changes in
 
average volume or changes in average rates for interest
 
earning assets and interest bearing liabilities.
 
Changes which are
 
not solely due to volume changes or solely due to rate changes
 
have been attributed to rate changes.
(2)
 
Interest income includes the effects of taxable
 
equivalent adjustments using a 21% tax rate to adjust on tax
 
-exempt loans
 
 
and securities to a taxable equivalent basis.
(3)
 
Reflects one extra calendar day in 2020.
 
Provision for Credit Losses
 
 
The provision for credit losses for 2020 was $9.6 million
 
($9.0 million for loans HFI and $0.6 million for unfunded loan
commitments) compared to $2.0 million for 2019 and
 
$2.9 million for 2018.
 
Prior to 2020,
 
the provision for unfunded loan
commitments was recorded in other expense.
 
The higher provision in 2020 reflected expected losses due to deterioration
 
in
economic conditions related to the COVID-19 pandemic
 
.
 
We further
 
discuss the various factors that have impacted our provision
expense for 2020 below under the heading Allowance
 
for Credit Losses.
 
Noninterest Income
 
 
For 2020, noninterest income totaled $111.2
 
million, a $58.1 million increase over 2019 primarily attributable
 
to higher mortgage
banking revenues of $58.0 million added through the
 
strategic alliance with CCHL.
 
Deposit fees declined $1.7 million primarily
due to the impact of government stimulus in the second
 
quarter related to the COVID-19 pandemic,
 
but improved for the second
half of the year due to higher utilization of our overdraft
 
product.
 
Strong debit card fee growth of $1.0 million and a $0.6 million
increase in wealth management fees significantly offset
 
the aforementioned decline in deposit fees.
 
 
For 2019, noninterest income totaled $53.1 million, a $1.5
 
million, or 2.9%, increase over 2018, and reflected higher
 
wealth
management fees of $1.8 million, mortgage banking
 
revenues of $0.6 million, and bank card fees of $0.6 million,
 
partially offset
by lower deposit fees of $0.6 million and other income
 
of $0.9 million.
 
 
Noninterest income as a percent of total operating revenues
 
(net interest income plus noninterest income) was 52.32
 
%
 
in 2020,
33.92%
 
in 2019, and 35.79% in 2018.
 
The addition of CCHL mortgage banking revenues drove
 
the improvement in this metric in
2020.
 
The decline in this metric in 2019 was attributable to growth
 
in net interest income as a component of operating revenues.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
40
CCHL’s
 
mortgage banking operations impacted our
 
noninterest income for 2020 and thus, the year over year comparisons
 
reflect
the impact of the CCHL consolidation, which occurred
 
on March 1, 2020.
 
The table below reflects the major components of
noninterest income for Core CCBG and CCHL to help
 
facilitate a better understanding of the 2020 versus 2019
 
comparison.
 
 
2020
2019
2018
(Dollars in Thousands)
Core CCBG
CCHL
CCBG
CCBG
Deposit Fees
$
17,800
$
-
$
19,472
$
20,093
Bank Card Fees
13,044
-
11,994
11,378
Wealth Management
 
Fees
11,035
-
10,480
8,711
Mortgage Banking Revenues
1,889
61,455
5,321
4,735
Other
4,992
950
5,786
6,648
Total Noninterest
 
Income
$
48,760
$
62,405
$
53,053
$
51,565
 
Significant components of noninterest income are
 
discussed in more detail below.
 
Deposit Fees
.
 
For 2020, deposit fees (service charge fees,
 
insufficient fund/overdraft fees (“NSF/OD”), and business account
analysis fees) totaled $17.8 million compared to $19.5 million
 
in 2019 and $20.1 million in 2018.
 
The $1.7 million, or 8.6%,
decrease in 2020 was attributable to lower NSF/OD fees and reflected
 
the impact of significant government stimulus in the second
quarter related to the COVID-19 pandemic.
 
For the second quarter of 2020, fees were down $1.3 million
 
compared to the first
quarter of 2020 and reflected lower utilization of our overdraft
 
product as consumer and business demand for this service
 
was
reduced by the impact of the significant cash stimulus provided
 
by the economic impact payments (EIP) and small business loans
(SBA PPP).
 
The decline in fees realized in the second quarter reversed
 
in the third and fourth quarters of 2020 as employment
conditions and economic activity began to recover resulting
 
in higher utilization of our overdraft product.
 
The $0.6 million, or
3.1%, decrease in 2019 reflected lower NSF/OD fees and
 
higher overdraft losses that were partially offset
 
by higher service
charge fees.
 
 
Bank Card Fees
.
 
Bank card fees totaled $13.0 million in 2020 compared
 
to $12.0 million in 2019 and $11.4
 
million in 2018.
Bank card fees in 2020 benefited from the effects
 
of the pandemic and increased on-line spending by our
 
clients.
 
An account
acquisition initiative that began in early 2019 and various
 
debit and credit card promotions contributed to the increases in both
2019 and 2020.
 
 
Wealth
 
Management Fees
.
 
Wealth management
 
fees including both trust fees (i.e., managed accounts and
 
trusts/estates) and
retail brokerage fees (i.e., investment, insurance products,
 
and retirement accounts) totaled $11.0 million in 2020 compared
 
to
$10.5 million in 2019 and $8.7 million in 2018.
 
The increase in fees for 2020 was attributable to a $0.3 million
 
increase in retail
brokerage fees and a $0.2 million increase in trust fees.
 
The growth in fees for 2019 reflected a $1.3 million
 
increase in retail
brokerage fees and $0.5 million increase in trust fees.
 
Higher transactions volumes and the addition of new investment
 
advisors
drove the increase in retail brokerage fees in 2019 and
 
2020.
 
Growth in assets under management contributed to the
 
growth in
trust fees in 2019 and 2020.
 
At December 31, 2020,
 
total assets under management were approximately $1.979 billion
 
compared
to $1.774 billion at December 31, 2019 and $1.500 billion
 
at December 31, 2018.
 
Mortgage Banking Revenues
.
 
Mortgage banking revenues totaled $63.3 million in 2020
 
compared to $5.3 million in 2019 and
$4.7 million in 2018.
 
The increase in 2020 reflected revenues added from the strategic
 
alliance with CCHL and the favorable
impact that the lower residential mortgage rate environment
 
had on home purchase,
 
construction, and refinancing activity in our
combined markets.
 
The increase in 2019 was attributable to higher production sold
 
into the secondary market at our legacy
residential mortgage operation versus loans retained
 
and held in the bank’s loan portfolio
 
.
 
We provide
 
a detailed overview of our
mortgage banking operation, including a detailed break-down
 
of mortgage banking revenues, mortgage servicing activity,
 
and
warehouse funding within Note 4 in the Notes to Consolidated
 
Financial Statements.
 
To date, the strategic
 
alliance has
significantly exceeded our pro forma expectations and served
 
as a hedge to the pressure on our net interest income
 
in 2020.
 
Refinancing activity represented 40% of loan production
 
at CCHL in 2020.
 
 
Other
.
 
Other noninterest income totaled $5.9 million in 2020 compared
 
to $5.8 million in 2019
 
and $6.6
 
million in 2018.
 
The
$0.1 million favorable variance in 2020 reflected higher
 
loan servicing fees added by CCHL substantially offset
 
by lower loan
related activity based fees.
 
The $0.9 million, or 13.0%, decrease in 2019 was primarily
 
due to a miscellaneous recovery in 2018
and lower miscellaneous loan fees.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
41
Noninterest Expense
 
 
For 2020, noninterest expense totaled $150.0 million,
 
an increase of $36.4 million over 2019 primarily attributable to the addition
of expenses at CCHL, including compensation expense of
 
$32.4 million, occupancy expense of $2.8 million, and other
 
expense of
$4.8 million.
 
Core CCBG noninterest expense decreased $3.6 million and
 
reflected lower compensation expense of $2.5 million,
ORE expense of $0.4 million, and other expense of $2.2 million,
 
partially offset by higher occupancy expense of
 
$1.5 million.
 
The decrease in compensation expense was primarily
 
attributable to lower commission expense of $2.2 million related
 
to the
transfer of our legacy mortgage production division
 
to CCHL and, to a lesser extent, higher realized loan cost of $0.4 million
related to the aforementioned increase in SBA PPP loan originations.
 
A $1.0 million gain from the sale of a banking office
 
in the
first quarter of 2020 drove the reduction in ORE expense.
 
The decline in other expense was primarily attributable to lower
service cost expense for our pension plan.
 
Higher expense for FF&E depreciation and maintenance agreements
 
(related to
technology investment and upgrades), higher than normal
 
premises maintenance, and pandemic related cleaning/supply
 
costs
drove the increase in occupancy.
 
 
For 2019, noninterest expense totaled $113.6
 
million, an increase of $2.1 million, or 1.9%, over 2018 attributable
 
to higher
compensation expense of $2.4 million that was partially
 
offset by a $0.3 million decrease in other expense.
 
The increase in
compensation expense was attributable to salary
 
expense (primarily merit raises) and commission expense (related
 
to residential
mortgage originations and retail brokerage transactions).
 
The decrease in other expense was primarily due to lower
 
professional
fees and insurance-other expense (primarily FDIC premiums)
 
that was partially offset by higher expense
 
for other real estate
(“OREO”) properties.
 
The increase in OREO was due to lower net gains from property sales in
 
2019.
 
 
Our operating efficiency ratio (expressed
 
as noninterest expense as a percent of taxable equivalent net
 
interest income plus
noninterest income) was 70.43%, 72.40%
 
and 77.05%
 
in 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively.
 
The improvement in this metric was
primarily attributable to higher noninterest income driven
 
by our strategic alliance with CCHL.
 
Improved operating leverage
primarily attributable to growth in net interest income was the primary
 
driver of improvement in 2019.
 
 
Expense management is an important part of our culture
 
and strategic focus.
 
We will continue
 
to review and evaluate
opportunities to optimize our delivery operations
 
and invest in technology that provides
 
favorable returns/scale and/or mitigates
risk.
 
 
CCHL’s
 
mortgage banking operations impacted our
 
noninterest expense for 2020 and thus, the year over year comparisons
 
reflect
the impact of the CCHL consolidation, which occurred
 
on March 1, 2020.
 
The table below reflects the major components of
noninterest expense for Core CCBG and CCHL to help facilitate
 
a better understanding of the 2020 versus 2019 comparison.
 
 
2020
2019
2018
(Dollars in Thousands)
Core CCBG
CCHL
CCBG
CCBG
Salaries
$
49,072
$
31,774
$
50,688
$
48,087
Associate Benefits
14,789
645
15,664
15,834
Total Compensation
63,861
32,419
66,352
63,921
Premises
9,194
1,318
8,734
8,913
Equipment
10,701
1,446
9,702
9,590
Total Occupancy
19,895
2,764
18,436
18,503
Legal Fees
1,600
(30)
1,722
2,055
Professional Fees
4,261
602
4,345
5,003
Processing Services
5,832
-
5,779
5,978
Advertising
1,970
1,028
2,056
1,611
Travel and Entertainment
580
275
1,045
974
Telephone
2,510
359
2,645
2,224
Insurance – Other
1,607
-
1,007
1,625
Other Real Estate, Net
122
(18)
546
(442)
Miscellaneous
7,743
2,582
9,676
10,051
Total Other Expense
26,225
4,798
28,821
29,079
Total Noninterest
 
Expense
$
109,981
$
39,981
$
113,609
$
111,503
 
 
42
Significant components of noninterest expense are
 
discussed in more detail below.
 
Compensation
.
 
Compensation expense totaled $96.3 million in 2020,
 
$66.4 million in 2019, and $63.9 million in 2018.
 
For
2020, the $29.9 million, or 45.1%, increase in consolidated
 
compensation expense reflected the addition of $32.4 million
 
in
compensation expense from CCHL.
 
Core CCBG compensation expense declined by $2.5
 
million,
 
primarily attributable to lower
commission expense of $2.2 million (transfer of residential
 
mortgage operations to CCHL), higher realized loan cost
 
(credit offset
to salary expense) of $0.4
 
million and lower associate benefit expense
 
of $0.9 million (primarily stock compensation and to a
lesser extent associate insurance), partially offset
 
by higher cash incentives of $0.2 million, base salaries of $0.3
 
million, and
contractual employment of $0.3 million (tax advisory services for
 
CCHL transaction).
 
 
For 2019, the $2.4 million, or 3.8%, increase over 2018
 
was attributable to higher salary expense of $2.6 million, partially offset
by lower associate benefit expense of $0.2 million.
 
Higher base salary expense and commission expense drove
 
the increase.
 
The
increase in base salaries primarily reflected merit raises and
 
the increase in commissions was related to the residential mortgage
and retail securities brokerage businesses.
 
 
Occupancy
.
 
Occupancy expense (including premises and equipment) totaled
 
$22.7 million for 2020, $18.4 million for 2019, and
$18.5 million for 2018.
 
For 2020, the $4.3 million, or 23.4%, increase in consolidated
 
occupancy expense reflected the addition
of $2.8 million in occupancy expense from CCHL.
 
Core CCBG occupancy expense increased $1.5 million
 
primarily due to
higher FF&E depreciation and maintenance agreement
 
expense (related to technology investment and upgrades), maintenance
 
for
premises, and pandemic related cleaning/supply costs.
 
Pandemic related costs reflected in occupancy expense for 2020
 
at Core
CCBG totaled approximately $0.3 million and will phase
 
out over a period of time as the pandemic subsides.
 
 
For 2019, the $0.1 million, or 0.4%, decrease from
 
2018 generally reflected the closing of two offices
 
in 2019.
 
 
Other
.
 
Other noninterest expense totaled $31.0 million in 2020
 
,
 
$28.8 million in 2019, and $29.1 million in 2018.
 
For 2020,
 
the
$2.2 million, or 7.6%, increase in consolidated
 
other expense reflected the addition of $4.8 million in expenses
 
from CCHL
partially offset by a $2.6 million decrease
 
in other expenses at Core CCBG.
 
Lower pension plan expense of $1.9 million (higher
unrealized gain amortization due to a lower discount
 
rate for pension liability),
 
ORE expense of $0.4 million (primarily due to a
$1.0 million gain from the sale of a banking office)
 
,
 
and travel/entertainment expense of $0.4 million (partially due
 
to lower travel
during pandemic) drove the decrease in other expenses
 
at Core CCBG.
 
 
For 2019, the $0.3 million, or 0.9%, decrease was primarily
 
attributable to lower professional fees of $0.7 million and
 
insurance-
other expense of $0.6 million,
 
partially offset by higher OREO expense of
 
$1.0 million.
 
The reduction in professional fees
reflected the completion of several consulting projects in
 
the second half of 2018.
 
Lower FDIC insurance premiums drove the
reduction in insurance-other expense as we used the bulk
 
of our premium credits in the third and fourth quarters of
 
2019.
 
The
increase in OREO expense was due to a lower
 
level of net gains from the sale of properties in 2019.
 
 
Income Taxes
 
 
For 2020, we realized income tax expense of $10.2
 
million (effective rate of 19%) compared to
 
$9.9 million (effective rate of
24%) for 2019 and $3.4 million (effective
 
rate of 12%) for 2018.
 
The decrease in our effective tax rate in 2020
 
reflected the
impact of converting CCHL to a partnership for tax purposes in
 
the second quarter of 2020.
 
In addition, 2020 income taxes
reflected net discrete tax expense items totaling $0.3 million.
 
Excluding discrete items, our effective tax rate was 19%
 
for 2020,
23% for 2019 and 24% for 2018.
 
Absent discrete items, we expect our annual effective
 
tax rate to approximate 18% to 19% in
2021.
 
 
In September 2019, Florida enacted a corporate tax
 
rate reduction from 5.5% to 4.5% retroactive to January 1,
 
2019.
 
As a result,
our deferred tax accounts were re-measured resulting in
 
a discrete tax expense of $0.4 million.
 
Further, our 2019 state tax rate
was adjusted to reflect the one percentage point reduction
 
which will be in effect through the end of 2021 at which
 
time it will
revert back to 5.5%.
 
On December 22, 2017, the Tax
 
Act was signed into law.
 
Among other things, the Tax
 
Act reduced our corporate federal tax rate
from 35% to 21% effective January 1, 2018.
 
During 2018, income tax expense included four discrete tax
 
benefit items totaling
$3.6 million resulting from the effect of the Tax
 
Act.
 
Three discrete items totaling $3.3 million related to pension
 
plan
contributions made in 2018 for the plan year 2017.
 
In addition, we realized a discrete tax item for $0.3 million related
 
to a tax
accounting method change for a cost segregation and depreciation
 
analysis for various properties we own which was filed with
the extended 2017 tax return.
 
 
43
FINANCIAL CONDITION
 
 
Average assets totaled
 
approximately $3.391 billion for 2020, an increase
 
of $404.0 million, or 13.5%, over 2019.
 
Average
earning assets were approximately $3.084 billion for 2020
 
,
 
an increase of $386.6 million, or 14.3%, over 2019.
 
Compared to
2019, average overnight funds increased $227.7 million,
 
while investment securities decreased $57.7 million and average
 
loans
were higher by $145.8 million.
 
We discuss these variances
 
in more detail below.
 
Table 2 provides
 
information on average balances and rates, Table
 
3 provides an analysis of rate and volume variances and Table
4 highlights the changing mix of our interest earning assets over
 
the last three years.
 
Loans
 
 
In 2020,
 
average loans HFI increased $145.8 million, or 8.1%, compared to
 
an increase of $100.1 million, or 5.8%, in 2019.
 
Compared to 2019, we realized average growth in all categories
 
except institutional loans, home equity loans, and consumer
loans.
 
During 2020, we originated PPP loans which averaged $128
 
million for the year.
 
 
In 2020, average loans held for sale (“HFS”) increased $70.8
 
million over 2019 due to the addition of loans from our
 
strategic
alliance with CCHL and the robust residential mortgage
 
market in 2020.
 
 
Loans HFI and HFS as a percentage of average earning
 
assets decreased to 66.1% in 2020 compared to 67.6% in
 
2019 and 67.1%
in 2018, primarily attributable to higher levels of overnight
 
funds due to growth in deposits.
 
 
We continue
 
to make minor modifications on some of our lending
 
programs to try and mitigate the impact that consumer
 
and
business deleveraging has had on our portfolio.
 
These programs, coupled with economic improvements in our
 
anchor markets
and loan purchases, have helped to increase overall loan growth.
 
 
We will periodically
 
purchase newly originated 1-4 family real estate secured adjustable
 
rate loans from CCHL.
 
Loan purchases
totaled $48.4 million and $25.2 million for the years ended
 
December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively.
 
The
strategic alliance with CCHL provides us a larger
 
pool of loan purchase opportunities, including participation
 
loans for
construction/perm product.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
44
Table 4
SOURCES OF EARNING ASSET GROWTH
2019 to
Percentage
Components of
2020
Total
Average
 
Earning Assets
(Average Balances –
 
Dollars In Thousands)
Change
Change
2020
2019
2018
Loans:
Loans HFS
$
70,776
18.3
%
2.6
%
0.4
%
0.3
%
Loans HFI:
Commercial, Financial, and Agricultural
106,870
27.6
11.7
9.4
8.7
Real Estate – Construction
25,552
6.6
4.0
3.7
3.3
Real Estate – Commercial Mortgage
37,962
9.8
21.1
22.7
22.1
Real Estate – Residential
(3,284)
(0.8)
11.5
13.2
12.9
Real Estate – Home Equity
(5,258)
(1.4)
6.4
7.5
8.5
Consumer
(16,004)
(4.1)
8.8
10.7
11.3
Total Loans HFS and
 
HFI
$
216,614
56.0
%
66.1
%
67.6
%
67.1
%
Investment Securities:
Taxable
$
(38,342)
(9.9)
%
18.6
%
22.7
%
25.0
%
Tax-Exempt
(19,348)
(5.0)
0.2
0.9
2.6
Total Securities
(57,690)
(14.9)
18.8
23.6
27.6
Funds Sold
227,653
58.9
15.1
8.8
5.3
Total Earning Assets
$
386,577
100.0
%
100.0
%
100.0
%
100.0
%
 
Our average total loans (HFS and HFI)-to-deposit
 
ratio was 71.7% in 2020, 71.8% in 2019, and 70.9% in
 
2018.
 
 
The composition of our HFI loan portfolio at December
 
31
st
 
for each of the past five years is shown in Table
 
5.
 
Table 6 arrays
our HFI loan portfolio at December 31, 2020,
 
by maturity period.
 
As a percentage of the HFI loan portfolio, loans with fixed
interest rates represented 42.4% at December 31, 2020
 
compared to 38.2% at December 31, 2019.
 
Stronger growth occurred in
our fixed rate loans, primarily due to the addition of
 
the PPP loans, which are short-term in nature.
 
Table 5
LOANS HFI BY CATEGORY
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
2017
2016
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
$
393,930
$
255,365
$
233,689
$
218,166
$
216,404
Real Estate – Construction
135,831
115,018
89,527
77,966
58,444
Real Estate – Commercial Mortgage
648,393
625,556
602,061
535,707
503,978
Real Estate – Residential
352,543
361,450
342,215
311,906
281,508
Real Estate – Home Equity
205,479
197,360
210,111
229,513
236,512
Consumer
270,250
281,180
296,622
280,234
264,443
Total Loans HFI
 
, Net of Unearned Income
$
2,006,426
$
1,835,929
$
1,774,225
$
1,653,492
$
1,561,289
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
45
Table 6
LOANS HFI MATURITIES
Maturity Periods
(Dollars in Thousands)
One Year
 
or Less
Over One
Through Five
Years
(2)
Over
 
Five Years
Total
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
$
38,500
$
309,124
$
46,306
$
393,930
Real Estate – Construction
75,009
33,506
27,316
135,831
Real Estate – Commercial Mortgage
39,333
89,138
519,922
648,393
Real Estate – Residential
20,153
62,853
269,537
352,543
Real Estate – Home Equity
5,165
26,925
173,389
205,479
Consumer
(1)
5,709
217,848
46,693
270,250
Total
$
183,869
$
739,394
$
1,083,163
$
2,006,426
Total Loans HFI
 
with Fixed Rates
$
106,087
$
562,810
$
180,969
$
849,866
Total Loans HFI
 
with Floating or Adjustable Rates
77,782
176,584
902,194
1,156,560
Total
$
183,869
$
739,394
$
1,083,163
$
2,006,426
(1)
Demand loans and overdrafts are
 
reported in the category of one
 
year or less.
(2)
Includes $178 million in fixed rate SBA PPP Loans
 
(commercial)
 
Risk Element Assets
 
 
Risk element assets consist of nonaccrual loans, OREO, troubled
 
debt restructurings (“TDRs”), past due loans, potential problem
loans, and loan concentrations.
 
Table 7 depicts certain
 
categories of our risk element assets as of December 31
st
 
for each of the
last five years.
 
 
Nonperforming assets (nonaccrual loans and OREO) totaled
 
$6.7 million at December 31, 2020 compared to
 
$5.4 million at
December 31, 2019.
 
Nonaccrual loans totaled $5.9 million at December 31, 2020,
 
a $1.4 million increase over December 31,
2019.
 
The balance of OREO totaled $0.8 million at December 31,
 
2020, a decrease of $0.1 million decrease from December
 
31,
2019.
 
Nonperforming assets represented 0.18%
 
of total assets at December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019
 
.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
46
Table 7
RISK ELEMENT ASSETS
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
2017
2016
Nonaccruing Loans:
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
$
161
$
446
$
267
$
629
$
468
Real Estate – Construction
179
-
722
298
311
Real Estate – Commercial Mortgage
1,412
1,434
2,860
2,370
3,410
Real Estate – Residential
3,130
1,392
2,119
1,938
2,330
Real Estate – Home Equity
695
797
584
1,748
1,774
Consumer
294
403
320
176
240
Total Nonaccruing
 
Loans (“NALs”)
(1)
5,871
4,472
6,872
7,159
8,533
Other Real Estate Owned
808
953
2,229
3,941
10,638
Total Nonperforming
 
Assets (“NPAs”)
6,679
5,425
9,101
11,100
19,171
Past Due Loans 30 – 89 Days
4,594
4,871
4,757
4,543
6,438
Past Due Loans 90 Days or More (accruing)
-
-
-
36
-
Performing Troubled Debt Restructurings
13,887
16,888
22,084
32,164
38,233
Classified Loans
$
17,631
$
20,847
$
22,888
$
31,002
$
41,507
Nonaccruing Loans/Loans
0.29
%
0.24
%
0.39
%
0.43
%
0.54
%
Nonperforming Assets/Total
 
Assets
0.18
0.18
0.31
0.38
0.67
Nonperforming Assets/Loans Plus OREO
0.33
0.29
0.51
0.67
1.21
Allowance/Nonaccruing Loans
405.66
%
310.99
%
206.79
%
185.87
%
157.40
%
(1)
 
Nonaccruing TDRs totaling $0.5 million, $0.7 million,
 
and $2.6 million are included in
 
NALs at December 31, 2020,
 
December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018, respectively.
 
Nonaccrual Loans
.
 
Nonaccrual loans totaled $5.9 million at December 31, 2020
 
,
 
an increase of $1.4 million over December 31,
2019.
 
Gross additions to nonaccrual status during 2020 totaled $11.4
 
million compared to $9.2 million in 2019.
 
 
Generally, loans
 
are placed on nonaccrual status if principal or interest payments
 
become 90 days past due or management deems
the collectability of the principal and interest to be doubtful.
 
Once a loan is placed in nonaccrual status, all previously
 
accrued
and uncollected interest is reversed against interest income.
 
Interest income on nonaccrual loans is recognized when
 
the ultimate
collectability is no longer considered doubtful.
 
Loans are returned to accrual status when the principal
 
and interest amounts
contractually due are brought current or when future
 
payments are reasonably assured.
 
If interest on our loans classified as
nonaccrual during 2020 had been recognized on a fully
 
accruing basis, we would have recorded an additional $0.4 million
 
of
interest income for the year ended December 31, 2020.
 
Other Real Estate Owned
.
 
OREO represents property acquired as the result of
 
borrower defaults on loans or by receiving a deed
in lieu of foreclosure.
 
OREO is recorded at the lower of cost or estimated fair value,
 
less estimated selling costs, at the time of
foreclosure.
 
Write-downs occurring at foreclosure
 
are charged against the allowance for loan losses.
 
On an ongoing basis,
properties are either revalued internally or by a third
 
party appraiser as required by applicable regulations.
 
Subsequent declines in
value are reflected as other noninterest expense.
 
Carrying costs related to maintaining the OREO properties are expensed
 
as
incurred and are also reflected as other noninterest expense.
 
OREO totaled $0.8 million at December 31, 2020
 
versus $1.0 million at December 31, 2019.
 
During 2020,
 
we added properties
totaling $2.3 million, sold properties totaling $1.7 million,
 
and recorded valuation adjustments totaling $0.8 million.
 
For 2019,
we added properties totaling $1.3 million, sold properties
 
totaling $2.3 million, and recorded valuation adjustments totaling
 
$0.3
million.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
47
The composition of our OREO portfolio as of December
 
31 is provided in the table below.
 
 
 
Table 8
OTHER REAL ESTATE
 
COMPOSITION
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
Lots/Land
$
51
$
87
Residential 1-4
49
383
Commercial Building
707
123
Other
1
360
Total OREO
$
808
$
953
 
Troubled
 
Debt Restructurings.
 
TDRs are loans on which, due to the deterioration in the
 
borrower’s financial condition, the
original terms have been modified and deemed
 
a concession to the borrower.
 
From time to time we will modify a loan as a
workout alternative.
 
Most of these instances involve an extension of the loan term, an
 
interest rate reduction, or a principal
moratorium.
 
A TDR classification can be removed if the borrower’s
 
financial condition improves such that the borrower is no
longer in financial difficulty,
 
the loan has not had any forgiveness of principal
 
or interest, and the loan is subsequently refinanced
or restructured at market terms and qualifies as a new
 
loan in calendar years after the year in which the restructuring took
 
place.
 
 
Loans classified as TDRs at December 31, 2020 totaled $14.3
 
million compared to $17.6 million at December 31,
 
2019.
 
Accruing TDRs made up approximately $13.9 million of our
 
TDR portfolio at December 31, 2020 of which $0.7 million
 
was over
30 days past due.
 
The weighted average rate for the loans within the accruing
 
TDR portfolio was 5.21%.
 
During 2020, we
modified three loan contracts totaling approximately $0.2
 
million.
 
Our TDR default rate (default balance as a percentage
 
of
average TDRs) in 2020 and 2019 was 2.9% and 3.0%,
 
respectively.
 
COVID Loan Extensions
.
 
To assist our clients
 
during the COVID-19 pandemic, beginning in March
 
2020, we began allowing
short term 60 to 90 day loan extensions for affected
 
borrowers.
 
We have extended
 
loans totaling $333 million of which
approximately 75% were for commercial borrowers
 
and 25% were for consumer borrowers.
 
Approximately $324 million, or 97%
of the loan balances associated with these borrowers
 
have resumed making regularly scheduled payments.
 
Of the $9 million in
loans that remain on extension, no loans were classified at December
 
31, 2020.
 
Of the $324 million in loans where the borrowers
have resumed payments, loan balances totaling $3.5
 
million were over 30 days delinquent and an additional $0.4 million
 
was on
nonaccrual status at December 31, 2020.
 
Under the applicable regulatory guidance, none of these loans were
 
considered
restructured at December 31, 2020.
 
We continue
 
to analyze our loan portfolio for segments that have been affected
 
by the stressed economic and business conditions
caused by the pandemic.
 
Certain at-risk segments total 8% of our loan balances at December 31,
 
2020, including hotel (3%),
restaurant (1%), retail and shopping centers (3%),
 
and other (1%).
 
The other segment includes churches, non-profits, education,
and recreational.
 
 
The composition of our TDR portfolio as of December 31 is provided
 
in the table below.
2020
2019
(Dollars in Thousands)
Accruing
Nonaccruing
(1)
Accruing
Nonaccruing
(1)
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
$
320
$
-
$
495
$
55
Real Estate – Commercial Mortgage
7,021
57
7,787
176
Real Estate – Residential
5,360
369
7,083
379
Real Estate – Home Equity
1,169
-
1,452
105
Consumer
17
29
71
-
Total TDRs
$
13,887
$
455
$
16,888
$
715
(1)
 
Nonaccruing TDRs are included in
 
NAL totals and NAL/NPA
 
ratio calculations.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
48
Activity within our TDR portfolio is provided in the table
 
below.
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
TDR Beginning Balance:
$
17,603
$
24,724
Additions
188
494
Charge-Offs
(322)
(364)
Paid Off/Payments
(2,463)
(5,162)
Removal Due to Change in TDR Status
(369)
(1,644)
Transferred to OREO
(295)
(445)
TDR Ending Balance
$
14,342
$
17,603
 
Past Due Loans
.
 
A loan is defined as a past due loan when one full payment is past
 
due or a contractual maturity is over 30 days
past due.
 
Past due loans at December 31, 2020 totaled $4.6 million compared
 
to $4.9
 
million at December 31, 2019.
 
 
Potential Problem Loans
.
 
Potential problem loans are defined as those loans which are now current
 
but where management has
doubt as to the borrower’s ability to comply
 
with present loan repayment terms.
 
At December 31, 2020,
 
we had $2.3
 
million in
loans of this type which were not included in either of
 
the nonaccrual, TDR or 90 day past due loan categories compared
 
to $2.5
million at December 31, 2019.
 
Management monitors these loans closely and reviews their
 
performance on a regular basis.
 
Loan Concentrations
.
 
Loan concentrations exist when there are amounts loaned
 
to multiple borrowers engaged in similar
activities which cause them to be similarly impacted by
 
economic or other conditions and such amount exceeds
 
10% of total
loans.
 
Due to the lack of diversified industry within our markets and
 
the relatively close proximity of the markets, we have both
geographic concentrations as well as concentrations in
 
the types of loans funded.
 
Specifically, due to the
 
nature of our markets, a
significant portion of our HFI loan portfolio has historically
 
been secured with real estate, approximately 67
 
%
 
at December 31,
2020 and 71% at December 31, 2019.
 
This percentage declined in 2020 due to the higher allocation
 
in the commercial loan
category which reflected $178 million in SBA PPP loans at December
 
31, 2020.
 
The primary types of real estate collateral are
commercial properties and 1-4 family residential properties.
 
 
The following table summarizes our real estate loan
 
portfolio as segregated by the type of property.
 
Property type concentrations
are stated as a percentage of December 31
st
 
total real estate loans.
 
2020
2019
Investor
Real Estate
Owner
Occupied
 
Real Estate
Investor
Real Estate
Owner
Occupied
 
Real Estate
Vacant
 
Land, Construction, and Land Development
14.7
%
-
13.1
%
-
Improved Property
28.5
56.8
%
25.8
61.1
%
Total Real Estate Loans
43.2
%
56.8
%
38.9
%
61.1
%
 
A major portion of our real estate loan portfolio is centered
 
in the owner occupied category which carries a lower risk of
 
non-
collection than certain segments of the investor category.
 
Approximately 35%
 
of the investor real estate category was secured by
residential real estate at December 31, 2020.
 
Allowance for Credit Losses
 
The allowance for credit losses is a valuation account that
 
is deducted from the loans’ amortized cost basis to present
 
the net
amount expected to be collected on the loans.
 
The allowance for credit losses is adjusted by a credit loss provision
 
which is
reported in earnings, and reduced by the charge
 
-off of loan amounts, net of recoveries.
 
Loans are charged off against the
allowance when management believes the uncollectability
 
of a loan balance is confirmed.
 
Expected recoveries do not exceed the
aggregate of amounts previously charged
 
-off and expected to be charged-off.
 
Expected credit loss inherent in non-cancellable
off-balance sheet credit exposures is provided
 
through the credit loss provision, but recorded as a separate
 
liability included in
other liabilities.
 
Management estimates the allowance balance using
 
relevant available information, from internal and external
 
sources, relating to
past events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable
 
forecasts.
 
Historical loan default and loss experience provides the
basis for the estimation of expected credit losses.
 
Adjustments to historical loss information incorporate management’s
 
view of
current conditions and forecasts.
 
 
Detailed information regarding the methodology for
 
estimating the amount reported in the allowance for credit
 
losses is provided
in Note 1 – Significant Accounting Policies/Allowance for
 
Credit Losses in the Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
49
 
Table 9 analyzes
 
the activity in the allowance over the past five years.
 
For 2020, our net loan charge-offs
 
totaled $2.4 million, or 0.12%, of average HFI loans, compared
 
to $2.3 million, or 0.13%, for
2019, and $2.0 million, or 0.12%, for 2018.
 
At December 31, 2020, the allowance represented 1.19% of
 
HFI loans and provided
coverage of 406% of nonperforming loans compared to
 
0.75% and 311%, respectively,
 
at December 31, 2019 and 0.80% and
207%, respectively,
 
at December 31, 2018.
 
At December 31, 2020, excluding SBA PPP loans (100% government
 
guaranteed),
the allowance represented 1.30% of loans held for investment.
 
Table 10 provides
 
an allocation of the allowance for loan losses to specific loan
 
types for each of the past five years.
 
At December 31, 2020, the allowance for credit losses totaled
 
$23.8 million compared to $13.9 million at December
 
31, 2019 and
$14.2 million at December 31, 2018.
 
The adoption of ASC 326 (“CECL”) on January 1, 2020 had an
 
impact of $4.0 million ($3.3
million increase in the allowance for credit losses and
 
$0.7 million increase in the allowance for unfunded loan commitments
(other liability account)).
 
The $6.6 million build (provision of $9.0 million less net
 
charge-offs of $2.4 million) in the allowance
for credit losses in 2020 was attributable to stressed economic
 
conditions related to the COVID-19 pandemic and
 
its potential
effect on rates of default.
 
For 2019, the slight decrease generally reflected improvement
 
in overall credit quality metrics.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
50
Table 9
ANALYSIS OF
 
ALLOWANCE
 
FOR CREDIT LOSSES
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
2017
2016
Balance at Beginning of Year
$
13,905
$
14,210
$
13,307
$
13,431
$
13,953
Impact of Adopting ASC 326 (CECL)
3,269
-
-
-
-
Charge-Offs:
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
789
768
644
1,357
861
Real Estate – Construction
-
281
7
-
-
Real Estate – Commercial
28
214
315
685
349
Real Estate – Residential
150
400
780
411
899
Real Estate – Home Equity
151
430
533
190
450
Consumer
2,785
2,878
2,395
2,193
2,127
Overdrafts
(1)
2,257
-
-
-
-
Total Charge
 
-Offs
6,160
4,971
4,674
4,836
4,686
Recoveries:
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
252
345
459
313
337
Real Estate – Construction
50
-
26
50
-
Real Estate – Commercial
318
578
373
174
408
Real Estate – Residential
279
429
643
616
1,231
Real Estate – Home Equity
178
175
191
219
409
Consumer
1,219
1,112
964
1,125
960
Overdrafts
(1)
1,471
-
-
-
-
Total Recoveries
3,767
2,639
2,656
2,497
3,345
Net Charge-Offs
2,393
2,332
2,018
2,339
1,341
Provision for Credit Losses - HFI
9,035
2,027
2,921
2,215
819
 
Balance at End of Year
 
- HFI
(2)
$
23,816
$
13,905
$
14,210
$
13,307
$
13,431
 
Net Charge-Offs to Average
 
Loans HFI
0.12
%
0.13
%
0.12
%
0.14
%
0.09
%
 
Allowance for Credit Losses as a Percent of
 
 
Loans HFI at End of Year
1.19
%
0.75
%
0.80
%
0.80
%
0.86
%
 
Allowance for Credit Losses as a Multiple of
 
 
Net Charge-Offs
9.95
x
5.96
x
7.04
x
5.69
x
10.02
x
(1)
Prior to 2020, overdraft losses were
 
reflected in noninterest
 
income (deposit fees)
(2)
Provision of $0.6 million in 2020
 
for unfunded loan commitments - balance of $1.6 million recorded
 
in other liabilities
 
at 12/31/20
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
51
Table 10
ALLOCATION OF
 
ALLOWANCE
 
FOR CREDIT LOSSES
2020
2019
2018
2017
2016
(Dollars in Thousands)
ACL
Amount
Percent
of Loans
to Total
Loans
ACL
Amount
Percent
of Loans
to Total
Loans
ACL
Amount
Percent
of Loans
to Total
Loans
ACL
Amount
Percent
of Loans
to Total
Loans
ACL
Amount
Percent
of Loans
to Total
Loans
Commercial, Financial
 
 
and Agricultural
$
2,204
19.6
%
$
1,675
13.9
%
$
1,434
13.1
%
$
1,191
13.2
%
$
1,198
13.8
%
Real Estate:
Construction
2,479
6.8
370
6.2
280
5.0
122
4.7
168
3.7
Commercial
7,029
32.3
3,416
33.9
4,181
33.8
4,346
32.3
4,315
32.1
Residential
5,440
17.6
3,128
20.1
3,400
19.6
3,206
19.1
3,445
18.6
Home Equity
3,111
10.2
2,224
10.7
2,301
11.8
2,506
13.8
2,297
15.0
Consumer
3,553
13.5
3,092
15.2
2,614
16.7
1,936
16.9
2,008
16.8
 
Total
$
23,816
100.0
%
$
13,905
100.0
%
$
14,210
100.0
%
$
13,307
100.0
%
$
13,431
100.0
%
 
Investment Securities
 
 
Our average investment portfolio balance decreased
 
$57.7 million, or 9.1%, in 2020 and decreased $71.1 million,
 
or 10.1%, in
2019.
 
As a percentage of average earning assets, our investment portfolio
 
represented 18.8% in 2020, compared to 23.8% in
2019.
 
In 2020,
 
the reduction in the investment portfolio was primarily attributable
 
to the inability to find compelling investments.
We currently
 
believe a relatively short duration investment portfolio offers
 
the flexibility to provide additional liquidity from
maturing bonds, if necessary.
 
In addition, we continue to review various investment
 
strategies to prudently deploy at least a
portion of our excess overnight funds.
 
In 2020, average taxable
 
investments decreased $38.3 million, or 6.3%, while tax-exempt
 
investments decreased $19.3 million, or
79.1%.
 
Taxable bonds declined
 
as part of our overall investment strategy,
 
and non-taxable investments decreased as the tax-
equivalent yield was generally unattractive throughout
 
2020 compared to taxable investments. At December 31, 2020,
 
municipal
securities (taxable and non-taxable) comprised 0.7%
 
of the portfolio.
 
We may consider
 
the purchase of municipal issues if the
yields become more attractive compared to taxable
 
securities, or if they are CRA-eligible investments.
 
 
Our investment portfolio is a significant component of
 
our operations and, as such, it functions as a key element
 
of liquidity and
asset/liability management.
 
Two types of classifications
 
are approved for investment securities which are Available
 
-for-Sale
(“AFS”) and Held-for-Maturity (“HTM”).
 
In 2019 and 2020, we purchased securities under both
 
the AFS and HTM designations.
At December 31, 2020, $324.9 million, or 65.7% of
 
our investment portfolio was classified as AFS, with the remaining
 
$169.9
million, or 34.3%, classified as HTM. At December 31,
 
2019, the AFS and HTM portfolio comprised 62.8%
 
and 37.2%,
respectively.
 
Table 11
 
provides the composition of our investment securities portfolio.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
52
Table 11
INVESTMENT SECURITES COMPOSITION
 
 
2020
2019
2018
(Dollars in Thousands)
Carrying
Amount
Percent
Carrying
Amount
Percent
Carrying
Amount
Percent
Available for
 
Sale
U.S. Government Treasury
$
104,519
21.1
%
$
232,778
36.2
%
$
261,849
39.5
%
U.S. Government Agency
208,531
42.2
156,078
24.3
133,206
20.1
States and Political Subdivisions
3,632
0.7
6,319
1.0
42,365
6.4
Mortgage-Backed Securities
515
0.1
773
0.1
943
0.1
Equity Securities
7,673
1.6
7,653
1.2
7,794
1.2
Total
 
324,870
65.7
403,601
62.8
446,157
67.2
Held to Maturity
U.S. Government Treasury
5,001
1.0
20,036
3.1
35,088
5.3
States and Political Subdivisions
-
-
1,376
0.2
6,512
1.0
Mortgage-Backed Securities
164,938
33.3
218,127
33.9
175,720
26.5
Total
169,939
34.3
239,539
37.2
217,320
32.8
Total Investment
 
Securities
$
494,809
100
%
$
643,140
100
%
$
663,477
100
%
 
The classification of a security is determined upon acquisition
 
based on how the purchase will affect our asset/liability
 
strategy
and future business plans and opportunities.
 
Classification determinations will also factor in regulatory capital requiremen
 
ts,
volatility in earnings or other comprehensive income, and
 
liquidity needs.
 
Securities in the AFS portfolio are recorded at fair
value with unrealized gains and losses associated with these securities
 
recorded net of tax, in the accumulated other
comprehensive income (loss) component of shareowners’
 
equity.
 
Securities designated as HTM are those acquired or owned with
the intent of holding them to maturity (final payment date).
 
HTM investments are measured at amortized cost.
 
It is neither
management’s current
 
intent nor practice to participate in the trading of investment securities for
 
the purpose of recognizing gains
and therefore we do not maintain a trading portfolio.
 
At December 31, 2020, there were 47 positions (combined
 
AFS and HTM) with unrealized losses totaling $0.2
 
million.
 
GNMA
mortgage-backed securities, U.S. Treasuries,
 
and SBA securities carry the full faith and credit guarantee
 
of the U.S. Government,
and are 0% risk-weighted assets.
 
SBA securities float monthly or quarterly with the prime
 
rate and are uncapped. None of these
positions with unrealized losses are considered credit impaired,
 
and all are expected to mature at par.
 
The table below provides a
break-down of our unrealized losses by security type.
 
 
Less Than 12 months
 
12 months or Longer
Total
Market
Unrealized
 
Market
Unrealized
 
Market
Unrealized
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Count
 
Value
 
Losses
Count
Value
 
Losses
Count
Value
 
Losses
SBA
36
28,266
156
11
4,670
28
47
32,936
184
Total
36
$
28,266
$
156
11
$
4,670
$
28
47
$
32,936
$
184
 
The average maturity of our investment portfolio at
 
December 31, 2020 was 2.09 years compared to 2.11
 
years at December 31,
2019.
 
Balances of U.S. Treasuries,
 
GNMA securities, and municipal bonds declined compared
 
to the prior year, and were
partially offset by increases in SBA securities.
 
The average life of our investment portfolio declined
 
slightly as the balance of the
overall portfolio declined, with the existing portfolio rolling
 
down the curve. See Table
 
12 for a break-down of maturities by
investment type.
 
 
The weighted average taxable equivalent yield of our
 
investment portfolio at December 31, 2020 was 1.78% versus
 
2.23% in
2019.
 
This decrease in yield reflected lower reinvestment rates during
 
most of 2020. Our bond portfolio contained no investments
in obligations, other than U.S. Governments, of any state,
 
municipality, political
 
subdivision or any other issuer that exceeded
10% of our shareowners’ equity at December 31, 2020.
 
 
Table 12 and
 
Note 2 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements present a detailed
 
analysis of our investment securities as
to type, maturity and yield at December 31.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
53
Table 12
MATURITY DISTRIBUTION
 
OF INVESTMENT SECURITIES
Within 1 year
1 - 5 years
5 - 10 years
After 10 years
Total
(Dollars in
Thousands)
Amount
WAY
(3)
Amount
WAY
(3)
Amount
WAY
(3)
Amount
WAY
(3)
Amount
WAY
(3)
Available for Sale
U.S. Government
Treasury
$
99,408
2.20
%
$
5,111
1.70
%
$
-
-
%
$
-
-
%
$
104,519
2.19
%
U.S. Government
Agency
8,802
0.52
195,183
1.49
4,546
1.16
-
-
208,531
1.45
States and Political
Subdivisions
1,833
3.01
1,799
3.11
-
-
-
-
3,632
3.06
Mortgage-Backed
Securities
(1)
73
0.61
406
4.96
36
3.46
-
-
515
4.24
Other Securities
(2)
-
-
-
-
-
-
7,673
5.24
7,673
5.24
Total
$
110,116
2.09
%
$
202,499
1.52
%
$
4,582
1.18
%
$
7,673
5.24
%
$
324,870
1.78
%
Held to Maturity
U.S. Government
Treasury
$
5,001
1.90
%
$
-
1.90
%
$
-
-
%
$
-
-
%
$
5,001
1.90
%
Mortgage-Backed
Securities
(1)
4,754
(0.39)
154,558
1.81
5,626
2.92
-
-
164,938
1.79
Total
$
9,755
0.78
%
$
154,558
1.81
%
$
5,626
2.92
%
$
-
-
%
$
169,939
1.79
%
Total Investment
Securities
$
119,871
1.99
%
$
357,057
1.65
%
$
10,208
2.14
%
$
7,673
5.24
%
$
494,809
1.78
%
(1)
 
Based on weighted-average maturity.
(2)
 
Federal Home Loan Bank Stock and Federal Reserve Bank Stock
 
are included in this category for weighted average yield, but do not have stated maturities.
(3)
 
Weighted average yield calculated based on current amortized cost balances – not presented on a tax equivalent basis.
 
Deposits and Short Term
 
Borrowings
 
 
Average total
 
deposits for 2020 were $2.844 billion, an increase of $306.9
 
million, or 12.1%, over 2019.
 
Average deposits
increased $114.5 million, or 4.7%, from
 
2018 to 2019.
 
The increase in 2020 occurred in all deposit types except
 
certificates of
deposit, with the largest increases occurring
 
in noninterest bearing and savings accounts.
 
The increase in 2019 occurred in
noninterest bearing deposits, negotiated NOW accounts,
 
and savings accounts, partially offset by declines
 
in money market
accounts and certificates of deposit.
 
 
Strong deposit growth occurred during the year reflecting
 
federal stimulus inflows as well as strong core deposit growth.
 
In
addition, the seasonal growth of public funds occurred
 
in the fourth quarter of 2020 and is expected to continue into
 
the first
quarter of 2021. Deposit levels remain strong as we continue to
 
see growth in our non-maturity deposits. Our mix of deposits
continues to improve as certificates of deposit are
 
replaced with noninterest bearing demand accounts.
 
 
We continue
 
to closely monitor several metrics such as the sensitivity of our
 
deposit rates, our overall liquidity position, and
competitor rates when pricing deposits. This strategy is consistent
 
with previous rate cycles, and allows us to manage
 
the mix of
our deposits rather than compete on rate. We
 
believe this enabled us to maintain a low cost of funds of
 
16 basis points for 2020
and 35 basis points for 2019.
 
Table 2 provides
 
an analysis of our average deposits, by category,
 
and average rates paid thereon for each of the last three years.
Table 13 reflects the
 
shift in our deposit mix over the last year and Table
 
14 provides a maturity distribution of time deposits in
denominations of $100,000 and over at December
 
31, 2020.
 
Average short
 
-term borrowings increased $59.8 million in 2020 due to the addition
 
of warehouse line borrowings of CCHL that
are used to support our held for sale loan portfolio.
 
See Note 11 in the Notes to Consolidated
 
Financial Statements for additional
information on short-term borrowings.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
54
We continue
 
to focus on the value of our deposit franchise, which produces
 
a strong base of core deposits with minimal reliance
on wholesale funding.
 
Table 13
SOURCES OF DEPOSIT GROWTH
 
2019 to
Percentage
Components of
2020
of Total
Total
 
Deposits
(Average Balances - Dollars
 
in Thousands)
Change
Change
2020
2019
2018
Noninterest Bearing Deposits
$
241,633
78.8
%
44.1
%
39.9
%
37.5
%
NOW Accounts
21,146
6.9
29.0
31.7
32.2
Money Market Accounts
86
-
8.3
9.3
10.4
Savings
53,099
17.3
14.9
14.6
14.5
Time Deposits
(9,106)
(3.0)
3.7
4.5
5.4
Total Deposits
$
306,858
100.0
%
100.0
%
100.0
%
100.0
%
 
Table 14
MATURITY DISTRIBUTION
 
OF CERTIFICATES
 
OF DEPOSIT $100,000 AND OVER
2020
(Dollars in Thousands)
Time Certificates
 
of Deposit
Percent
Three months or less
$
7,403
25.4
%
Over three through six months
7,449
25.6
Over six through twelve months
10,557
36.2
Over twelve months
3,741
12.8
Total
$
29,150
100.0
%
 
Market Risk and Interest Rate Sensitivity
 
 
Overview.
 
Market risk arises from changes in interest rates, exchange
 
rates, commodity prices, and equity prices.
 
We have risk
management policies designed to monitor and limit exposure
 
to market risk and we do not participate in activities that give rise
 
to
significant market risk involving exchange rates, commodity
 
prices, or equity prices.
 
In asset and liability management activities,
our policies are designed to minimize structural intere
 
st rate risk.
 
Interest Rate Risk Management.
 
Our net income is largely dependent on net interest
 
income.
 
Net interest income is susceptible to
interest rate risk to the degree that interest-bearing
 
liabilities mature or reprice on a different basis than interest-earning
assets.
 
When interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice
 
more quickly than interest-earning assets in a given period, a
 
significant
increase in market rates of interest could adversely affect
 
net interest income.
 
Similarly, when interest
 
-earning assets mature or
reprice more quickly than interest-bearing liabilities, falling
 
market interest rates could result in a decrease in
 
net interest
income.
 
Net interest income is also affected by changes in the portion
 
of interest-earning assets that are funded by interest-
bearing liabilities rather than by other sources of
 
funds, such as noninterest-bearing deposits and shareowners’
 
equity.
 
We have established
 
what we believe to be a comprehensive interest rate risk
 
management policy,
 
which is administered by
management’s Asset Liability
 
Management Committee (“ALCO”).
 
The policy establishes limits of risk, which are quantitative
measures of the percentage change in net interest income
 
(a measure of net interest income at risk) and the fair value
 
of equity
capital (a measure of economic value of equity (“EVE”)
 
at risk) resulting from a hypothetical change in interest rates for
maturities from one day to 30 years.
 
We measure the
 
potential adverse impacts that changing interest rates may have on
 
our
short-term earnings, long-term value, and liquidity by
 
employing simulation analysis through the use of computer
 
modeling.
 
The
simulation model captures optionality factors such
 
as call features and interest rate caps and floors imbedded in investment
 
and
loan portfolio contracts.
 
As with any method of gauging interest rate risk, there are
 
certain shortcomings inherent in the interest
rate modeling methodology used by us.
 
When interest rates change, actual movements in different
 
categories of interest-earning
assets and interest-bearing liabilities, loan prepayments,
 
and withdrawals of time and other deposits, may deviate
 
significantly
from assumptions used in the model.
 
Finally, the methodology
 
does not measure or reflect the impact that higher rates may have
on adjustable-rate loan clients’ ability to service their debts,
 
or the impact of rate changes on demand for loan and
 
deposit
products.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
55
The balance sheet is subject to testing for interest rate
 
shock possibilities to indicate the inherent interest rate risk.
 
We prepare a
current base case and several alternative interest rate simulations
 
(-100,+100, +200, +300, and +400 basis points (bp)), at least
once per quarter, and report the analysis
 
to ALCO, our Market Risk Oversight Committee (“MROC”), our
 
Enterprise Risk
Oversight Committee (“EROC”) and the Board of Directors.
 
(The -200bp rate scenario was not modeled starting in the second
half of 2019 due to the low interest rate environment below
 
2.00%). We
 
augment our interest rate shock analysis with alternative
interest rate scenarios on a quarterly basis that may include
 
ramps, parallel shifts, and a flattening or steepening of
 
the yield curve
(non-parallel shift).
 
In addition, more frequent forecasts may be produced when
 
interest rates are particularly uncertain or when
other business conditions so dictate.
 
Our goal is to structure the balance sheet so that net
 
interest earnings at risk over 12-month and 24-month periods
 
and the
economic value of equity at risk do not exceed policy
 
guidelines at the various interest rate shock levels. We
 
attempt to achieve
this goal by balancing, within policy limits, the volume
 
of floating-rate liabilities with a similar volume of floating-rate assets, by
keeping the average maturity of fixed-rate asset and liability contracts
 
reasonably matched, by managing the mix of our core
deposits, and by adjusting our rates to market conditions
 
on a continuing basis. At December 31, 2019, the instantaneous rate
shock of down 100 bp over 24-months was slightly outside
 
of desired parameters due to limited repricing of deposits relative
 
to
the decline in rates.
 
 
Analysis.
 
Measures of net interest income at risk produced by simulation
 
analysis are indicators of an institution’s
 
short-term
performance in alternative rate environments.
 
These measures are typically based upon a relatively brief
 
period, and do not
necessarily indicate the long-term prospects or economic
 
value of the institution.
 
 
ESTIMATED CHANGES
 
IN NET INTEREST INCOME
(1)
 
Percentage Change (12-month shock)
+400 bp
+300 bp
+200 bp
+100 bp
-100 bp
Policy Limit
-15.0
%
-12.5
%
-10.0
%
-7.5
%
-7.5
%
December 31, 2020
39.0
%
28.7
%
18.7
%
9.0
%
-3.0
%
December 31, 2019
13.8
%
10.3
%
6.8
%
3.4
%
-6.2
%
Percentage Change (24-month shock)
+400 bp
+300 bp
+200 bp
+100 bp
-100 bp
Policy Limit
-17.5
%
-15.0
%
-12.5
%
-10.0
%
-10.0
%
December 31, 2020
54.2
%
38.3
%
22.6
%
7.6
%
-10.9
%
December 31, 2019
35.5
%
26.4
%
17.2
%
8.2
%
-13.4
%
 
The Net Interest Income (“NII”) at Risk position was more
 
favorable at December 31, 2020 compared to December
 
31, 2019 for
the 12-month shock for all rate scenarios. The year-over-year
 
favorable changes were primarily driven by growth in our
noninterest bearing deposits, which have a positive impact
 
on our NII. The model indicates that in the short-term,
 
all rising rate
environments will positively impact the net interest margin
 
of the Company,
 
while a declining rate environment of 100 bp will
have a negative impact on the net interest margin.
 
 
All measures of Net Interest Income at Risk are within
 
our prescribed policy limits over both the 12-month and 24-month periods,
with the exception of rates down 100 bp over 24-months.
 
We are slightly out
 
of compliance in this rates down 100 bp scenario as
we have a limited ability to lower our deposit rates the
 
full 100 bp relative to the decline in market rate.
 
In addition, this analysis
incorporates an instantaneous, parallel shock and assumes
 
we move with market rates and do not lag our deposit rates.
 
 
The measures of equity value at risk indicate our ongoing
 
economic value by considering the effects of changes
 
in interest rates
on all of our cash flows by discounting the cash flows
 
to estimate the present value of assets and liabilities. The difference
between these discounted values of the assets and liabilities is
 
the economic value of equity,
 
which in theory approximates the fair
value of our net assets.
 
ESTIMATED CHANGES
 
IN ECONOMIC VALUE
 
OF EQUITY
(1)
 
Changes in Interest Rates
+400 bp
+300 bp
+200 bp
+100 bp
-100 bp
Policy Limit
-30.0
%
-25.0
%
-20.0
%
-15.0
%
-15.0
%
December 31, 2020 (Base Scenario)
(2)
160.9
%
127.5
%
89.9
%
48.4
%
-90.4
%
December 31, 2019 (Base Scenario)
37.5
%
30.2
%
21.7
%
12.2
%
-22.0
%
December 31, 2020 (Alternate Scenario)
(2)
50.0
%
31.4
%
10.6
%
-3.9
%
-0.6
%
 
 
56
At December 31, 2020,
 
the economic value of equity was more favorable in all up-rate scenarios
 
and is within prescribed
tolerance levels, but is less favorable and out of policy
 
in the down 100 basis point EVE scenario.
 
The year-over-year favorable
changes were primarily driven by growth in our
 
noninterest bearing deposits compared to the prior year.
 
EVE became less
favorable in rates down 100bp compared to the
 
prior year as we have limited ability to lower our deposit
 
rates relative to the
decline in market rates.
 
EVE output is extreme given the historically low rate environment,
 
in conjunction with the high
overnight funds sold balance when compared to December
 
31, 2019.
 
Given the current interest rate environment and the
historically high levels of liquidity,
 
management is monitoring the EVE analysis in light of the economic
 
recovery, but has chosen
not to institute immediate balance sheet changes to address
 
the down 100 basis point scenario.
 
In an alternate EVE scenario
where the value of our nonmaturity deposits are capped
 
at their book value, we are within policy guidelines.
 
 
As the interest rate environment and the dynamics of the
 
economy continue to change, additional simulations will be analyzed
 
to
address not only the changing rate environment, but also
 
the changing balance sheet mix, measured over multiple
 
years, to help
assess the risk to the Company.
 
 
(1)
 
Down 200, 300 and 400 bp rate scenarios have been excluded
 
due to the current interest
 
rate environment.
 
(2)
 
For the rates down 100 bp scenario, the high negative
 
percentage change is due to a negative value
 
assigned to our
nonmaturity deposits.
 
Since we believe our nonmaturity deposits are
 
highly valued core franchise deposits,
 
we run an
alternate EVE calculation which caps the projected
 
value of our nonmaturity deposits at their book value.
 
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL
 
RESOURCES
 
 
Liquidity
 
 
In general terms, liquidity is a measurement of our ability
 
to meet our cash needs.
 
Our objective in managing our liquidity is to
maintain our ability to fund loan commitments, purchase
 
securities, accommodate deposit withdrawals or repay other liabilities in
accordance with their terms, without an adverse impact
 
on our current or future earnings.
 
Our liquidity strategy is guided by
policies that are formulated and monitored by our
 
ALCO and senior management, and which take into account
 
the marketability
of assets, the sources and stability of funding and the level
 
of unfunded commitments.
 
We regularly evaluate
 
all of our various
funding sources with an emphasis on accessibility,
 
stability, reliability
 
and cost-effectiveness.
 
For 2020 and 2019, our principal
source of funding was client deposits, supplemented
 
by our short-term and long-term borrowings, primarily from our trust-
preferred securities, securities sold under repurchase agreements,
 
federal funds purchased and FHLB borrowings.
 
We believe that
the cash generated from operations, our borrowing capacity
 
and our access to capital resources are sufficient
 
to meet our future
operating capital and funding requirements.
 
At December 31, 2020, we had the ability to generate
 
approximately $1.198 billion in additional liquidity through all of
 
our
available resources beyond our overnight funds sold
 
position.
 
In addition to the primary borrowing outlets mentioned above,
 
we
also have the ability to generate liquidity by borrowing
 
from the Federal Reserve Discount Window and
 
through brokered
deposits.
 
We recognize
 
the importance of maintaining liquidity and have developed a Contingent
 
Liquidity Plan, which addresses
various liquidity stress levels and our response and
 
action based on the level of severity.
 
We periodically
 
test our credit facilities
for access to the funds, but also understand that as the
 
severity of the liquidity level increases certain credit facilities may
 
no
longer be available.
 
We conduct quarterly
 
liquidity stress tests and the results are reported to ALCO, MROC, EROC and
 
the
Board of Directors.
 
We believe the
 
liquidity available to us is sufficient to meet our
 
ongoing needs.
 
We also view our
 
investment portfolio as a liquidity source and have the option
 
to pledge securities in our portfolio as collateral
for borrowings or deposits, and/or sell selected securities.
 
Our portfolio consists of debt issued by the U.S. Treasury,
 
U.S.
governmental agencies, and municipal governments.
 
The weighted-average maturity of our portfolio was 2.09
 
years at December
31, 2020 and had a net unrealized pre-tax gain of $3.7
 
million in the AFS portfolio.
 
Our average net overnight funds sold position (defined
 
as funds sold plus interest-bearing deposits with other banks less funds
purchased) was $465.7 million in 2020 compared to
 
an average net overnight funds sold position of $238.0 million
 
in 2019.
 
The
increase in this position in 2020 reflected strong deposit
 
growth, primarily related to government stimulus program
 
inflows
(primarily noninterest bearing deposits)
 
and runoff from the investment portfolio,
 
partially offset by higher growth in the loan
portfolio.
 
 
We expect
 
capital expenditures over the next 12 months to be approximately
 
$7.0 million, which will consist primarily of
technology purchases for banking offices,
 
business applications, and information technology security
 
needs as well as furniture
and fixtures and banking office remodels.
 
We expect that these capital
 
expenditures will be funded with existing resources
without impairing our ability to meet our ongoing obligations.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
57
Long-Term
 
Borrowings
 
 
At December 31, 2020,
 
total advances from the FHLB consisted of $2.2 million
 
in outstanding debt comprised of seven notes.
 
In
2020,
 
the Bank made FHLB advance payments totaling $3.2 million.
 
One advance matured, and one was paid off, with no
 
new
fixed rate advances obtained in 2020. The FHLB notes are
 
collateralized by a blanket floating lien on all of our 1-4
 
family
residential mortgage loans, commercial real estate mortgage
 
loans, and home equity mortgage loans.
 
 
We have issued
 
two junior subordinated deferrable interest notes to wholly
 
owned Delaware statutory
 
trusts.
 
The first note for
$30.9 million was issued to CCBG Capital Trust
 
I in November 2004.
 
The second note for $32.0 million was issued to CCBG
Capital Trust II in May 2005.
 
 
During the second quarter of 2020 we entered into a
 
derivative cash flow hedge of our interest rate risk related to
 
our
subordinated debt.
 
The notional amount of the derivative is $30 million ($10
 
million of the CCBG Capital Trust I borrowing
 
and
$20 million of the CCBG Capital Trust II
 
borrowing).
 
The interest rate swap agreement requires CCBG to pay fixed and receive
variable (Libor plus spread) and has an average all-in
 
fixed rate of 2.50% for 10 years.
 
Additional detail on the interest rate swap
agreement is provided in Note 5 – Derivatives in the Consolidated
 
Financial Statements.
 
See Note 12 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for
 
additional information on long-term borrowings.
 
Table 15
 
CONTRACTUAL CASH OBLIGATIONS
 
Table 15 sets forth
 
certain information about contractual cash obligations
 
at December 31, 2020.
 
Payments Due By Period
(Dollars in Thousands)
< 1 Yr
> 1 – 3 Yrs
> 3 – 5 Yrs
> 5 Yrs
Total
Warehouse
 
Lines
(1)
$
74,782
$
-
$
-
$
-
$
74,782
Federal Home Loan Bank Advances
733
1,131
314
-
2,178
Note Payable
296
592
12
-
900
Subordinated Notes Payable
-
-
-
52,887
52,887
Operating Lease Obligations
1,707
2,353
1,685
11,129
16,874
Time Deposit Maturities
83,989
14,094
3,511
-
101,594
Total Contractual
 
Cash Obligations
$
86,725
$
18,170
$
5,522
$
64,016
$
174,433
(1)
 
Used to fund HFS loan portfolio at CCHL
 
Capital
 
Shareowners’ equity was $320.8 million at December
 
31, 2020 compared to $327.0 million at December 31, 2019.
 
During 2020,
shareowners’ equity was positively impacted by net
 
income of $31.6 million, a $1.8 million increase in the unrealized
 
gain on
investment securities, net adjustments totaling $1.4
 
million related to transactions under our stock compensation
 
plans, stock
compensation accretion of $0.9 million, and a $0.4 million
 
increase in fair value of the interest rate swap related to subordinated
debt.
 
Shareowners’ equity was reduced by an $18.2 million increase in the
 
accumulated other comprehensive loss for our pension
plan, common stock dividends of $9.6 million ($0.57 per
 
share), a $3.1 million (net of tax) adjustment to retained earnings for
 
the
adoption of CECL, reclassification of $9.4 million to
 
temporary equity to increase the redemption value of the non-controlling
interest in CCHL, and share repurchases of $2.0 million
 
(99,952 shares).
 
Shareowners' equity as of December 31, for each of
 
the last three years is presented below:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
Common Stock
$
168
$
168
$
167
Additional Paid-in Capital
32,283
32,092
31,058
Retained Earnings
332,528
322,937
300,177
Subtotal
364,979
355,197
331,402
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss, Net of Tax
(44,142)
(28,181)
(28,815)
Total Shareowners’
 
Equity
$
320,837
$
327,016
$
302,587
 
 
58
We continue
 
to maintain a strong capital position.
 
The ratio of shareowners' equity to total assets at year-end was 8.45
 
%, 10.59%,
and 10.23%, in 2019, 2018, and 2018, respectively.
 
Further, our tangible common equity,
 
was 6.25% at December 31, 2020
compared to 8.06% at December 31, 2019, respectively.
 
The reduction in ratios in 2020 primarily reflected the significant growth
in assets during the year.
 
We are subject
 
to regulatory risk-based capital requirements that measure
 
capital relative to risk-weighted assets and off-balance
sheet financial instruments.
 
At December 31, 2020, our total risk-based capital ratio
 
was 17.30% compared to 17.90% at
December 31, 2019.
 
Our common equity tier 1 capital ratio was 13.71% and 14.47%,
 
respectively, on these dates.
 
Our leverage
ratio was 9.33% and 11.25%, respectively,
 
on these dates.
 
For a detailed discussion of our regulatory capital requirements,
 
refer
to the “Regulatory Considerations – Capital Regulations”
 
section on page 14.
 
See Note 17 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial
Statements for additional information as to our capital
 
adequacy.
 
 
At December 31, 2020,
 
our common stock had a book value of $19.05 per diluted share
 
compared to $19.40 at December 31,
2019.
 
Book value is impacted by the net unrealized gains and losses on
 
investment securities.
 
At December 31, 2020,
 
the net
unrealized gain was $2.7 million compared to $0.9
 
million at December 31, 2019.
 
Book value is also impacted by the recording
of our unfunded pension liability through other comprehensive
 
income in accordance with Accounting Standards Codification
Topic 715.
 
At December 31, 2020,
 
the net pension liability reflected in accumulated other comprehensive
 
loss was $47.3 million
compared to $29.0 million at December 31, 2019.
 
The unfavorable adjustment to our unfunded pension
 
liability was attributable
to the lower discount rate used to calculate the present
 
value of the pension obligation.
 
The lower discount rate reflected the
significant decline in long-term interest rates in 2020.
 
This adjustment also unfavorably impacted our tangible capital ratio.
 
Further, book value is impacted by
 
the periodic adjustment made to record temporary equity at redemption
 
value.
 
At December
31, 2020, $9.4 million had been reclassified from retained
 
earnings to temporary equity during 2020 to increase the redemption
value of the non-controlling interest in CCHL.
 
In February 2014, our Board of Directors authorized the
 
repurchase of up to 1,500,000 shares of our outstanding
 
common stock
over a five-year period.
 
Repurchases may be made in the open market or in privately
 
negotiated transactions; however,
 
we are
not obligated to repurchase any specified number of shares.
 
In January, 2019, the
 
2014 plan was terminated and our Board of
Directors approved a new share repurchase plan that
 
authorizes the repurchase of up to 750,000 shares of our outstanding
common stock over a five-year period.
 
Terms of this plan
 
are substantially similar to the 2014 plan.
 
99,952 shares were
repurchased in 2020 at an average price of $20.39 and 77,000
 
shares were repurchased in 2019 at an average price of $23.40.
 
Since 2014, a total of 1,361,682 shares of our outstanding
 
common stock have been repurchased at an average price of
 
$17.93
under our stock repurchase plans.
 
 
Dividends
 
 
Adequate capital and financial strength is paramount
 
to our stability and the stability of our subsidiary bank.
 
Cash dividends
declared and paid should not place unnecessary strain
 
on our capital levels.
 
When determining the level of dividends the
following factors are considered:
 
 
Compliance with state and federal laws and regulations;
 
Our capital position and our ability to meet our financial obligations;
 
Projected earnings and asset levels; and
 
The ability of the Bank and us to fund dividends.
 
Inflation
 
 
The impact of inflation on the banking industry differs
 
significantly from that of other industries in which a large
 
portion of total
resources are invested in fixed assets such as property,
 
plant and equipment.
 
Assets and liabilities of financial institutions are
virtually all monetary in nature, and therefore are primarily
 
impacted by interest rates rather than changing prices.
 
While the
general level of inflation underlies most interest rates, interest rates
 
react more to changes in the expected rate of inflation
 
and to
changes in monetary and fiscal policy.
 
Net interest income and the interest rate spread are good measures
 
of our ability to react to
changing interest rates and are discussed in further detail
 
in the section entitled “Results of Operations.”
 
OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS
 
 
We are a party
 
to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risks in the
 
normal course of business to meet the financing needs
of our clients.
 
See Note 19 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
 
 
59
At December 31, 2020,
 
we had $756.9 million in commitments to extend credit and $6.5 million
 
in standby letters of credit.
 
Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend
 
to a client so long as there is no violation of any condition established in
 
the
contract.
 
Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other
 
termination clauses and may require payment of a fee.
 
Since many of the commitments may expire without being
 
drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily
represent future cash requirements.
 
The increase in commitments to extend credit in 2020 reflected
 
the addition of interest rate
lock commitments for CCHL which are funded through
 
warehouse lines of credit.
 
Standby letters of credit are conditional
commitments issued by us to guarantee the performance of
 
a client to a third party.
 
We use the same credit
 
policies in
establishing commitments and issuing letters of credit
 
as we do for on-balance sheet instruments.
 
 
If commitments arising from these financial instruments
 
continue to require funding at historical levels, management does not
anticipate that such funding will adversely impact our ability to
 
meet on-going obligations.
 
In the event these commitments
require funding in excess of historical levels, management
 
believes current liquidity,
 
investment security maturities, available
advances from the FHLB and Federal Reserve Bank, and
 
warehouse lines of credit provide a sufficient source
 
of funds to meet
these commitments.
 
In conjunction with the sale and securitization of loans
 
held for sale and their related servicing rights, we may be
 
exposed to
liability resulting from recourse, repurchase and
 
make-whole agreements.
 
If it is determined subsequent to our sale of a loan or
its related servicing rights that a breach of the representatio
 
ns or warranties made in the applicable sale agreement
 
has occurred,
which may include guarantees that prepayments will not
 
occur within a specified and customary time frame, we
 
may have an
obligation to either (a) repurchase the loan for the unpaid
 
principal balance, accrued interest and related advances,
 
(b) indemnify
the purchaser against any loss it suffers or
 
(c) make the purchaser whole for the economic benefits of the
 
loan and its related
servicing rights.
 
Our repurchase, indemnification and make-whole obligations vary
 
based upon the terms of the applicable agreements, the nature
of the asserted breach and the status of the mortgage
 
loan at the time a claim is made. We
 
establish reserves for estimated losses
of this nature inherent in the origination of mortgage loans by
 
estimating the losses inherent in the population of all loans sold
based on trends in claims and actual loss severities experienced.
 
The reserve will include accruals for probable contingent losses
in addition to those identified in the pipeline of claims received.
 
The estimation process is designed to include amounts based on
actual losses experienced from actual activity.
 
FOURTH QUARTER,
 
2020 FINANCIAL RESULTS
 
Results of Operations
 
We realized net
 
income of $7.7 million, or $0.46 per diluted share for the fourth
 
quarter of 2020 compared to $10.4 million, or
$0.62 per diluted share for the third quarter of 2020.
 
The decrease in earnings reflected a $4.5 million decrease in
 
noninterest
income, a $1.0 million increase in noninterest expense,
 
and a $0.1 million
 
decrease in net interest income, partially offset by a
 
$2.6
million decrease in the non-controlling interest in earnings
 
from CCHL, and lower income taxes of $0.3 million.
 
 
Tax-equivalent
 
net interest income for the fourth quarter of 2020 was $25.1
 
million compared to $25.2 million for the third quarter
of 2020.
 
The decrease reflected lower rates earned on investment securities and
 
variable/adjustable rate loans.
 
Our net interest
margin for the fourth quarter of 2020 was 3.00%,
 
a decrease of 12 basis points from the third quarter of 2020.
 
Our net interest margin for the fourth quarter
 
of 2020 was 3.00%, a decrease of 12 basis points from
 
the third quarter of 2020
driven by a higher level of overnight funds reflective of
 
seasonal public fund inflows and continued growth in core deposits.
 
Our
net interest margin for the fourth quarter of 2020,
 
excluding the impact of overnight funds in excess of $200 million,
 
was 3.50%.
 
The provision for credit losses was $1.3 million
 
for both the third and fourth quarters of 2020.
 
The provision for the fourth
quarter reflected a slight build in additional reserves held
 
for COVID-19 exposure.
Noninterest income for the fourth quarter of 2020
 
totaled $30.5 million compared to $35.0 million for the third quarter
 
of 2020
with the decrease attributable to lower mortgage
 
banking revenues of $5.3 million, partially offset by
 
higher deposit activity fees
of $0.5 million and wealth management fees of $0.3
 
million.
 
The decline in mortgage banking revenues reflected a seasonal
slowdown in loan production and a lower gain on sale margin.
 
Noninterest expense for the fourth quarter of 2020
 
totaled $41.3 million compared to $40.3 million for the third quarter
 
of 2020
with the increase primarily attributable to higher compensation
 
expense of $0.6 million and other real estate expense of $0.3
million.
 
The increase in compensation reflected higher commission expense
 
of $0.2 million, salary expense of $0.2 million, and
cash incentive expense of $0.2 million.
 
Valuation
 
adjustments totaling $0.5 million for two properties drove the increase
 
in other
real estate expense.
 
In addition, we recognized $0.4 million in expenses during
 
the fourth quarter of 2020 related to additional
funding of our foundation and consulting/legal costs for
 
a strategic initiative.
 
 
 
60
We realized income
 
tax expense of $2.8 million (effective rate of 22%)
 
for the fourth quarter of 2020 compared to $3.2 million
(effective rate of 17%) for the third quarter
 
of 2020.
 
Tax expense for
 
the fourth quarter of 2020 was unfavorably impacted by a
$0.3 million discrete tax expense.
 
 
Discussion of Financial Condition
 
Average earning
 
assets were $3.337 billion for the fourth quarter of 2020, an
 
increase of $113.6 million, or 3.5%, over the third
quarter of 2020 attributable to a higher level of
 
deposits primarily seasonal public fund inflows and growth
 
in core deposits.
 
Average loans
 
HFI decreased $11.7 million, or 0.6%, from
 
the third quarter of 2020,
 
partially due to SBA PPP loan pay-offs.
 
Period-end HFI loans increased $8.3 million, or 0.4%, over
 
the third quarter of 2020 and reflected higher home equity,
construction, and residential loan balances.
 
At December 31, 2020, SBA PPP loans of $150,000 or less totaled
 
$69 million.
 
SBA
PPP loan fees totaled approximately $0.8 million for the
 
fourth quarter of 2020 and $0.6 million for the third
 
quarter of 2020.
 
At
December 31, 2020 we had $3.2 million (net) in deferred
 
SBA PPP loan fees.
 
Nonperforming assets (nonaccrual loans and OREO) totaled
 
$6.7 million at December 31, 2020, comparable
 
to September 30,
2020.
 
Nonaccrual loans totaled $5.9 million at December 31, 2020, a
 
$0.4 million increase over September 30, 2020.
 
The
balance of OREO totaled $0.8 million at December
 
31, 2020, a decrease of $0.4 million from September 30,
 
2020.
 
We continue
 
to analyze our loan portfolio for segments that have been affected
 
by the stressed economic and business conditions
caused by the pandemic.
 
To assist our clients, in
 
mid-March of 2020, we began allowing short term 60 to 90
 
day loan extensions
for affected borrowers.
 
We have extended
 
loans totaling $333 million of which 75% were for commercial borrowers
 
and 25%
were for consumer borrowers.
 
At December 31, 2020, approximately $324 million,
 
or 97% of the loan balances associated with
these borrowers have resumed making regularly scheduled
 
payments compared to $285 million, or 88% of the loan
 
balances at
September 30, 2020.
 
 
Average total
 
deposits were $3.066 billion for the fourth quarter of 2020, an
 
increase of $94.9 million, or 3.2%, over the third
quarter of 2020 and reflected growth in core deposits of
 
$64.9 million and higher public fund balances of $30 million.
 
ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
 
Critical Accounting Policies
 
 
The consolidated financial statements and accompanying
 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements are prepared in
 
accordance
with accounting principles generally accepted in the
 
United States of America, which require us to make various estimates and
assumptions (see Note 1 in the Notes to Consolidated
 
Financial Statements).
 
We believe that,
 
of our significant accounting
policies, the following may involve a higher degree of
 
judgment and complexity.
 
Allowance for Credit Losses
.
 
The amount of the allowance for credit losses represents
 
management's best estimate of current
expected credit losses considering available information,
 
from internal and external sources, relevant to assessing exposure
 
to
credit loss over the contractual term of the instrument.
 
Relevant available information includes historical credit
 
loss experience,
current conditions,
 
and reasonable and supportable forecasts.
 
While historical credit loss experience
 
provides
 
the basis for the
estimation of expected credit losses, adjustments to historical
 
loss information may be made for changes in loan risk
 
grades, loss
experience trends, loan prepayment trends, differences
 
in current portfolio-specific risk characteristics, environmental
 
conditions,
future expectations, or other relevant factors.
 
While management utilizes its best judgment and information available,
 
the
ultimate adequacy of our allowance accounts is dependent
 
upon a variety of factors beyond our control, including the
performance of our portfolios, the economy,
 
changes in interest rates and the view of the regulatory authorities toward
classification of assets.
 
Goodwill
.
 
Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of acquired businesses over
 
the fair market value of their identifiable net
assets.
 
We perform
 
an impairment review on an annual basis or more frequently
 
if events or changes in circumstances indicate
that the carrying value may not be recoverable.
 
Adverse changes in the economic environment, declining operations,
 
or other
factors could result in a decline in the estimated implied
 
fair value of goodwill.
 
If the estimated implied fair value of goodwill is
less than the carrying amount, a loss would be recognized
 
to reduce the carrying amount to the estimated implied fair
 
value.
 
We evaluate
 
goodwill for impairment on an annual basis and in 2017
 
adopted ASU 2017-04, Intangibles – Goodwill and Other
(Topic 350):
 
Simplifying Accounting for Goodwill Impairment which allows for
 
a qualitative assessment of goodwill impairment
indicators.
 
If the assessment indicates that impairment has more than likely
 
occurred, the Company must compare the estimated
fair value of the reporting unit to its carrying amount.
 
If the carrying amount of the reporting unit exceeds its estimated fair
 
value,
an impairment charge is recorded equal to
 
the excess.
 
During the fourth quarter, we
 
performed our annual impairment testing.
 
We proceeded
 
with qualitative assessment by evaluating
impairment indicators and concluded there were none
 
that indicated that goodwill impairment had occurred.
 
 
61
 
Pension Assumptions
.
 
We have a defined
 
benefit pension plan for the benefit of substantially all of our associates.
 
Our funding
policy with respect to the pension plan is to contribute,
 
at a minimum, amounts sufficient to meet minimum
 
funding requirements
as set by law.
 
Pension expense is determined by an external actuarial valuation
 
based on assumptions that are evaluated annually
as of December 31, the measurement date for the pension
 
obligation.
 
The service cost component of pension expense is reflected
as “Compensation Expense” in the Consolidated Statements
 
of Income.
 
All other components of pension expense are reflected as
“Other Expense”.
 
 
The Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition
 
reflect an accrued pension benefit cost due to funding levels
 
and
unrecognized actuarial amounts.
 
The most significant assumptions used in calculating
 
the pension obligation are the weighted-
average discount rate used to determine the present value
 
of the pension obligation, the weighted-average expected
 
long-term rate
of return on plan assets, and the assumed rate of
 
annual compensation increases.
 
These assumptions are re-evaluated annually
with the external actuaries, taking into consideration both
 
current market conditions and anticipated long-term market conditions.
 
The discount rate is determined by matching the anticipated
 
defined pension plan cash flows to the spot rates of
 
a corporate Aa-
rated bond index/yield curve and solving for the single
 
equivalent discount rate which would produce the same present
 
value.
 
This methodology is applied consistently from year-to-year.
 
The discount rate utilized in 2020 was 3.53%.
 
The estimated impact
to 2020 pension expense of a 25 basis point increase or
 
decrease in the discount rate would have been a decrease and increase of
approximately $934,000 and $907,000,
 
respectively.
 
We anticipate using
 
a 2.88%
 
discount rate in 2021.
 
 
Based on the balances at the December 31, 2020
 
measurement date, the estimated impact in accumulated other
 
comprehensive
income of a 25 basis point increase or decrease in
 
the discount rate is a decrease or increase of approximately $6.6
 
million (after-
tax).
 
 
The weighted-average expected long-term rate of return
 
on plan assets is determined based on the current
 
and anticipated future
mix of assets in the plan.
 
The assets currently consist of equity securities, U.S. Government
 
and Government agency debt
securities, and other securities (typically temporary liquid
 
funds awaiting investment).
 
The weighted-average expected long-term
rate of return on plan assets utilized for 2020 was 7.00%.
 
The estimated impact to 2020 pension expense of a 25 basis point
increase or decrease in the rate of return would have been
 
an approximate $393,000 increase or decrease, respectively.
 
We
anticipate using a rate of return on plan assets of 6.75% for
 
2021.
 
The assumed rate of annual compensation increases of
 
4.00%
 
in 2020 reflected expected trends in salaries and the
 
employee
base.
 
We anticipate using
 
a compensation increase of 4.00% for 2021 reflecting current
 
market trends.
 
Detailed information on the pension plan, the actuarially
 
determined disclosures, and the assumptions used are
 
provided in Note
13 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
 
Income Taxes
.
 
Income tax expense is the total of the current year income tax due
 
or refundable and the change in deferred tax
assets and liabilities.
 
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are the expected future
 
tax amounts for the temporary differences between
carrying amounts and tax bases of assets and liabilities, computed
 
using enacted tax rates.
 
A valuation allowance, if needed,
reduces deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized.
 
 
A tax position is recognized as a benefit only if it is “more
 
likely than not” that the tax position would be sustained in a
 
tax
examination, with a tax examination being presumed
 
to occur.
 
The amount recognized is the largest amount of
 
tax benefit that is
greater than 50% likely of being realized on examination.
 
For tax positions not meeting the “more likely than not” test,
 
no tax
benefit is recorded.
 
 
We recognize
 
interest and/or penalties related to income tax matters in other
 
expenses.
 
ITEM 7A.
 
QUANTITATIVE
 
AND QUALITATIVE
 
DISCLOSURE ABOUT MARKET RISK
 
 
See “Financial Condition - Market Risk and Interest Rate
 
Sensitivity” in Management’s
 
Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations, above, which
 
is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
62
Item 8.
 
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
 
 
Table 16
QUARTERLY
 
FINANCIAL DATA
 
(Unaudited)
2020
2019
(Dollars in Thousands, Except
 
Per Share Data)
Fourth
Third
Second
First
Fourth
Third
Second
First
Summary of Operations:
Interest Income
$
26,154
$
26,166
$
26,512
$
27,365
$
28,008
$
28,441
$
28,665
$
27,722
Interest Expense
1,181
1,044
1,054
1,592
1,754
2,244
2,681
2,814
Net Interest Income
24,973
25,122
25,458
25,773
26,254
26,197
25,984
24,908
Provision for Credit Losses
1,342
1,308
2,005
4,990
(162)
776
646
767
Net Interest Income After
 
 
Provision for Credit Losses
23,631
23,814
23,453
20,783
26,416
25,421
25,338
24,141
Noninterest Income
30,523
34,965
30,199
15,478
13,828
13,903
12,770
12,552
Noninterest Expense
41,348
40,342
37,303
30,969
29,142
27,873
28,396
28,198
Income Before Income Taxes
12,806
18,437
16,349
5,292
11,102
11,451
9,712
8,495
Income Tax Expense
2,833
3,165
2,950
1,282
2,537
2,970
2,387
2,059
(Income) Loss Attributable to NCI
(1)
(2,227)
(4,875)
(4,253)
277
-
-
-
-
Net Income Attributable to CCBG
7,746
10,397
9,146
4,287
8,565
8,481
7,325
6,436
Net Interest Income (Tax Equivalent)
$
25,082
$
25,233
$
25,564
$
25,877
$
26,378
$
26,333
$
26,116
$
25,042
 
Per Common Share:
Basic Net Income
$
0.46
$
0.62
$
0.55
$
0.25
$
0.51
$
0.51
$
0.44
$
0.38
Diluted Net Income
0.46
0.62
0.55
0.25
0.51
0.50
0.44
0.38
Cash Dividends Declared
0.15
0.14
0.14
0.14
0.13
0.13
0.11
0.11
Diluted Book Value
19.05
20.20
19.92
19.50
19.40
19.14
18.76
18.35
Diluted Tangible Book Value
(2)
13.76
14.90
14.62
14.20
14.37
14.09
13.70
13.31
Market Price:
High
26.35
21.71
23.99
30.62
30.95
28.00
25.00
25.87
Low
18.14
17.55
16.16
15.61
25.75
23.70
21.57
21.04
Close
24.58
18.79
20.95
20.12
30.50
27.45
24.85
21.78
 
Selected Average Balances:
Loans Held for Investment
$
1,993,470
$
2,005,178
$
1,982,960
$
1,847,780
$
1,834,085
$
1,824,685
$
1,814,401
$
1,772,967
Earning Assets
3,337,409
3,223,838
3,016,772
2,751,880
2,694,700
2,670,081
2,719,217
2,704,802
Total Assets
3,652,436
3,539,332
3,329,226
3,038,788
2,982,204
2,959,310
3,010,662
2,996,511
Deposits
3,066,136
2,971,277
2,783,453
2,552,690
2,524,951
2,495,755
2,565,431
2,564,715
Shareowners’ Equity
343,674
340,073
333,515
331,891
326,904
320,273
313,599
307,262
Common Equivalent Average Shares:
Basic
16,763
16,771
16,797
16,808
16,750
16,747
16,791
16,791
Diluted
16,817
16,810
16,839
16,842
16,834
16,795
16,818
16,819
 
Performance Ratios:
Return on Average Assets
0.84
%
1.17
%
1.10
%
0.57
%
1.14
%
1.14
%
0.98
%
0.87
%
Return on Average Equity
8.97
12.16
11.03
5.20
10.39
10.51
9.37
8.49
Net Interest Margin (FTE)
3.00
3.12
3.41
3.78
3.89
3.92
3.85
3.75
Noninterest Income as % of Operating Revenue
55.00
58.19
54.26
37.52
34.50
34.67
32.95
33.51
Efficiency
 
Ratio
74.36
67.01
66.90
74.89
72.48
69.27
73.02
75.01
 
Asset Quality:
Allowance for Credit Losses
$
23,816
$
23,137
$
22,457
$
21,083
$
13,905
$
14,319
$
14,593
$
14,120
Allowance for Credit Losses
 
to Loans HFI
1.19
%
1.16
%
1.11
%
1.13
%
0.75
%
0.78
%
0.79
%
0.78
%
Nonperforming Assets ("NPA's")
6,679
6,732
8,025
6,337
5,425
5,454
6,632
6,949
NPA’s
 
to Total Assets
0.18
0.19
0.23
0.21
0.18
0.19
0.22
0.23
NPA’s
 
to Loans plus ORE
0.33
0.34
0.40
0.34
0.29
0.30
0.36
0.39
Allowance to Non-Performing Loans HFI
405.66
420.30
322.37
432.61
310.99
290.55
259.55
279.77
Net Charge-Offs to Average
 
Loans HFI
0.09
0.11
0.05
0.23
0.05
0.23
0.04
0.20
 
Capital Ratios:
Tier 1 Capital
16.19
%
16.77
%
16.59
%
16.12
%
17.16
%
16.83
%
16.36
%
16.34
%
Total Capital
17.30
17.88
17.60
17.19
17.90
17.59
17.13
17.09
Common Equity Tier 1 Capital
13.71
14.20
14.01
13.55
14.47
14.13
13.67
13.62
Leverage
9.33
9.64
10.12
10.81
11.25
11.09
10.64
10.53
Tangible Common Equity
(2)
6.25
7.16
7.21
7.98
8.06
8.31
7.83
7.56
(1)
 
Acquired 51% membership interest
 
in Brand Mortgage Group, LLC
 
re-named Capital City Home Loans on March
 
1, 2020 - fully consolidated
(1)
 
Diluted tangible book value and tangible common equity ratio are
 
non-GAAP financial measures. For additional information,
 
including a reconciliation to GAAP,
 
refer to page 32.
 
 
63
CAPITAL CITY BANK
 
GROUP,
 
INC.
 
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
 
STATEMENTS
 
PAGE
 
 
 
64
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting
 
Firm
 
 
67
Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition
 
 
68
Consolidated Statements of Income
 
 
69
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income
 
 
70
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareowners’
 
Equity
 
 
71
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
 
 
72
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
64
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting
 
Firm
 
To the Shareowners
 
and the Board of Directors of Capital City Bank Group,
 
Inc.
 
Opinion on the Financial Statements
 
We have
 
audited the accompanying
 
consolidated balance sheets of
 
Capital City Bank Group,
 
Inc. (the Company) as
 
of December
31, 2020
 
and 2019, the
 
related consolidated
 
statements of income,
 
comprehensive income,
 
shareholders’ equity,
 
and cash flows
for each
 
of the three
 
years in
 
the period
 
ended December
 
31, 2020,
 
and the
 
related notes
 
(collectively referred
 
to as
 
the
“consolidated financial
 
statements”). In our
 
opinion, the consolidated
 
financial statements present
 
fairly, in
 
all material respects,
the financial position of the Company
 
at December 31, 2020 and 2019, and
 
the results of its operations and its cash
 
flows for each
of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2020,
 
in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
 
 
We also
 
have audited,
 
in accordance
 
with the
 
standards of
 
the Public
 
Company Accounting
 
Oversight Board
 
(United States)
(PCAOB), the Company’s
 
internal control
 
over financial
 
reporting as
 
of December
 
31, 2020,
 
based on
 
criteria established
 
in
Internal Control
 
-Integrated Framework
 
issued by
 
the Committee
 
of Sponsoring
 
Organizations of
 
the Treadway
 
Commission
(2013 framework) and our report dated March 1, 2021
 
expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.
 
Adoption of New Accounting Standard
 
As discussed in Note
 
1
 
to the consolidated financial
 
statements, the Company
 
changed its method for
 
accounting for credit losses
in 2020.
 
As explained
 
below, auditin
 
g
 
the Company’s
 
allowance for
 
credit losses,
 
including adoption
 
of the
 
new accounting
guidance related to the estimate of allowance for credit losses,
 
was a critical audit matter.
 
Basis for Opinion
 
These financial statements are the responsibility of
 
the Company’s management.
 
Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the
Company’s financial
 
statements based
 
on our
 
audits. We
 
are a
 
public accounting
 
firm registered
 
with the
 
PCAOB and
 
are
required to
 
be independent
 
with respect
 
to the
 
Company in accordance
 
with the
 
U.S. federal securities
 
laws and
 
the applicable
rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission
 
and the PCAOB.
 
We conducted
 
our audits in
 
accordance with the
 
standards of the
 
PCAOB. Those standards
 
require that we
 
plan and perform
 
the
audit to obtain reasonable assurance about
 
whether the financial statements are free of material
 
misstatement, whether due to error
or fraud.
 
Our audits
 
included performing
 
procedures to
 
assess the
 
risks of
 
material misstatement
 
of the
 
financial statements
 
,
whether due to
 
error or fraud,
 
and performing procedures
 
that respond to
 
those risks. Such
 
procedures included examining,
 
on a
test basis,
 
evidence regarding
 
the amounts
 
and disclosures
 
in the
 
financial statements.
 
Our audits
 
also included
 
evaluating the
accounting principles
 
used and significant
 
estimates made
 
by management,
 
as well as
 
evaluating the
 
overall presentation
 
of the
financial statements. We
 
believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for
 
our opinion.
 
Critical Audit Matters
 
The critical audit
 
matters communicated
 
below are matters
 
arising from
 
the current
 
period audit of
 
the financial
 
statements that
were communicated or
 
required to be communicated
 
to the audit committee
 
and that: (1) relate
 
to accounts or disclosures
 
that are
material to
 
the financial
 
statements and
 
(2) involved
 
especially challenging,
 
subjective or
 
complex judgments.
 
The
communication of critical
 
audit matters does not
 
alter in any way
 
our opinion on
 
the consolidated financial
 
statements, taken as a
whole, and
 
we are
 
not, by
 
communicating the
 
critical audit
 
matters below,
 
providing a
 
separate opinion
 
on the
 
critical audit
matters or on the accounts or disclosures to which they
 
relate.
 
 
65
Allowance for Credit Losses
Description of
the Matter
The Company’s
 
loans held
 
for investment
 
portfolio totaled
 
$2.0 billion
 
as of
 
December 31,
2020, and the associated
 
ACL was $23.8 million.
 
As discussed above and
 
in Note 1 and Note
 
3
to the
 
consolidated financial
 
statements, the
 
Company adopted
 
ASU No.
 
2016-13, Financial
Instruments-
 
Credit Losses,
 
also known
 
as Current
 
Expected Credit
 
Losses (“CECL”).
 
Upon
adoption, the
 
Company recorded
 
a pre
 
-tax cumulative
 
-effect transition
 
adjustment increasing
the allowance
 
for credit
 
losses (ACL)
 
on loans
 
by $3.3
 
million.
 
The ACL
 
is an
 
amount,
established through
 
the use
 
of forecast
 
models, which
 
represents management’s
 
estimate of
current expected credit losses over
 
the contractual life of the loans. The
 
ACL is estimated based
on historical and expected
 
credit loss patterns including the
 
reasonable and supportable forecast
periods. Management applies judgment in the assignment
 
of probabilities to economic scenarios
included within
 
the modeled forecast
 
periods, including the
 
selection of macroeconomic
variables (MEV),
 
the length
 
of the forecast
 
and reversion
 
period, as well
 
as the application
 
of
qualitative adjustments to the model calculation deemed
 
necessary to estimate the ACL.
 
Auditing management’s
 
estimate of the
 
ACL involved a
 
high degree of
 
subjectivity due
 
to the
judgment involved
 
in management’s
 
determination of
 
the probabilities
 
assigned to
 
the
economic scenarios
 
utilized within
 
the reasonable
 
and supportable
 
forecast peri
 
ods and
 
the
application of
 
qualitative adjustments to
 
the modeled calculations.
 
Management’s judgment
 
of
the future economic
 
conditions and qualitative
 
adjustments to the model
 
calculation could have
a significant impact on the ACL.
 
How We
Addressed the
Matter in Our
Audit
Our considerations
 
and procedures
 
performed included
 
evaluation of
 
the process
 
utilized by
management to challenge
 
the model results and
 
resulting estimate of the
 
ACL as of the balance
sheet date. We
 
obtained an understanding
 
of the Company’s
 
process for establishing
 
the ACL,
including management’s
 
determination of
 
the probabilities assigned
 
to the economic
 
scenarios
utilized within the
 
reasonable and
 
supportable forecast
 
periods and the
 
qualitative adjustments
applied to the ACL model calculation.
 
We evaluated
 
the design and tested the operating
effectiveness of
 
the controls
 
associated with
 
the ACL
 
process, including
 
controls around
 
the
reliability and accuracy
 
of data used
 
in the model,
 
management’s review
 
and approval of
 
both
the selection of
 
and probabilities assigned
 
to the economic
 
scenarios utilized within
 
the
reasonable and supportable
 
forecast periods and
 
the qualitative adjustments to
 
the model
calculation, the
 
governance of
 
the credit
 
loss methodology,
 
and management’s
 
review and
approval of the ACL.
 
To test
 
the ACL estimate,
 
our audit procedures
 
included testing the
 
completeness and accuracy
of data
 
used by
 
the Company
 
within the
 
model to
 
estimate the
 
ACL as
 
well as
 
testing the
economic scenarios utilized within
 
the model for the reasonable
 
and supportable forecast
periods by
 
evaluating the
 
probabilities assigned,
 
model results,
 
qualitative model
 
adjustments
applied to the model
 
calculation, and comparing
 
loss history and industry
 
data to actual results.
We involved
 
an internal specialist
 
to assist in
 
assessing the expected
 
credit loss methodology,
evaluating support
 
for key
 
quantitative modeling
 
assumptions such
 
as the
 
MEV,
 
probabilities
assigned to
 
the economic
 
scenarios and
 
forecasting period,
 
and testing
 
the appropriateness
 
of
qualitative adjustments
 
to the
 
model calculation.
 
Within the
 
testing performed,
 
considerations
were given to
 
the assumptions included
 
within each economic
 
scenario and probabilities
assigned and
 
how those
 
assumptions and
 
probabilities compared
 
to key
 
economic variables
available through
 
external sources.
 
Alternative sources
 
and scenarios
 
were also considered.
 
In
addition, we evaluated
 
the Company’s
 
estimate of the
 
ACL giving consideration
 
to the
Company’s borrowers,
 
loan portfolio,
 
and macroeconomic
 
trends, independen
 
tly obtained and
compared such information to comparable
 
financial institutions, and considered whether
 
new or
contrary information existed.
 
 
 
66
Pension Benefit Obligation
Description of
the Matter
The Company’s
 
pension benefit obligation
 
totaled $226 million
 
as of December
 
31, 2020, and
the fair
 
value of
 
plan assets
 
at year
 
-end was
 
$171.8 million,
 
resulting in
 
an unfunded
 
defined
benefit pension
 
obligation (PBO) of
 
$54.2 million.
 
As discussed in
 
Note 1 and
 
Note 15 to
 
the
consolidated financial
 
statements, the
 
Pension Benefit
 
Obligation (PBO)
 
is an
 
amount which
represents management’s
 
best estimate
 
of future
 
pension benefit
 
liabilities in
 
excess of
 
the
projected return
 
of fund
 
assets based
 
on actuarial
 
assumptions. The
 
Company recognizes
 
the
unfunded pension liability through other comprehensive
 
income in accordance with ASC 715.
Auditing the
 
PBO is complex
 
and required
 
the involvement
 
of actuarial
 
specialists due
 
to the
highly judgmental nature of the actuarial assumptions
 
(e.g. discount rate, expected rate of
 
return
on assets,
 
mortality rate,
 
inflation rate,
 
and future
 
compensation levels)
 
used in
 
the
measurement process. These assumptions have a significant
 
effect on the PBO.
How We
Addressed the
Matter in Our
Audit
We obtained
 
an understanding
 
of the
 
Company’s process
 
for establishing
 
the pension
 
benefit
obligation, including valuation
 
of plan assets. We
 
evaluated the design
 
and tested the operating
effectiveness of
 
the controls
 
and governance
 
over the
 
appropriateness of
 
the estimate
 
and
significant assumptions,
 
including but
 
not limited to
 
discount rates,
 
expected rate
 
of return on
assets, mortality rate, inflation rate, and future compensation levels.
 
To test
 
the pension
 
benefit obligation,
 
our audit
 
procedures included
 
evaluating the
methodology used, assessing
 
the qualifications of
 
management’s actuarial
 
specialists, and
reviewing the
 
significant actuarial
 
assumptions discussed
 
above and
 
the underlying
 
data used
by the
 
Company. We
 
compared the
 
actuarial assump
 
tions used
 
by management
 
to historical
trends and evaluated
 
the change in
 
the PBO from
 
prior year due
 
to the change
 
in service cost,
interest cost, actuarial
 
gains and losses,
 
benefit payments, contributions
 
and other activities.
 
In
addition, we
 
involved an
 
actuarial specialist
 
to assist
 
with our
 
procedures. For
 
example, we
evaluated management’s
 
methodology for
 
determining the
 
discount rate
 
that reflects the
maturity and duration
 
of the benefit
 
payments and is
 
used to measure
 
the PBO. As
 
part of this
assessment, we compared
 
the projected cash
 
flows to prior
 
year and compared
 
the current year
benefits paid to the
 
prior year projected cash
 
flows. To
 
evaluate future compensation levels,
 
the
mortality rate
 
and the
 
inflation rate,
 
we assessed
 
whether the
 
information is
 
consistent with
publicly available
 
information, and
 
whether any
 
market data
 
adjusted for
 
the entity
 
-specific
adjustments were applied.
 
To evaluate
 
the expected return
 
on plan assets,
 
we assessed whether
management’s assumption
 
is consistent
 
with a
 
range of
 
returns for
 
a portfolio
 
of comparative
investments. We
 
tested the valuation
 
of the pension
 
plan assets as
 
of the balance
 
sheet date by
comparing asset fair values to an
 
independent pricing source based on tolerable
 
variances set by
level of estimation uncertainty.
 
We also
 
tested the completeness and
 
accuracy of the underlying
data, including
 
the participant
 
data provided
 
to management’s
 
actuarial specialists.
 
Lastly, we
performed procedures
 
relating to
 
the application
 
of ASC
 
715, including
 
review of
 
entries
proposed by management’s
 
actuarial specialist, and footnote supporting detail.
 
 
 
/s/ Ernst & Young
 
LLP
 
We have served
 
as the Company’s auditor since
 
2007.
 
Tallahassee, Florida
March 1, 2021
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
67
CAPITAL CITY BANK
 
GROUP,
 
INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS
 
OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
As of December 31,
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
ASSETS
Cash and Due From Banks
$
67,919
$
60,087
Federal Funds Sold and Interest Bearing Deposits
860,630
318,336
Total Cash and Cash
 
Equivalents
928,549
378,423
Investment Securities, Available
 
for Sale, at fair value
324,870
403,601
Investment Securities, Held to Maturity (fair value of $
175,175
 
and $
241,429
)
169,939
239,539
Total Investment
 
Securities
494,809
643,140
Loans Held For Sale, at fair value
114,039
9,509
Loans, Held for Investment
2,006,426
1,835,929
Allowance for Credit Losses
(23,816)
(13,905)
Loans Held for Investment, Net
1,982,610
1,822,024
Premises and Equipment, Net
86,791
84,543
Goodwill
89,095
84,811
Other Real Estate Owned
808
953
Other Assets
101,370
65,550
Total Assets
$
3,798,071
$
3,088,953
LIABILITIES
Deposits:
Noninterest Bearing Deposits
$
1,328,809
$
1,044,699
Interest Bearing Deposits
1,888,751
1,600,755
Total Deposits
3,217,560
2,645,454
Short-Term
 
Borrowings
79,654
6,404
Subordinated Notes Payable
52,887
52,887
Other Long-Term
 
Borrowings
3,057
6,514
Other Liabilities
102,076
50,678
Total Liabilities
3,455,234
2,761,937
Temporary Equity
22,000
-
SHAREOWNERS’ EQUITY
Preferred Stock, $
.01
 
par value;
3,000,000
 
shares authorized; no shares issued and outstanding
-
-
Common Stock, $
.01
 
par value;
90,000,000
 
shares authorized;
16,790,573
 
and
16,771,544
 
shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2020 and
 
December 31, 2019, respectively
168
168
Additional Paid-In Capital
32,283
32,092
Retained Earnings
332,528
322,937
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss, Net of Tax
(44,142)
(28,181)
Total Shareowners’
 
Equity
320,837
327,016
Total Liabilities, Temporary
 
Equity, and Shareowners’
 
Equity
$
3,798,071
$
3,088,953
The accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial
 
Statements are an integral part of these statements.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
68
CAPITAL CITY BANK
 
GROUP,
 
INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS
 
OF INCOME
For the Years
 
Ended December 31,
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Per Share
 
Data)
2020
2019
2018
INTEREST INCOME
Loans, including Fees
$
94,752
$
94,215
$
84,117
Investment Securities:
Taxable
10,176
13,122
12,081
Tax Exempt
98
312
787
Funds Sold
1,171
5,187
2,410
Total Interest Income
106,197
112,836
99,395
INTEREST EXPENSE
Deposits
1,548
6,840
4,243
Short-Term
 
Borrowings
1,690
109
110
Subordinated Notes Payable
1,472
2,287
2,167
Other Long-Term
 
Borrowings
161
257
371
Total Interest Expense
4,871
9,493
6,891
NET INTEREST INCOME
101,326
103,343
92,504
Provision for Credit Losses
9,645
2,027
2,921
Net Interest Income After Provision for Credit Losses
91,681
101,316
89,583
NONINTEREST INCOME
Deposit Fees
17,800
19,472
20,093
Bank Card Fees
13,044
11,994
11,378
Wealth Management
 
Fees
11,035
10,480
8,711
Mortgage Banking Revenues
63,344
5,321
4,735
Other
5,942
5,786
6,648
Total Noninterest
 
Income
111,165
53,053
51,565
NONINTEREST EXPENSE
Compensation
96,280
66,352
63,921
Occupancy, Net
22,659
18,436
18,503
Other Real Estate Owned, Net
104
546
(442)
Other
30,919
28,275
29,521
Total Noninterest
 
Expense
149,962
113,609
111,503
INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES
52,884
40,760
29,645
Income Tax Expense
 
10,230
9,953
3,421
NET INCOME
$
42,654
$
30,807
$
26,224
Pre-Tax Income
 
Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests
(11,078)
-
-
NET INCOME ATTRIBUTABLE
 
TO COMMON SHAREOWNERS
$
31,576
$
30,807
$
26,224
BASIC NET INCOME PER SHARE
$
1.88
$
1.84
$
1.54
DILUTED NET INCOME PER SHARE
$
1.88
$
1.83
$
1.54
Average Basic Common
 
Shares Outstanding
16,785
16,770
17,029
Average Diluted
 
Common Shares Outstanding
16,822
16,827
17,072
The accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial
 
Statements are an integral part of these statements.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
69
CAPITAL CITY BANK
 
GROUP,
 
INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS
 
OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
For the Years
 
Ended December 31,
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
NET INCOME
$
31,576
$
30,807
$
26,224
Other comprehensive income (loss), before
 
tax:
Investment Securities:
Change in net unrealized gain (loss) on securities available
 
for sale
2,437
3,790
(409)
Amortization of unrealized losses on securities transferred
 
from
 
available for sale to held to maturity
36
43
55
Total Investment
 
Securities
2,473
3,833
(354)
Derivative:
Change in net unrealized gain (loss) on effective
 
cash flow derivative
574
-
-
Benefit Plans:
Reclassification adjustment for amortization of prior service
 
cost
(880)
15
199
Reclassification adjustment for amortization of net loss
4,391
4,623
5,299
Current year actuarial loss
(27,924)
(7,642)
(815)
Total Benefit Plans
(24,413)
(3,004)
4,683
Other comprehensive (loss) income, before
 
tax:
(21,366)
829
4,329
Deferred tax benefit (expense) related to other comprehensive
 
income
5,405
(195)
(1,100)
Other comprehensive (loss) income, net of tax
(15,961)
634
3,229
TOTAL COMPREHENSIVE
 
INCOME
$
15,615
$
31,441
$
29,453
The accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial
 
Statements are an integral part of these statements.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
70
CAPITAL CITY BANK
 
GROUP,
 
INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS
 
OF CHANGES IN SHAREOWNERS' EQUITY
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
(Loss) Income,
 
Net of Taxes
(Dollars in Thousands, Except
Per Share Data)
Shares
Outstanding
Common
Stock
Additional
Paid-In
Capital
Retained
Earnings
Total
Balance, January 1, 2018
16,988,951
$
170
$
36,674
$
279,410
$
(32,044)
$
284,210
Net Income
-
-
26,224
-
26,224
Other Comprehensive Loss, Net of Tax
-
-
-
3,229
3,229
Cash Dividends ($
0.32
 
per share)
-
-
(5,457)
-
(5,457)
Stock Based Compensation
-
1,421
-
-
1,421
Stock Compensation Plan Transactions, net
 
83,061
-
990
-
-
990
Repurchase of Common Stock
(324,441)
(3)
(8,027)
-
-
(8,030)
Balance, December 31, 2018
16,747,571
167
31,058
300,177
(28,815)
302,587
Net Income
-
-
-
30,807
-
30,807
Other Comprehensive Income, Net of Tax
-
-
-
-
634
634
Cash Dividends ($
0.48
 
per share)
-
-
-
(8,047)
-
(8,047)
Stock Based Compensation
-
-
1,569
-
-
1,569
Stock Compensation Plan Transactions, net
 
100,973
1
1,270
-
-
1,271
Repurchase of Common Stock
(77,000)
-
(1,805)
-
-
(1,805)
Balance, December 31, 2019
16,771,544
168
32,092
322,937
(28,181)
327,016
Impact of Adopting ASC 326 (CECL)
-
-
-
(3,095)
-
(3,095)
Net Income
-
-
-
31,576
-
31,576
Reclassification to Temporary Equity
(1)
-
-
-
(9,323)
-
(9,323)
Other Comprehensive Income, Net of Tax
-
-
-
-
(15,961)
(15,961)
Cash Dividends ($
0.57
 
per share)
-
-
-
(9,567)
-
(9,567)
Stock Based Compensation
-
-
892
-
-
892
Stock Compensation Plan Transactions, net
 
118,981
1
1,340
-
-
1,341
Repurchase of Common Stock
(99,952)
(1)
(2,041)
-
-
(2,042)
Balance, December 31, 2020
16,790,573
$
168
$
32,283
$
332,528
$
(44,142)
$
320,837
(1)
Adjustments to redemption value for non-controlling interest in CCHL
The accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements are an integral part of these statements.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
71
CAPITAL CITY BANK
 
GROUP,
 
INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS
 
OF CASH FLOWS
For the Years
 
Ended December 31,
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING
 
ACTIVITIES
Net Income
 
$
31,576
$
30,807
$
26,224
Adjustments to Reconcile Net Income to Cash From Operating
 
Activities:
 
Provision for Credit Losses
9,645
2,027
2,921
 
Depreciation
7,230
6,253
6,453
 
Amortization of Premiums, Discounts, and Fees, net
7,533
5,206
6,698
 
Originations of Loans Held-for-Sale
(606,337)
(232,259)
(177,742)
 
Proceeds From Sales of Loans Held-for-Sale
565,151
234,940
180,425
 
Net Gain From Sales of Loans Held-for-Sale
(63,344)
(5,321)
(4,735)
 
Net Additions for Capitalized Mortgage Servicing Rights
(2,792)
-
-
 
Change in Valuation
 
Provision for Mortgage Servicing Rights
250
-
-
 
Stock Compensation
892
1,569
1,421
 
Net Tax Benefit from
 
Stock Compensation
(84)
(14)
(41)
 
Deferred Income Taxes
(53)
1,225
4,837
 
Net Change in Operating Leases
(156)
90
-
 
Net Loss (Gain) on Sales and Write-Downs
 
of Other Real Estate Owned
(393)
214
(935)
 
Impairment Loss on Premises (Hurricane Damage)
-
-
(1,213)
 
Proceeds From Insurance Claim for Operating Loss
-
268
-
 
Loss on Disposal of Premises and Equipment
-
30
87
 
Net (Increase) Decrease in Other Assets
(38,353)
9,830
7,168
 
Net Increase (Decrease) in Other Liabilities
40,624
(1,176)
(16,942)
 
Net Cash (Used In) Provided By Operating Activities
(48,611)
53,689
34,626
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES
Securities Held to Maturity:
 
Purchases
(32,250)
(92,186)
(102,428)
 
Payments, Maturities, and Calls
99,251
68,185
100,131
Securities Available
 
for Sale:
 
Purchases
(108,728)
(119,685)
(132,895)
 
Payments, Maturities, and Calls
186,499
162,260
161,332
Purchase of Loans Held for Investment
(43,804)
(25,256)
(26,070)
Net Increase in Loans
(130,020)
(39,608)
(98,068)
Net Cash Paid for Brand Acquisition
(2,405)
-
-
Proceeds From Insurance Claims on Premises
-
814
663
Proceeds From Sales of Other Real Estate Owned
2,835
2,360
4,774
Purchases of Premises and Equipment, net
(9,738)
(3,759)
(1,458)
Noncontrolling Interest Contributions
5,766
-
-
Net Cash Used In Investing Activities
(32,594)
(46,875)
(94,019)
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES
Net Increase in Deposits
572,106
113,598
61,979
Net Increase (Decrease) in Short-Term
 
Borrowings
73,156
(7,497)
2,551
Repayment of Other Long-Term
 
Borrowings
(3,363)
(1,694)
(1,889)
Dividends Paid
(9,567)
(8,047)
(5,457)
Payments to Repurchase Common Stock
(2,042)
(1,805)
(8,030)
Issuance of Common Stock Under Compensation Plans
1,041
1,054
797
Net Cash Provided By Financing Activities
631,331
95,609
49,951
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS
550,126
102,423
(9,442)
Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Year
378,423
276,000
285,442
Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Year
$
928,549
$
378,423
$
276,000
Supplemental Cash Flow Disclosures:
 
Interest Paid
$
4,841
$
9,521
$
6,879
 
Income Taxes Paid
$
9,171
$
6,255
$
157
Noncash Investing and Financing Activities:
 
Loans and Premises Transferred to Other Real Estate
 
Owned
$
2,297
$
1,298
$
2,140
The accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial
 
Statements are an integral part of these statements.
 
72
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
 
Note 1
SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
 
Nature of Operations
 
Capital City Bank Group, Inc. (“CCBG”) provides
 
a full range of banking and banking-related services to individual
 
and
corporate clients through its subsidiary,
 
Capital City Bank, with banking offices located in Florida,
 
Georgia, and Alabama.
 
The
Company is subject to competition from other financial
 
institutions, is subject to regulation by certain government agencies and
undergoes periodic examinations by those regulatory
 
authorities.
 
Basis of Presentation
 
The consolidated financial statements include the
 
accounts of CCBG and its wholly owned subsidiary,
 
Capital City Bank (“CCB”
or the “Bank” and together with CCBG, the “Company
 
”).
 
All material inter-company transactions and accounts have
 
been
eliminated in consolidation.
 
The Company, which
 
operates a single reportable business segment that is comprised
 
of commercial banking within the states of
Florida, Georgia, and Alabama, follows accounting
 
principles generally accepted in the United States of America and
 
reporting
practices applicable to the banking industry.
 
The principles which materially affect the financial position,
 
results of operations
and cash flows are summarized below.
 
The Company determines whether it has a controlling
 
financial interest in an entity by first evaluating whether the entity is a
voting interest entity or a variable interest entity under
 
accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of
 
America.
Voting
 
interest entities are entities in which the total equity investment
 
at risk is sufficient to enable the entity to finance
 
itself
independently and provide the equity holders with the
 
obligation to absorb losses, the right to receive residual
 
returns and the
right to make decisions about the entity’s
 
activities.
 
The Company consolidates voting interest entities in which it has all,
 
or at
least a majority of, the voting interest.
 
As defined in applicable accounting standards, variable interest
 
entities (“VIE’s”) are
entities that lack one or more of the characteristics of a voting
 
interest entity.
 
A controlling financial interest in an entity is
present when an enterprise has a variable interest,
 
or a combination of variable interests, that will absorb a majority
 
of the entity’s
expected losses, receive a majority of the entity’s
 
expected residual returns, or both.
 
The enterprise with a controlling financial
interest, known as the primary beneficiary,
 
consolidates the VIE.
 
Two of CCBG's wholly
 
owned subsidiaries, CCBG Capital
Trust I (established November 1, 2004)
 
and CCBG Capital Trust II (established
 
May 24, 2005) are VIEs for which the Company
is not the primary beneficiary.
 
Accordingly, the
 
accounts of these entities are not included in the Company’s
 
consolidated
financial statements.
 
Certain previously reported amounts have been reclassified to
 
conform to the current year’s presentation.
 
The Company has
evaluated subsequent events for potential recognition
 
and/or disclosure through the date the consolidated financial
 
statements
included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K were filed
 
with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.
 
Use of Estimates
 
 
The preparation of financial statements in conformity
 
with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of
America requires management to make estimates and
 
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
 
liabilities, the
disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date
 
of financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and
expenses during the reporting period.
 
Actual results could vary from these estimates.
 
Material estimates that are particularly
susceptible to significant changes in the near-term
 
relate to the determination of the allowance for loan losses, pension
 
expense,
income taxes, loss contingencies, valuation of other real
 
estate owned, and valuation of goodwill and their respective
 
analysis of
impairment.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
73
Business Combination
 
On March 1, 2020, CCB completed its acquisition of
 
a
51
% membership interest in
Brand Mortgage Group, LLC
 
(“Brand”),
which is now operated as Capital City Home Loans (“CCHL”).
 
CCHL was consolidated into CCBG’s financial
 
statements
effective March 1, 2020.
 
Assets acquired totaled $
52
 
million (consisting primarily of loans held for sale)
 
and liabilities assumed
totaled $
42
 
million (consisting primarily of warehouse line borrowings).
 
The primary reasons for the acquisition and strategic
alliance with Brand was to gain access to an expanded residential
 
mortgage product line-up and investor base (including
 
a
mandatory delivery channel for loan sales), to hedge
 
our net interest income business and to generate other
 
operational synergies
and cost savings.
 
CCB made a $
7.1
 
million cash payment for its
51
% membership interest and entered into a buyout agreement
for the remaining
49
% noncontrolling interest resulting in temporary equity with a fair
 
value of $
7.4
 
million.
 
Goodwill totaling
$
4.3
 
million was recorded in connection with this acquisition.
 
Factors that contributed to the purchase price resulting in goodwill
include Brand’s strong
 
management team and expertise in the mortgage industry,
 
historical record of earnings, and operational
synergies created as part of the strategic alliance.
 
At December 31, 2020, $
9.3
 
million was reclassified from permanent equity to
temporary equity which reflects the increase in the
 
redemption value of the
49
% noncontrolling interest under the terms of the
buyout agreement.
 
 
Adoption of New Accounting Standard
 
On January 1, 2020, the Company adopted ASU 2016
 
-13
Financial Instruments – Credit Losses (Topic
 
326): Measurement of
Credit Losses on Financial Instruments
, which replaces the incurred loss methodology
 
with an expected loss methodology that is
referred to as the current expected credit loss (“CECL”) methodology.
 
The measurement of expected credit losses under the
CECL methodology is applicable to financial assets measured
 
at amortized cost, including loan receivables and held-to-maturity
debt securities.
 
It also applies to off-balance sheet credit exposures not
 
accounted for as insurance (loan commitments, standby
letters of credit, financial guarantees, and other similar
 
instruments).
 
In addition, ASC 326-30 provides a new credit loss model
for available-for-sale debt securities.
 
The most significant change requires credit losses to be presented
 
as an allowance rather
than as a write-down on available-for-sale debt
 
securities that management does not intend to sell or believes
 
that it is not more
likely than not they will be required to sell.
 
The Company adopted ASC 326 using the modified retrospective
 
method for all
financial assets measured at amortized cost and off
 
-balance sheet credit exposures.
 
 
Our accounting policies changed significantly with the
 
adoption of CECL on January 1, 2020.
 
Prior to January 1, 2020,
allowances were based on incurred credit losses in accordance
 
with accounting policies disclosed in Note 1 of the Consolidated
Financial Statements included in the 2019 Form 10-K.
 
The adoption of ASC 326 (“CECL”) had an impact of $
4.0
 
million ($
3.3
million increase in the allowance for credit losses and
 
$
0.7
 
million increase in the allowance for unfunded loan commitments
(liability account)) that was offset by a corresponding
 
decrease in retained earnings of $
3.1
 
million and $
0.9
 
million increase in
deferred tax assets.
 
The increase in the allowance for credit losses required
 
under the ASC 326 generally reflected the impact of
reserves calculated over the life of loan, and more specifically
 
higher reserves required for longer duration loan portfolios,
 
and the
utilization of a longer historical look-back period
 
in the calculation of loan loss rates (loss given default).
 
Upon analyzing the
debt security portfolios, the Company determined that
 
no allowance was required as these debt securities are government
guaranteed treasuries or government agency-backed
 
securities for which the risk of loss was deemed minimal.
 
Further, certain
municipal debt securities held by the Company have been
 
pre-refunded and secured by government guaranteed treasuries.
 
The following table illustrates the impact of adopting
 
ASC 326 on January 1, 2020.
 
As Reported
Impact of
Under
Pre-ASC 326
ASC 326
(Dollars in Thousands)
ASC 326
Adoption
Adoption
Loans:
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
$
2,163
$
1,675
$
488
Real Estate - Construction
672
370
302
Real Estate - Commercial Mortgage
4,874
3,416
1,458
Real Estate - Residential
4,371
3,128
1,243
Real Estate - Home Equity
2,598
2,224
374
Consumer, Other Loans and
 
Overdrafts
2,496
3,092
(596)
Allowance for Credit Losses on Loans
17,174
13,905
3,269
Other Liabilities:
Allowance for Credit Losses on Off-Balance Sheet
 
Credit Exposures
$
815
$
157
$
658
 
 
74
Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents include cash and due from banks,
 
interest-bearing deposits in other banks, and federal
 
funds
sold. Generally,
 
federal funds are purchased and sold for one-day periods and
 
all other cash equivalents have a maturity of 90
days or less.
 
The Company is required to maintain average reserve balances
 
with the Federal Reserve Bank based upon a
percentage of deposits.
 
On March 26, 2020, the Federal Reserve reduced the amount
 
of the required reserve balance to
zero
.
 
The
average amount of the required reserve balance for
 
the year ended December 31, 2019 was $
29.7
 
million.
 
The Company maintains certain cash balances that are
 
restricted under warehouse lines of credit and master
 
repurchase
agreements.
 
The restricted cash balance at December 31, 2020 was $
0.6
 
million.
 
Investment Securities
 
 
Investment securities are classified as held-to-maturity
 
and carried at amortized cost when the Company has the positive
 
intent
and ability to hold them until maturity.
 
Investment securities not classified as held-to-maturity or trading securities
 
are classified
as available-for-sale and carried at fair value.
 
The Company determines the appropriate classification of securities
 
at the time of
purchase.
 
For reporting and risk management purposes, we further
 
segment investment securities by the issuer of the security
which correlates to its risk profile: U.S. government treasury,
 
U.S. government agency,
 
state and political subdivisions, and
mortgage-backed securities.
 
Certain equity securities with limited marketability,
 
such as stock in the Federal Reserve Bank and
the Federal Home Loan Bank, are classified as available
 
-for-sale and carried at cost.
 
 
Interest income includes amortization and accretion
 
of purchase premiums and discounts.
 
Realized gains and losses are derived
from the amortized cost of the security sold.
 
Gains and losses on the sale of securities are recorded on the
 
trade date and are
determined using the specific identification method.
 
Securities transferred from available-for-sale to
 
held-to-maturity are
recorded at amortized cost plus or minus any unrealized
 
gain or loss at the time of transfer.
 
Any existing unrecognized gain or
loss continues to be reported in accumulated other
 
comprehensive income (net of tax) and amortized as an adjustment
 
to interest
income over the remaining life of the security.
 
Any existing allowance for credit loss is reversed at the time
 
of transfer.
 
Subsequent to transfer, the
 
allowance for credit losses on the transferred security is evaluated in
 
accordance with the accounting
policy for held-to-maturity securities.
 
Additionally, any
 
allowance amounts reversed or established as part of the transfer
 
are
presented on a gross basis in the consolidated statement
 
of income.
 
 
The accrual of interest is generally suspended on securities
 
more than 90 days past due with respect to principal
 
or interest.
 
When
a security is placed on nonaccrual status, all previously
 
accrued and uncollected interest is reversed against current income and
thus not included in the estimate of credit losses.
 
 
Credit losses and changes thereto, are established as an
 
allowance for credit loss through a provision for credit loss expense.
 
Losses are charged against the allowance
 
when management believes the uncollectability of an available
 
-for-sale security is
confirmed or when either of the criteria regarding
 
intent or requirement to sell is met.
 
Certain debt securities in the Company’s
 
investment portfolio were issued by a U.S. government entity or agency
 
and are either
explicitly or implicitly guaranteed by the U.S. government.
 
The Company considers the long history of no credit losses on
 
these
securities indicates that the expectation of nonpayment
 
of the amortized cost basis is zero, even if the U.S. government
 
were to
technically default.
 
Further, certain municipal securities held
 
by the Company have been pre-refunded and secured
 
by
government
 
guaranteed treasuries.
 
Therefore, for the aforementioned securities, the Company
 
does not assess or record expected
credit losses due to the zero loss assumption.
 
Impairment - Available-for-Sale
 
Securities
.
 
Unrealized gains on available-for-sale securities are
 
excluded from earnings and reported, net of tax, in other
 
comprehensive
income (“OCI”).
 
For available-for-sale securities that are in an unrealized loss position,
 
the Company first assesses whether it
intends to sell, or whether it is more likely than not it will
 
be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized
 
cost
basis.
 
If either of the criteria regarding intent or requirement to
 
sell is met, the security’s amortized
 
cost basis is written down to
fair value through income.
 
For available-for-sale securities that do not meet
 
the aforementioned criteria or have a zero loss
assumption, the Company evaluates whether the decline
 
in fair value has resulted from credit losses or other factors.
 
In making
this assessment, management considers the extent
 
to which fair value is less than amortized cost, any changes
 
to the rating of the
security by a rating agency,
 
and adverse conditions specifically related to the security,
 
among other factors.
 
If the assessment
indicates that a credit loss exists, the present value
 
of cash flows to be collected from the security are compared
 
to the amortized
cost basis of the security.
 
If the present value of cash flows expected to be collected
 
is less than the amortized cost basis, a credit
loss exists and an allowance for credit losses is recorded through
 
a provision for credit loss expense, limited by the amount that
fair value is less than the amortized cost basis.
 
Any impairment that has not been recorded through an
 
allowance for credit losses
is recognized in other comprehensive income.
 
 
 
75
Allowance for Credit Losses - Held-to-Maturity
 
Securities.
 
Management measures expected credit losses on each
 
individual held-to-maturity debt security that has not been deemed to
 
have
a zero assumption.
 
Each security that is not deemed to have zero credit losses is individually
 
measured based on net realizable
value, or the difference between the discounted
 
value of the expected cash flows, based on the original effective
 
rate, and the
recorded amortized basis of the security.
 
To the extent a shortfall is related
 
to credit loss, an allowance for credit loss is recorded
through a provision for credit loss expense.
 
 
Loans Held for Investment
 
 
Loans held for investment (“HFI”) are stated at amortized cost which
 
includes the principal amount outstanding, net premiums
and discounts, and net deferred loan fees and costs.
 
Accrued interest receivable on loans is reported in other assets and
 
is not
included in the amortized cost basis of loans.
 
Interest income is accrued on the effective yield method
 
based on outstanding
principal balances and includes loan late fees.
 
Fees charged to originate loans and direct loan origination
 
costs are deferred and
amortized over the life of the loan as a yield adjustment.
 
 
The Company defines loans as past due when one
 
full payment is past due or a contractual maturity is over 30
 
days late.
 
The
accrual of interest is generally suspended on loans more
 
than 90 days past due with respect to principal or interest.
 
When a loan is
placed on nonaccrual status, all previously accrued
 
and uncollected interest is reversed against current income and thus
 
a policy
election has been made to not include in the estimate of
 
credit losses.
 
Interest income on nonaccrual loans is recognized when
 
the
ultimate collectability is no longer considered doubtful.
 
Loans are returned to accrual status when the principal and interest
amounts contractually due are brought current or when
 
future payments are reasonably assured.
 
 
Loan charge-offs on commercial and
 
investor real estate loans are recorded when the facts and circumstances
 
of the individual
loan confirm the loan is not fully collectible and the
 
loss is reasonably quantifiable.
 
Factors considered in making these
determinations are the borrower’s and any
 
guarantor’s ability and willingness to pay,
 
the status of the account in bankruptcy court
(if applicable), and collateral value.
 
Charge-off decisions for consumer loans
 
are dictated by the Federal Financial Institutions
Examination Council’s (FFIEC)
 
Uniform Retail Credit Classification and Account Management
 
Policy which establishes
standards for the classification and treatment of consumer
 
loans, which generally require charge-off after
 
120 days of
delinquency.
 
The Company has adopted comprehensive lending policies,
 
underwriting standards and loan review procedures designed
 
to
maximize loan income within an acceptable level
 
of risk.
 
Reporting systems are used to monitor loan originations,
 
loan ratings,
concentrations, loan delinquencies, nonperforming
 
and potential problem loans, and other credit quality metrics.
 
The ongoing
review of loan portfolio quality and trends by Management
 
and the Credit Risk Oversight Committee support the
 
process for
estimating the allowance for credit losses.
 
 
Allowance for Credit Losses
 
 
The allowance for credit losses is a valuation account that
 
is deducted from the loans’ amortized cost basis to present
 
the net
amount expected to be collected on the loans.
 
The allowance for credit losses is adjusted by a credit loss provision
 
which is
reported in earnings, and reduced by the charge
 
-off of loan amounts, net of recoveries.
 
Loans are charged off against the
allowance when management believes the uncollectability
 
of a loan balance is confirmed.
 
Expected recoveries do not exceed the
aggregate of amounts previously charged
 
-off and expected to be charged-off.
 
Expected credit loss inherent in non-cancellable
off-balance sheet credit exposures is accounted
 
for as a separate liability included in other liabilities.
 
Management estimates the allowance balance using
 
relevant available information, from internal and external
 
sources, relating to
past events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable
 
forecasts.
 
Historical loan default and loss experience provides the
starting basis for the estimation of expected credit losses.
 
Adjustments to historical loss information incorporate
 
management’s
view of current conditions and forecasts.
 
 
The methodology for estimating the amount of credit losses reported
 
in the allowance for credit losses has two basic components:
first, an asset-specific component involving loans that
 
do not share risk characteristics and the measurement of expected
 
credit
losses for such individual loans; and second, a pooled
 
component for expected credit losses for pools of loans that
 
share similar
risk characteristics.
 
 
 
76
Loans That Do Not Share Risk Characteristics
 
(Individually Analyzed)
 
Loans that do not share similar risk characteristics are evaluated
 
on an individual basis.
 
Loans deemed to be collateral dependent
have differing risk characteristics and are individually
 
analyzed to estimate the expected credit loss.
 
A loan is collateral
dependent when the borrower is experiencing financial
 
difficulty and repayment of the loan is dependent
 
on the liquidation and
sale of the underlying collateral.
 
For collateral dependent loans where foreclosure is probable, the
 
expected credit loss is
measured based on the difference
 
between the fair value of the collateral (less selling cost) and
 
the amortized cost basis of the
asset.
 
For collateral dependent loans where foreclosure is not probable,
 
the Company has elected the practical expedient allowed
by ASC 326-20 to measure the expected credit loss under
 
the same approach as those loans where foreclosure is probable.
 
For
loans with balances greater than $
250,000
 
the fair value of the collateral is obtained through independent appraisal
 
of the
underlying collateral.
 
For loans with balances less than $
250,000
, the Company has made a policy election to measure expected
loss for these individual loans utilizing loss rates for similar
 
loan types.
 
The aforementioned measurement criteria are applied for
collateral dependent troubled debt restructurings.
 
 
Loans That Share Similar Risk Characteristics
 
(Pooled Loans)
 
The general steps in determining expected credit losses for
 
the pooled loan component of the allowance are as follows:
 
Segment loans into pools according to similar risk characteristics
 
Develop historical loss rates for each loan pool segment
 
Incorporate the impact of forecasts
 
Incorporate the impact of other qualitative factors
 
 
Calculate and review pool specific allowance for credit loss estimate
 
Methodology –
 
A discounted cash flow (“DCF”) methodology is utilized
 
to calculate expected cash flows for the life of each individual
 
loan.
 
The discounted present value of expected cash flow
 
is then compared to the loan’s amortized
 
cost basis to determine the credit
loss estimate.
 
Individual loan results are aggregated at the pool level
 
in determining total reserves for each loan pool.
 
 
The primary inputs used to calculate expected cash
 
flows include historical loss rates which reflect probabil
 
ity of default (“PD”)
and loss given default (“LGD”), and prepayment rates.
 
The historical look-back period is a key factor in the calculation
 
of the PD
rate and is based on management’s
 
assessment of current and forecasted conditions and
 
may vary by loan pool.
 
Loans subject to
the Company’s risk rating
 
process are further sub-segmented by risk rating in the
 
calculation of PD rates.
 
LGD rates generally
reflect the historical average net loss rate by loan
 
pool.
 
Expected cash flows are further adjusted to incorporate the
 
impact of loan
prepayments which will vary by loan segment and interest
 
rate conditions.
 
In general, prepayment rates are based on observed
prepayment rates occurring in the loan portfolio and
 
consideration of forecasted interest rates.
 
Forecast Factors –
 
In developing loss rates, adjustments are made to
 
incorporate the impact of forecasted conditions.
 
Certain assumptions are also
applied, including the length of the forecast and reversion
 
periods.
 
The forecast period is the period within which management is
able to make a reasonable and supportable assessment of
 
future conditions.
 
The reversion period is the period beyond which
management believes it can develop a reasonable and
 
supportable forecast, and bridges the gap between the forecast period
 
and
the use of historical default and loss rates.
 
The remainder period reflects the remaining life of
 
the loan.
 
The length of the forecast
and reversion periods are periodically evaluated and
 
based on management’s assessment
 
of current and forecasted conditions and
may vary by loan pool.
 
For purposes of developing a reasonable and supportable
 
assessment of future conditions, management
utilizes established industry and economic data
 
points and sources, including the Federal Open Market
 
Committee forecast, with
the forecasted unemployment rate being a significant
 
factor.
 
PD rates for the forecast period will be adjusted accordingly based
on management’s assessment
 
of future conditions.
 
PD rates for the remainder period will reflect the historical mean
 
PD rate.
 
Reversion period PD rates reflect the difference
 
between forecast and remainder period PD rates calculated using
 
a straight-line
adjustment over the reversion period.
 
 
Qualitative Factors –
 
Loss rates are further adjusted to account for other risk factors
 
that impact loan defaults and losses.
 
These adjustments are based
on management’s assessment
 
of trends and conditions that impact credit risk and resulting
 
loan losses, more specifically internal
and external factors that are independent of and not reflected
 
in the quantitative loss rate calculations.
 
Risk factors management
considers in this assessment include trends in underwriting
 
standards, nature/volume/terms of loan originations, past due loans,
loan review systems, collateral valuations, concentrations,
 
legal/regulatory/political conditions, and the unforeseen impact of
natural disasters.
 
 
77
Allowance for Credit Losses on Off-Balance
 
Sheet Credit Exposures
 
The Company estimates expected credit losses over
 
the contractual period in which it is exposed to credit risk through
 
a
contractual obligation to extend credit, unless that obligation
 
is unconditionally cancellable by the Company.
 
The allowance for
credit losses on off-balance sheet credit exposures
 
is adjusted as a provision for credit loss expense and is recorded
 
in other
liabilities.
 
The estimate includes consideration of the likelihood
 
that funding will occur and an estimate of expected credit losses
on commitments expected to be funded over its estimated life
 
and applies the same estimated loss rate as determined
 
for current
outstanding loan balances by segment.
 
Off-balance sheet credit exposures are identified and classified
 
in the same categories as
the allowance for credit losses with similar risk characteristics
 
that have been previously mentioned.
 
Mortgage Banking Activities
 
Mortgage Loans Held for Sale and Revenue Recognition
 
Mortgage loans held for sale (“HFS”) are carried at fair
 
value under the fair value option with changes in fair value
 
recorded in
gain on sale of mortgage loans held for sale on the consolidated
 
statements of income. The fair value of mortgage loans held
 
for
sale committed to investors is calculated using observable
 
market information such as the investor commitment, assignment of
trade (AOT) or other mandatory delivery commitment prices.
 
The Company bases loans committed to Agency
 
investors based on
the Agency’s quoted
 
mortgage backed
 
security (MBS) prices. The fair value of mortgage loans held for sale
 
not committed to
investors is based on quoted best execution secondary
 
market prices. If no such quoted price exists, the fair value is determined
using quoted prices for a similar asset or assets, such as MBS prices,
 
adjusted for the specific attributes of that loan, which would
be used by other market participants.
 
Gains and losses from the sale of mortgage loans held
 
for sale are recognized based upon the difference
 
between the sales
proceeds and carrying value of the related loans upon
 
sale and are recorded in mortgage banking revenues on the consolidated
statements of income. Sales proceeds reflect the cash
 
received from investors through the sale of the loan and servicing
 
release
premium. If the related mortgage loan is sold servicing retained,
 
the MSR addition is recorded in mortgage banking revenues on
the consolidated statements of income.
 
Mortgage banking revenues also includes the unrealized gains
 
and losses associated with
the changes in the fair value of mortgage loans held
 
for sale, and the realized and unrealized gains and losses from
 
derivative
instruments.
 
Mortgage loans held for sale are considered sold when
 
the Company surrenders control over the financial assets. Control is
considered to have been surrendered when the transferred
 
assets have been isolated from the Company,
 
beyond the reach of the
Company and its creditors; the purchaser obtains the
 
right (free of conditions that constrain it from taking advantage of
 
that right)
to pledge or exchange the transferred assets; and the
 
Company does not maintain effective control over
 
the transferred assets
through either an agreement that both entitles and
 
obligates the Company to repurchase or redeem the
 
transferred assets before
their maturity or the ability to unilaterally cause the holder
 
to return specific assets. The Company typically considers the above
criteria to have been met upon acceptance and receipt
 
of sales proceeds from the purchaser.
 
Government National Mortgage Association (GNMA) optional
 
repurchase programs allow financial institutions to buy back
individual delinquent mortgage loans that meet certain
 
criteria from the securitized loan pool for which the institution
 
provides
servicing.
 
At the servicer’s option and without GNMA’s
 
prior authorization, the servicer may repurchase such
 
a delinquent loan
for an amount equal to 100 percent of the remaining
 
principal balance of the loan.
 
Under FASB ASC Topic
 
860, “Transfers and
Servicing,” this buy-back option is considered a conditional
 
option until the delinquency criteria are met, at which
 
time the option
becomes unconditional.
 
When the Company is deemed to have regained effective
 
control over these loans under the
unconditional buy-back option, the loans can no longer be
 
reported as sold and must be brought back onto the balance sheet,
regardless of whether there is intent
 
to exercise the buy-back option.
 
These loans are reported in other assets with the offsetting
liability being reported in other liabilities.
 
 
Derivative Instruments (IRLC/Forward Commitments)
 
 
The Company holds and issues derivative financial
 
instruments such as interest rate lock commitments (IRLCs) and other
 
forward
sale commitments. IRLCs are subject to price risk primarily
 
related to fluctuations in market interest rates. To
 
hedge the interest
rate risk on certain IRLCs, the Company uses forward
 
sale commitments, such as to-be-announced securities (TBAs) or
mandatory delivery commitments with investors. Management
 
expects these forward sale commitments to experience changes
 
in
fair value opposite to the changes in fair value of
 
the IRLCs thereby reducing earnings volatility.
 
Forward sale commitments are
also used to hedge the interest rate risk on mortgage loans
 
held for sale that are not committed to investors and still subject to
price risk. If the mandatory delivery commitments are not
 
fulfilled, the Company pays a pair-off
 
fee. Best effort forward sale
commitments are also executed with investors, whereby
 
certain loans are locked with a borrower and simultaneously
 
committed
to an investor at a fixed price. If the best effort
 
IRLC does not fund, there is no obligation to fulfill the investor
 
commitment.
 
 
78
The Company considers various factors and strategies in
 
determining what portion of the IRLCs and uncommitted mortgage
 
loans
held for sale to economically hedge.
 
All derivative instruments are recognized as other assets or other
 
liabilities on the
consolidated statements of financial condition at their
 
fair value. Changes in the fair value of the derivative instruments
 
are
recognized in gain on sale of mortgage loans held for
 
sale on the consolidated statements of income in the period in
 
which they
occur. Gains and losses resulting
 
from the pairing-out of forward sale commitments are recognized
 
in gain on sale of mortgage
loans held for sale on the consolidated statements of income. The
 
Company accounts for all derivative instruments as free-
standing derivative instruments and does not designate
 
any for hedge accounting.
 
Mortgage Servicing Rights (“MSRs”) and Revenue Recognition
 
 
The Company sells residential mortgage loans in the secondary
 
market and may retain the right to service the loans sold.
 
Upon
sale, an MSR asset is capitalized, which represents the
 
then current fair value of future net cash flows expected to be
 
realized for
performing servicing activities.
 
As the Company has not elected to subsequently measure
 
any class of servicing assets under the
fair value measurement method, the Company follows the
 
amortization method.
 
MSRs are amortized to noninterest income
(other income) in proportion to and over the period of estimated
 
net servicing income, and assessed for impairment at each
reporting date.
 
MSRs are carried at the lower of the initial capitalized amount, net
 
of accumulated amortization, or estimated fair
value, and included in other assets, net, on the consolidated
 
statements of financial condition.
 
 
The Company periodically evaluates its MSRs asset for impairment.
 
Impairment is assessed based on fair value at each reporting
date using estimated prepayment speeds of the underlying
 
mortgage loans serviced and stratifications based on the risk
characteristics of the underlying loans (predominantly
 
loan type and note interest rate).
 
As mortgage interest rates fall,
prepayment speeds are usually faster and the value
 
of the MSRs asset generally decreases, requiring additional valuation
 
reserve.
 
Conversely, as mortgage
 
interest rates rise, prepayment speeds are usually slower and
 
the value of the MSRs asset generally
increases, requiring less valuation reserve.
 
A valuation allowance is established, through a charge
 
to earnings, to the extent the
amortized cost of the MSRs exceeds the estimated fair
 
value by stratification.
 
If it is later determined that all or a portion of the
temporary impairment no longer exists for a stratification,
 
the valuation is reduced through a recovery to earnings.
 
An other-than-
temporary impairment (i.e., recoverability is considered
 
remote when considering interest rates and loan pay off
 
activity) is
recognized as a write-down of the MSRs asset and the related
 
valuation allowance (to the extent a valuation allowance
 
is
available) and then against earnings.
 
A direct write-down permanently reduces the carrying value
 
of the MSRs asset and
valuation allowance, precluding subsequent recoveries.
 
 
Derivative/Hedging Activities
 
At the inception of a derivative contract, the Company designates
 
the derivative as one of three types based on the Company's
intentions and belief as to the likely effectiveness
 
as a hedge. These three types are (1) a hedge of the fair
 
value of a recognized
asset or liability or of an unrecognized firm commitment
 
("fair value hedge"), (2) a hedge of a forecasted transaction
 
or the
variability of cash flows to be received or paid related
 
to a recognized asset or liability ("cash flow hedge"), or (3) an
 
instrument
with no hedging designation ("standalone derivative").
 
For a fair value hedge, the gain or loss on the derivative, as well as the
offsetting loss or gain on the hedged item,
 
are recognized in current earnings as fair values change. For a cash flow
 
hedge, the
gain or loss on the derivative is reported in other comprehensive
 
income and is reclassified into earnings in the same periods
during which the hedged transaction affects earnings.
 
For both types of hedges, changes in the fair value of derivative
 
s
 
that are
not highly effective in hedging the changes in
 
fair value or expected cash flows of the hedged item are recognized
 
immediately in
current earnings. Net cash settlements on derivatives that
 
qualify for hedge accounting are recorded in interest income
 
or interest
expense, based on the item being hedged. Net cash settlements on
 
derivatives that do not qualify for hedge accounting are
reported in non-interest income. Cash flows on hedges are
 
classified in the cash flow statement the same as the cash flows of
 
the
items being hedged.
 
The Company formally documents the relationship between
 
derivatives and hedged items, as well as the risk-management
objective and the strategy for undertaking hedge
 
transactions at the inception of the hedging relationship. This documentation
includes linking fair value or cash flow hedges to specific
 
assets and liabilities on the balance sheet or to specific firm
commitments or forecasted transactions. The Company
 
also formally assesses, both at the hedge's inception and on
 
an ongoing
basis, whether the derivative instruments that are used
 
are highly effective in offsetting changes in
 
fair values or cash flows of the
hedged items. The Company discontinues hedge
 
accounting when it determines that the derivative is no longer
 
effective in
offsetting changes in the fair value or cash
 
flows of the hedged item, the derivative is settled or terminates, a
 
hedged forecasted
transaction is no longer probable, a hedged firm commitment
 
is no longer firm, or treatment of the derivative as a hedge is no
longer appropriate
 
or intended. When hedge accounting is discontinued, subsequent
 
changes in fair value of the derivative are
recorded as non-interest income. When a fair value hedge
 
is discontinued, the hedged asset or liability is no longer adjusted for
changes in fair value and the existing basis adjustment
 
is amortized or accreted over the remaining life of the
 
asset or liability.
When a cash flow hedge is discontinued but the hedged
 
cash flows or forecasted transactions are still expected to occur,
 
gains or
losses that were accumulated in other comprehensive
 
income are amortized into earnings over the same periods, in which the
hedged transactions will affect earnings.
 
 
79
Long-Lived Assets
 
 
Premises and equipment is stated at cost less accumulated
 
depreciation, computed on the straight-line method over
 
the estimated
useful lives for each type of asset with premises being depreciated
 
over a range of
10
 
to
40
 
years, and equipment being
depreciated over a range of
3
 
to
10
 
years.
 
Additions, renovations and leasehold improvements to premises are
 
capitalized and
depreciated over the lesser of the useful life or the remaining
 
lease term.
 
Repairs and maintenance are charged to noninterest
expense as incurred.
 
Long-lived assets are evaluated for impairment
 
if circumstances suggest that their carrying value may not be recoverable,
 
by
comparing the carrying value to estimated undiscounted
 
cash flows.
 
If the asset is deemed impaired, an impairment charge
 
is
recorded equal to the carrying value less the fair value.
 
Leases
 
The Company has entered into various operating
 
leases, primarily for banking offices.
 
Generally, these leases have
 
initial lease
terms from one to ten years.
 
Many of the leases have one or more lease renewal options.
 
The exercise of lease renewal options is
at the Company’s sole discretion.
 
The Company does not consider exercise of any lease renewal options
 
reasonably certain.
 
Certain of the lease contain early termination options.
 
No renewal options or early termination options have been
 
included in the
calculation of the operating right-of-use assets or operating
 
lease liabilities.
 
Certain of the lease agreements provide for periodic
adjustments to rental payments for inflation.
 
At the commencement date of the lease, the Company recognizes
 
a lease liability at
the present value of the lease payments not yet paid, discounted
 
using the discount rate for the lease or the Company’s
incremental borrowing rate.
 
As the majority of the Company's leases do not provide
 
an implicit rate, the Company uses its
incremental borrowing rate at the commencement date
 
in determining the present value of lease payments.
 
The incremental
borrowing rate is based on the term of the lease.
 
Incremental borrowing rates on January 1, 2019 were used
 
for operating leases
that commenced prior to that date.
 
At the commencement date, the company also recognizes a right
 
-of-use asset measured at (i)
the initial measurement of the lease liability; (ii) any lease
 
payments made to the lessor at or before the commencement
 
date less
any lease incentives received; and (iii) any initial direct
 
costs incurred by the lessee.
 
Leases with an initial term of 12 months or
less are not recorded on the balance sheet.
 
For these short-term leases, lease expense is recognized
 
on a straight-line basis over
the lease term.
 
At December 31, 2020,
 
the Company had no leases classified as finance leases.
 
See Note 7 – Leases for
additional information.
 
Bank Owned Life Insurance (BOLI)
 
The Company, through
 
its subsidiary bank, has purchased life insurance policies on
 
certain key officers.
 
Bank owned life
insurance is recorded at the amount that can be
 
realized under the insurance contract at the balance sheet date, which
 
is the cash
surrender value adjusted for other charges or
 
other amounts due that are probable at settlement.
 
Goodwill
 
 
Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of businesses acquired
 
over the fair value of the net assets acquired.
 
In accordance
with FASB ASC Topic
 
350, the Company determined it has one goodwill reporting
 
unit.
 
Goodwill is tested for impairment
annually during the fourth quarter or on an interim
 
basis if an event occurs or circumstances change that would more
 
likely than
not reduce the fair value of the reporting unit below
 
its carrying value.
 
See Note 8 – Goodwill for additional information
.
 
 
Other Real Estate Owned
 
 
Assets acquired through, or in lieu of, loan foreclosure
 
are held for sale and are initially recorded at the lower of cost
 
or fair value
less estimated selling costs, establishing a new cost basis.
 
Subsequent to foreclosure, valuations are periodically performed
 
by
management and the assets are carried at the lower of carrying
 
amount or fair value less cost to sell.
 
The valuation of foreclosed
assets is subjective in nature and may be adjusted in the
 
future because of changes in economic conditions.
 
Revenue and
expenses from operations and changes in value are
 
included in noninterest expense.
 
 
Loss Contingencies
 
 
Loss contingencies, including claims and legal actions
 
arising in the ordinary course of business are recorded as liabilities when
the likelihood of loss is probable and an amount or range of
 
loss can be reasonably estimated.
 
 
80
Noncontrolling Interest
 
To the extent
 
the Company’s interest in a consolidated
 
entity represents less than 100% of the entity’s
 
equity, the Company
recognizes noncontrolling interests in subsidiaries.
 
In the case of the CCHL acquisition (previously noted
 
under Business
Combination), the noncontrolling interest represents
 
equity which is redeemable or convertible for cash at the
 
option of the equity
holder and is classified within temporary equity in the
 
mezzanine section of the Consolidated Statements of Financial
 
Condition.
 
The call/put option is redeemable at the option of either
 
CCBG (call) or the noncontrolling interest holder (put) on or
 
after
January 1, 2025, and therefore, not entirely within CCBG’s
 
control.
 
The subsidiary's net income or loss and related dividends are
allocated to CCBG and the noncontrolling interest holder
 
based on their relative ownership percentages.
 
The noncontrolling
interest carrying value is adjusted on a quarterly basis to the
 
higher of the carrying value or current redemption value,
 
at the
balance sheet date, through a corresponding adjustment
 
to retained earnings.
 
The redemption value is calculated quarterly and is
based on the higher of a predetermined book value or pre-tax earnings
 
multiple.
 
To the extent the redemption
 
value exceeds the
fair value of the noncontrolling interest, the Company’s
 
earnings per share attributable to common shareowners
 
is adjusted by that
amount.
 
The Company uses an independent valuation expert to assist in estimating
 
the fair value of the noncontrolling interest
using: 1) the discounted cash flow methodology under
 
the income approach, and (2) the guideline public company
 
methodology
under the market approach.
 
The estimated fair value is derived from equally weighting the result of
 
each of the two
methodologies.
 
The estimation of the fair value includes significant assumptions
 
concerning: (1) projected loan volumes; (2)
projected pre-tax profit margins; (3) tax
 
rates and (4) discount rates.
 
Income Taxes
 
 
Income tax expense is the total of the current year
 
income tax due or refundable and the change in deferred tax
 
assets and
liabilities (excluding deferred tax assets and liabilities related
 
to business combinations or components of other comprehensive
income).
 
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are the expected future tax amounts
 
for the temporary differences between carrying
amounts and tax bases of assets and liabilities, computed
 
using enacted tax rates.
 
A valuation allowance, if needed, reduces
deferred tax assets to the expected amount most likely
 
to be realized.
 
Realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the
generation of a sufficient level of future taxable
 
income and recoverable taxes paid in prior years.
 
The income tax effects related
to settlements of share-based payment awards are reported
 
in earnings as an increase or decrease in income tax expense.
 
 
The Company files a consolidated federal income tax
 
return and each subsidiary files a separate state income tax return.
 
Earnings Per Common Share
 
 
Basic earnings per common share is based on net income
 
divided by the weighted-average number of common shares
 
outstanding
during the period excluding non-vested stock.
 
Diluted earnings per common share include the dilutive effect
 
of stock options and
non-vested stock awards granted using the treasury stock
 
method.
 
A reconciliation of the weighted-average shares used in
calculating basic earnings per common share and the
 
weighted average common shares used in calculating diluted
 
earnings per
common share for the reported periods is provided in
 
Note 14 — Earnings Per Share.
 
Comprehensive Income
 
 
Comprehensive income includes all changes in shareowners’
 
equity during a period, except those resulting from transactions
 
with
shareowners.
 
Besides net income, other components of the Company’s
 
comprehensive income include the after tax effect of
changes in the net unrealized gain/loss on securities available
 
for sale and changes in the funded status of defined benefit and
supplemental executive retirement plans.
 
Comprehensive income is reported in the accompanying Consolidated
 
Statements of
Comprehensive Income and Changes in Shareowners’ Equity.
 
Stock Based Compensation
 
 
Compensation cost is recognized for share-based
 
awards issued to employees, based on the fair value of these awards
 
at the date
of grant.
 
Compensation cost is recognized over the requisite service period,
 
generally defined as the vesting period.
 
The market
price of the Company’s
 
common stock at the date of the grant is used for
 
restricted stock awards.
 
For stock purchase plan awards,
a Black-Scholes model is utilized to estimate the fair
 
value of the award.
 
The impact of forfeitures of share-based awards on
compensation expense is recognized as forfeitures occur.
 
 
81
Revenue Recognition
 
Accounting Standards Codification ("ASC") 606, Revenue
 
from Contracts with Customers ("ASC 606"), establishes principles
for reporting information about the nature, amount,
 
timing and uncertainty of revenue and cash flows arising from
 
the entity's
contracts to provide goods or services to customers. The
 
core principle requires an entity to recognize revenue to depict the
transfer of goods or services to customers in an amount
 
that reflects the consideration that it expects to be entitled to receive
 
in
exchange for those goods or services recognized as performance
 
obligations are satisfied.
 
The majority of the Company’s revenue
 
-generating transactions are not subject to ASC 606, including
 
revenue generated from
financial instruments, such as our loans, letters of credit,
 
and investment securities, and revenue related to the sale of residential
mortgages in the secondary market, as these activities are
 
subject to other GAAP discussed elsewhere within our disclosures.
 
The
Company recognizes revenue from these activities as it is earned
 
based on contractual terms, as transactions occur,
 
or as services
are provided and collectability is reasonably assured.
 
Descriptions of the major revenue-generating activities that are
 
within the
scope of ASC 606, which are presented in the accompanying
 
statements of income as components of non-interest income are
 
as
follows:
 
Deposit Fees - these represent general service fees
 
for monthly account maintenance and activity- or transaction
 
-based fees and
consist of transaction-based revenue, time-based revenue
 
(service period), item-based revenue or some other individual
 
attribute-
based revenue.
 
Revenue is recognized when the Company’s
 
performance obligation is completed which is generally
 
monthly for
account maintenance services or when a transaction has
 
been completed.
 
Payment for such performance obligations are generally
received at the time the performance obligations are
 
satisfied.
 
Wealth Management
 
- trust fees and retail brokerage fees – trust fees represent
 
monthly fees due from wealth management clients
as consideration for managing the client’s
 
assets. Trust services include custody of
 
assets, investment management, fees for trust
services and similar fiduciary activities. Revenue is recognized
 
when the Company’s performance
 
obligation is completed each
month or quarter, which is the time that
 
payment is received. Also, retail brokerage fees are received
 
from a third party broker-
dealer, for which the Company acts
 
as an agent, as part of a revenue-sharing agreement
 
for fees earned from customers that are
referred to the third party.
 
These fees are for transactional and advisory services and are paid by
 
the third party on a monthly
basis and recognized ratably throughout the quarter as the
 
Company’s performance obligation
 
is satisfied.
 
Bank Card Fees – bank card related fees primarily
 
includes interchange income from client use of consumer and business debit
cards.
 
Interchange income is a fee paid by a merchant bank to the card-issuing
 
bank through the interchange network.
 
Interchange fees are set by the credit card associations and
 
are based on cardholder purchase volumes.
 
The Company records
interchange income as transactions occur.
 
Gains and Losses from the Sale of Bank Owned Property
 
– the performance obligation in the sale of other real estate owned
typically will be the delivery of control over the property
 
to the buyer.
 
If the Company is not providing the financing of the sale,
the transaction price is typically identified in the purchase
 
and sale agreement.
 
However, if the Company provides seller
financing, the Company must determine a transaction price,
 
depending on if the sale contract is at market terms and
 
taking into
account the credit risk inherent in the arrangement.
 
 
Other non-interest income primarily includes items such
 
as mortgage banking fees (gains from the sale of residential mortgage
loans held for sale), bank-owned life insurance, and
 
safe deposit box fees none of which are subject to the requirements of
 
ASC
606.
 
The Company has made no significant judgments in applying
 
the revenue guidance prescribed in ASC 606 that affects
 
the
determination of the amount and timing of revenue from the
 
above-described contracts with clients.
 
 
Accounting Standard Updates
 
 
ASU 2019-12,
 
"Income Taxes
 
(Topic
 
740): Simplifying the Accounting for Income Taxes.
 
ASU 2019-12 simplifies the accounting
for income taxes by eliminating certain exceptions to the
 
guidance in ASC 740 related to the approach for intra-period
 
tax
allocation when there is a loss from continuing operations
 
or a gain from other items and the general methodology for calculating
income taxes in an interim period when a year-to-date
 
loss exceeds the anticipated loss for the year.
 
ASU 2019-12 also
simplifies aspects of the accounting for franchise taxes and
 
enacted changes in tax laws or rates and clarifies the accounting
 
for
transactions that result in a step-up in the tax basis of
 
goodwill.
 
ASU 2019-12 is effective for the Company
 
on January 1, 2021
and is not expected to have a material impact on
 
the Company’s consolidated financial
 
statements.
 
 
82
ASU 2020-01, "Investments - Equity Securities (Topic
 
321), Investments - Equity Method and Joint Ventures
 
(Topic
 
323), and
Derivatives and Hedging (Topic
 
815).
 
ASU 2020-01 clarifies the interaction of the accounting for equity
 
securities under Topic
321 and investments accounted for under the equity method
 
of accounting in Topic
 
323 and the accounting for certain forward
contracts and purchased options accounted for under
 
Topic 815.
 
ASU 2020-01 is effective for the Company on
 
January 1, 2021
and is not expected to have a material impact on
 
the Company’s consolidated financial
 
statements.
 
ASU 2020-04, "Reference Rate Reform
 
(Topic
 
848).
 
ASU 2020-04 provides optional expedients and exceptions for applying
GAAP to loan and lease agreements, derivative contracts,
 
and other transactions affected by the anticipated
 
transition away from
LIBOR toward new interest rate benchmarks. For
 
transactions that are modified because of reference rate reform
 
and that meet
certain scope guidance (i) modifications of loan agreements
 
should be accounted for by prospectively adjusting
 
the effective
interest rate and the modification will be considered "minor"
 
so that any existing unamortized origination fees/costs would carry
forward and continue to be amortized and (ii) modifications
 
of lease agreements should be accounted for as a
 
continuation of the
existing agreement with no reassessments of the lease classification
 
and the discount rate or re-measurements of lease payments
that otherwise would be required for modifications not
 
accounted for as separate contracts. ASU 2020-04 also provides
 
numerous
optional expedients for derivative accounting.
 
ASU 2020-04 is effective March 12, 2020 through
 
December 31, 2022.
 
An entity
may elect to apply ASU 2020-04 for contract modifications
 
as of January 1, 2020, or prospectively from a date
 
within an interim
period that includes or is subsequent to March 12, 2020,
 
up to the date that the financial statements are available to
 
be issued.
 
Once elected for a Topic
 
or an Industry Subtopic within the Codification, the amendments
 
in this ASU must be applied
prospectively for all eligible contract modifications for
 
that Topic or Industry
 
Subtopic.
 
It is anticipated this ASU will simplify
any modifications executed between the selected start date
 
(yet to be determined) and December 31, 2022 that are
 
directly related
to LIBOR transition by allowing prospective recognition
 
of the continuation of the contract, rather than extinguishment
 
of the old
contract resulting in writing off unamortized
 
fees/costs.
 
Further,
ASU 2021-01, “Reference Rate Reform
 
(Topic
 
848): Scope,”
clarifies that certain optional expedients and exceptions
 
in ASC 848 for contract modifications and hedge accounting apply to
derivatives that are affected by the discounting
 
transition. ASU 2021-01 also amends the expedients and exceptions
 
in ASC 848
to capture the incremental consequences of the scope
 
clarification and to tailor the existing guidance to derivative instruments.
 
The Company is evaluating the impact of this ASU and
 
has not yet determined
 
if this ASU will have material effects on the
Company’s business operations
 
and consolidated financial statements.
 
ASU 2020-08, “Codification Improvements
 
to Subtopic 310-20, Receivables - Nonrefundable
 
Fees and Other Costs.”
ASU 2020-
08 clarifies the accounting for the amortization
 
of purchase premiums for callable debt securities with multiple
 
call dates. ASU
2020-8 will be effective for the Company
 
on January 1, 2021 and is not expected to have a significant impact
 
on Company’s
consolidated financial statements.
 
ASU 2020-09, “Debt (Topic
 
470): Amendments to SEC Paragraphs Pursuant to SEC Release No.
 
33-10762.”
ASU 2020-9
amends the ASC to reflect the issuance of an SEC rule
 
related to financial disclosure requirements for subsidiary issuers and
guarantors of registered debt securities and affiliates
 
whose securities are pledged as collateral for registered
 
securities.
ASU 2020-09 will be effective for the Company
 
on January 4, 2021, concurrent with the effective date
 
of the SEC release, and is
not expected to have a significant impact on Company’s
 
consolidated financial statements.
 
On March 27, 2020, the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and
 
Economic Security Act (“CARES Act”) was signed into law.
 
Section 4013
of the CARES Act, “Temporary
 
Relief From Troubled Debt Restructurings,”
 
provides banks the option to temporarily suspend
certain requirements under U.S. GAAP related to troubled
 
debt restructurings (“TDR”) for a limited period of time
 
to account for
the effects of COVID-19.
 
To qualify for
 
Section 4013 of the CARES Act, borrowers must have been current
 
at December 31,
2019.
 
All modifications are eligible as long as they are executed between
 
March 1, 2020 and the earlier of (i) December 31,
2020, or (ii) the 60th day after the end of the COVID-19
 
national emergency declared by the President of
 
the U.S.
 
Multiple
modifications of the same credits are allowed and
 
there is no cap on the duration of the modification. See MD&A (Credit
Quality/COVID-19 Exposure) for disclosure of the impact
 
to date.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
83
Note 2
INVESTMENT SECURITIES
Investment Portfolio Composition
. The following table summarizes the amortized cost and related
 
market value of investment
securities available-for-sale and securities held-to-maturity
 
and the corresponding amounts of gross unrealized gains and
 
losses.
2020
2019
Amortize
d
Unrealize
d
Unrealize
d
Market
Amortize
d
Unrealize
d
Unrealize
d
Market
(Dollars in Thousands)
Cost
Gains
Losses
Value
Cost
Gain
Losses
Value
Available for
 
Sale
U.S. Government Treasury
$
103,547
$
972
$
-
$
104,519
$
231,996
$
849
$
67
$
232,778
U.S. Government Agency
205,972
2,743
184
208,531
155,706
697
325
156,078
States and Political Subdivisions
3,543
89
-
3,632
6,310
9
-
6,319
Mortgage-Backed Securities
456
59
-
515
693
80
-
773
Equity Securities
(1)
7,673
-
-
7,673
7,653
-
-
7,653
Total
 
$
321,191
$
3,863
$
184
$
324,870
$
402,358
$
1,635
$
392
$
403,601
Held to Maturity
U.S. Government Treasury
$
5,001
$
13
$
-
$
5,014
$
20,036
$
15
$
9
$
20,042
States and Political Subdivisions
-
-
-
-
1,376
-
-
1,376
Mortgage-Backed Securities
164,938
5,223
-
170,161
218,127
2,064
180
220,011
Total
 
$
169,939
$
5,236
$
-
$
175,175
$
239,539
$
2,079
$
189
$
241,429
Total Investment
 
Securities
$
491,130
$
9,099
$
184
$
500,045
$
641,897
$
3,714
$
581
$
645,030
 
(1)
 
Includes Federal Home Loan Bank and Federal Reserve Bank
 
recorded at
 
cost of $
2.9
 
million and $
4.8
 
million, respectively,
 
at
 
December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019.
 
Securities with an amortized cost of $
308.2
 
million and $
353.8
 
million at December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019,
respectively, were
 
pledged to secure public deposits and for other purposes.
 
The Bank, as a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank
 
of Atlanta (“FHLB”), is required to own capital stock in the FHLB based
generally upon the balances of residential and commercial
 
real estate loans, and FHLB advances.
 
FHLB stock which is included
in other securities is pledged to secure FHLB advances.
 
No ready market exists for this stock, and it has no quoted
 
market value;
however, redemption of this stock
 
has historically been at par value.
 
As a member of the Federal Reserve Bank of Atlanta,
 
the Bank is required to maintain stock in the Federal Reserve Bank of
Atlanta based on a specified ratio relative to the Bank’s
 
capital.
 
Federal Reserve Bank stock is carried at cost.
 
Investment Sales
. There were no sales of investment securities for each of the
 
last three years.
 
Maturity Distribution
.
 
At December 31, 2020, the Company's investment securities had
 
the following maturity distribution based
on contractual maturity.
 
Expected maturities may differ from contractual maturities
 
because borrowers may have the right to call
or prepay obligations.
 
Mortgage-backed securities and certain amortizing U.S. government agency
 
securities are shown
separately since they are not due at a certain maturity
 
date.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
84
Available for
 
Sale
Held to Maturity
Amortized
 
Market
 
 
Amortized
 
Market
(Dollars in Thousands)
Cost
Value
Cost
Value
Due in one year or less
$
104,382
 
$
105,245
 
$
5,001
 
$
5,014
Due after one through five years
 
28,057
 
 
28,269
 
 
-
 
 
-
Mortgage-Backed Securities
456
515
164,938
170,161
U.S. Government Agency
 
180,623
 
 
183,168
 
 
-
 
 
-
Equity Securities
 
7,673
 
 
7,673
 
 
-
 
 
-
Total
 
$
321,191
 
$
324,870
 
$
169,939
 
$
175,175
 
Unrealized Losses
. The following table summarizes the investment securities
 
with unrealized losses at December 31, aggregated
by major security type and length of time in a continuous unrealized
 
loss position:
 
Less Than 12 Months
Greater Than 12 Months
Total
Market
Unrealized
Market
Unrealized
Market
Unrealized
(Dollars in Thousands)
Value
Losses
Value
Losses
Value
Losses
December 31, 2020
Available for
 
Sale
U.S. Government Agency
28,266
156
4,670
28
32,936
184
Total
 
28,266
 
156
 
4,670
 
28
 
32,936
 
184
December 31, 2019
Available for
 
Sale
 
U.S. Government Treasury
$
9,955
 
$
-
 
$
93,310
 
$
67
 
$
103,265
 
$
67
U.S. Government Agency
36,361
244
17,364
81
53,725
325
States and Political Subdivisions
 
578
 
 
-
 
 
-
 
 
-
 
 
578
 
 
-
Mortgage-Backed Securities
8
-
-
-
8
-
Total
 
46,902
 
244
 
110,674
 
148
 
157,576
 
392
 
Held to Maturity
U.S. Government Treasury
 
-
 
 
-
 
 
15,022
 
 
9
 
 
15,022
 
 
9
States and Political Subdivisions
1,033
-
-
-
1,033
-
Mortgage-Backed Securities
22,581
42
16,027
138
38,608
180
Total
 
$
23,614
 
$
42
 
$
31,049
 
$
147
 
$
54,663
 
$
189
 
At December 31, 2020, there were
47
 
available-for-sale (“AFS”) securities with unrealized
 
losses totaling $
0.2
 
million.
 
All of
these positions were U.S. government agency securities
 
guaranteed by U.S. government sponsored entities.
 
Because the declines
in the market value of these securities are attributable
 
to changes in interest rates and not credit quality and because the
 
Company
has the present ability and intent to hold these investments
 
until there is a recovery in fair value, which may be at maturity,
 
the
Company did not record any allowance for credit losses on
 
any investment securities at December 31, 2020.
 
Additionally, none
of the AFS or held-to-maturity securities held by the
 
Company were past due or in nonaccrual status at December 31,
 
2020.
 
Credit Quality Indicators
 
The Company monitors the credit quality of its investment
 
securities through various risk management procedures, including
 
the
monitoring of credit ratings.
 
A majority of the debt securities in the Company’s
 
investment portfolio were issued by a U.S.
government entity or agency and are either explicitly
 
or implicitly guaranteed by the U.S. government.
 
The Company believes
the long history of no credit losses on these securities indicates
 
that the expectation of nonpayment of the amortized
 
cost basis is
zero, even if the U.S. government were to technically default.
 
Further, certain municipal securities held
 
by the Company have
been pre-refunded and secured by government guaranteed
 
treasuries.
 
Therefore, for the aforementioned securities, the Company
does not assess or record expected credit losses due to
 
the zero loss assumption.
 
The Company monitors the credit quality of its
municipal securities portfolio via credit ratings which are
 
updated on a quarterly basis.
 
On a quarterly basis, municipal securities
in an unrealized loss position are evaluated to determine
 
if the loss is attributable to credit related factors and if an
 
allowance for
credit loss is needed.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
85
Note 3
LOANS HELD FOR INVESTMENT AND ALLOWANCE
 
FOR CREDIT LOSSES
 
Loan Portfolio Composition
.
 
The composition of the HFI loan portfolio at December
 
31 was as follows:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
$
393,930
 
$
255,365
Real Estate – Construction
 
135,831
 
 
115,018
Real Estate – Commercial Mortgage
 
648,393
 
 
625,556
Real Estate – Residential
(1)
 
352,543
 
 
361,450
Real Estate – Home Equity
 
205,479
 
 
197,360
Consumer
(2)
 
270,250
 
 
281,180
Loans Held for Investment, Net of Unearned Income
$
2,006,426
 
$
1,835,929
 
(1)
 
Includes loans in process with outstanding
 
balances of $
10.9
 
million and $
8.3
 
million for 2020 and 2019, respectively.
(2)
 
Includes overdraft balances of $
0.7
 
million and $
1.6
 
million for December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
 
 
Net deferred fees, which include premiums on purchased
 
loans, included in loans were $
0.1
 
million at December 31, 2020 and net
deferred costs were $
1.8
 
million at December 31, 2019.
 
Net deferred fees at December 31, 2020 included $
3.2
 
million in net fees
for SBA PPP loans.
 
Accrued interest receivable on loans which is excluded
 
from amortized cost totaled $
6.9
 
million at December 31, 2020 and $
5.5
million at December 31, 2019, and is reported separately
 
in Other Assets.
 
 
The Company has pledged a blanket floating lien on all 1-4
 
family residential mortgage loans, commercial real estate mortgage
loans, and home equity loans to support available borrowing
 
capacity at the FHLB of Atlanta and has pledged a blanket
 
floating
lien on all consumer loans, commercial loans, and construction
 
loans to support available borrowing capacity at the Federal
Reserve Bank of Atlanta.
 
 
Loan Purchases
.
 
The Company will periodically purchase newly originated 1-4
 
family real estate secured adjustable rate loans
from CCHL, a related party effective on
 
March 1, 2020 (see Note 1 – Significant Accounting Policies).
 
Loan purchases totaled
$
48.4
 
million and $
25.2
 
million for the years ended December 31, 2020 and December
 
31, 2019, respectively,
 
and were not credit
impaired.
 
 
Allowance for Loan Losses
.
 
The methodology for estimating the amount of credit
 
losses reported in the allowance for credit
losses (“ACL”) has two basic components: first, an asset-specific
 
component involving loans that do not share risk characteristics
and the measurement of expected credit losses for
 
such individual loans; and second, a pooled component for expected
 
credit
losses for pools of loans that share similar risk characteristics.
 
This methodology is discussed further in Note 1 – Significant
Accounting Policies.
 
 
The following table details the activity in the allowance
 
for credit losses by portfolio segment for the year
 
s
 
ended December 31.
 
Allocation of a portion of the allowance to one category
 
of loans does not preclude its availability to absorb
 
losses in other
categories.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
86
`
Commercial
,
Real Estate
Financial,
 
Real Estate
Commercial
 
Real Estate
Real Estate
(Dollars in Thousands)
Agricultural
Construction
Mortgage
Residential
Home Equity
Consumer
Total
2020
Beginning Balance
$
1,675
$
370
$
3,416
$
3,128
$
2,224
$
3,092
$
13,905
Impact of Adopting ASC
326
488
302
1,458
1,243
374
(596)
3,269
Provision for Credit Losses
578
1,757
1,865
940
486
3,409
9,035
Charge-Offs
(789)
-
(28)
(150)
(151)
(5,042)
(6,160)
Recoveries
 
252
50
318
279
178
2,690
3,767
Net Charge-Offs
(537)
50
290
129
27
(2,352)
(2,393)
Ending Balance
$
2,204
$
2,479
$
7,029
$
5,440
$
3,111
$
3,553
$
23,816
2019
Beginning Balance
$
1,434
$
280
$
4,181
$
3,400
$
2,301
$
2,614
$
14,210
Provision for Credit Losses
664
371
(1,129)
(301)
178
2,244
2,027
Charge-Offs
(768)
(281)
(214)
(400)
(430)
(2,878)
(4,971)
Recoveries
345
-
578
429
175
1,112
2,639
Net Charge-Offs
(423)
(281)
364
29
(255)
(1,766)
(2,332)
Ending Balance
$
1,675
$
370
$
3,416
$
3,128
$
2,224
$
3,092
$
13,905
2018
Beginning Balance
$
1,191
$
122
$
4,346
$
3,206
$
2,506
$
1,936
$
13,307
Provision for Credit Losses
428
139
(223)
331
137
2,109
2,921
Charge-Offs
(644)
(7)
(315)
(780)
(533)
(2,395)
(4,674)
Recoveries
459
26
373
643
191
964
2,656
Net Charge-Offs
(185)
19
58
(137)
(342)
(1,431)
(2,018)
Ending Balance
$
1,434
$
280
$
4,181
$
3,400
$
2,301
$
2,614
$
14,210
 
On January 1, 2020, we adopted ASC 326 and recorded
 
a pre-tax cumulative effect transition adjustment of $
3.3
 
million.
 
The
adoption of ASC 326 is discussed further in Note 1
 
– Significant Accounting Policies/Adoption of New Accounting
 
Standards.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2020, the provision
 
for credit losses totaled $
9.0
 
million for held for investment loans and net
loan charge-offs totaled $
2.4
 
million.
 
See Note 21 – Commitments and Contingencies for information
 
on the provision for credit
losses related to off-balance sheet commitments.
 
The $
6.6
 
million build (provision of $9.0 million less net charge-offs
 
of $2.4
million) in the allowance for credit losses for 2020 was attributable
 
to a deterioration in economic conditions, primarily a high
 
er
rate of unemployment due to the COVID-19 pandemic
 
and its potential effect on rates of default.
 
Three unemployment rate
forecast scenarios were utilized to estimate probability
 
of default and were weighted based on management’s
 
estimate of
probability.
 
The mitigating impact of the unprecedented fiscal stimulus, including
 
direct payments to individuals, increased
unemployment benefits, as well as various government
 
sponsored loan programs, was also considered.
 
Loan Portfolio Aging.
 
A loan is defined as a past due loan when one full payment is past
 
due or a contractual maturity is over 30
days past due (“DPD”).
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
87
The following table presents the aging of the amortized cost
 
basis in accruing past due loans by class of loans at December
 
31,
 
 
 
30-59
 
60-89
 
90 +
 
Total
Total
Nonaccrual
Total
(Dollars in Thousands)
DPD
DPD
DPD
Past Due
Current
Loans
Loans
2020
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
$
194
$
124
$
-
$
318
$
393,451
$
161
$
393,930
Real Estate – Construction
 
-
717
-
717
134,935
179
135,831
Real Estate – Commercial Mortgage
 
293
-
-
293
646,688
1,412
648,393
Real Estate – Residential
 
375
530
-
905
348,508
3,130
352,543
Real Estate – Home Equity
 
325
138
-
463
204,321
695
205,479
Consumer
 
1,556
342
-
1,898
268,058
294
270,250
Total Past Due Loans
$
2,743
$
1,851
$
-
$
4,594
$
1,995,961
$
5,871
$
2,006,426
2019
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
$
489
$
191
$
-
$
680
$
254,239
$
446
$
255,365
Real Estate – Construction
 
300
10
-
310
114,708
-
115,018
Real Estate – Commercial Mortgage
 
148
84
-
232
623,890
1,434
625,556
Real Estate – Residential
 
629
196
-
825
359,233
1,392
361,450
Real Estate – Home Equity
 
155
20
-
175
196,388
797
197,360
Consumer
 
2,000
649
-
2,649
278,128
403
281,180
Total Past Due Loans
$
3,721
$
1,150
$
-
$
4,871
$
1,826,586
$
4,472
$
1,835,929
 
Nonaccrual Loans
.
 
Loans are generally placed on nonaccrual status if principal or
 
interest payments become 90 days past due
and/or management deems the collectability of the
 
principal and/or interest to be doubtful.
 
Loans are returned to accrual status
when the principal and interest amounts contractually due
 
are brought current or when future payments are reasonably
 
assured.
 
 
The following table presents the amortized cost basis of loans in
 
nonaccrual status and loans past due over 90 days and
 
still on
accrual by class of loans.
 
2020
 
2019
Nonaccrual
Nonaccrual
90 + Days
Nonaccrual
Nonaccrual
90 + Days
With No
With
Still
With No
With
Still
(Dollars in Thousands)
ACL
 
ACL
 
Accruing
ACL
 
ACL
 
Accruing
Commercial, Financial and Agricultural
$
-
$
161
$
-
$
-
$
446
$
-
Real Estate – Construction
 
-
179
-
-
-
-
Real Estate – Commercial Mortgage
 
1,075
337
-
958
476
-
Real Estate – Residential
 
1,513
1,617
-
227
1,165
-
Real Estate – Home Equity
 
-
695
-
-
797
-
Consumer
 
-
294
-
-
403
-
Total Nonaccrual
 
Loans
$
2,588
$
3,283
$
-
$
1,185
$
3,287
$
-
 
The Company recognized $
52,000
 
and $
35,000
 
of interest income on nonaccrual loans for the years ended
 
December 31, 2020
and December 31, 2019, respectively.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
88
Collateral Dependent Loans
.
 
 
The following table presents the amortized cost basis of collateral
 
dependent loans at December 31:
 
2020
Real Estate
Non Real Estate
(Dollars in Thousands)
Secured
Secured
Real Estate – Commercial Mortgage
3,900
-
Real Estate – Residential
3,022
-
Real Estate – Home Equity
219
-
Consumer
-
29
Total
$
7,141
$
29
 
A loan is collateral dependent when the borrower is experiencing
 
financial difficulty and repayment of the loan
 
is dependent on
the sale or operation of the underlying collateral.
 
 
The Bank’s collateral dependent
 
loan portfolio is comprised primarily of real estate secured loans,
 
collateralized by either
residential or commercial collateral types.
 
The loans are carried at fair value based on current values determined
 
by either
independent appraisals or internal evaluations, adjusted for
 
selling costs or other amounts to be deducted when estimating
expected net sales proceeds.
 
 
Residential Real Estate Loans In Process
 
of Foreclosure
.
 
At December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, the Company
 
had $
1.6
million and $
1.2
 
million, respectively,
 
in 1-4 family residential real estate loans for which formal
 
foreclosure proceedings were in
process.
 
Troubled
 
Debt Restructurings (“TDRs”)
.
 
TDRs are loans in which the borrower is experiencing
 
financial difficulty and the
Company has granted an economic concession to the borrower
 
that it would not otherwise consider.
 
In these instances, as part of
a work-out alternative, the Company will make concessions
 
including the extension of the loan term, a principal moratorium,
 
a
reduction in the interest rate, or a combination thereof.
 
The impact of the TDR modifications and defaults are factored
 
into the
allowance for credit losses on a loan-by-loan basis.
 
Thus, specific reserves are established based upon the results of
 
either a
discounted cash flow analysis or the underlying collateral
 
value, if the loan is deemed to be collateral dependent.
 
A TDR
classification can be removed if the borrower’s
 
financial condition improves such that the borrower is no longer
 
in financial
difficulty,
 
the loan has not had any forgiveness of principal or interest,
 
and the loan is subsequently refinanced or restructured at
market terms and qualifies as a new loan.
 
At December 31, 2020, the Company had $
14.3
 
million in TDRs, of which $
13.9
 
million were performing in accordance with the
modified terms.
 
At December 31, 2019 the Company had $
17.6
 
million in TDRs, of which $
16.9
 
million were performing in
accordance with modified terms.
 
For TDRs, the Company estimated $
0.6
 
million and $
1.5
 
million of credit loss reserves at
December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively.
 
The modifications made to TDRs involved either an
 
extension of the loan term, a principal moratorium, a reduction in the interest
rate, or a combination thereof.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2020, there were
three
 
loans modified with a recorded
investment of $
0.2
 
million.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2019, there were
seven
 
loans modified with a recorded investment
of $
0.5
 
million.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2018, there were
six
 
loans modified with a recorded investment of $
0.7
million.
 
The financial impact of these modifications was not material.
 
 
For the years ended December 31, 2020 and December
 
31, 2019, there were
no
 
loans classified as TDRs, for which there was a
payment default and the loans were modified within
 
the 12 months prior to default.
 
Credit Risk Management
.
 
The Company has adopted comprehensive lending policies, underwriting
 
standards and loan review
procedures designed to maximize loan income within
 
an acceptable level of risk.
 
Management and the Board of Directors review
and approve these policies and procedures on a regular
 
basis (at least annually).
 
 
 
 
89
Reporting systems are used to monitor loan originations,
 
loan quality, concentrations
 
of credit, loan delinquencies and
nonperforming loans and potential problem loans.
 
Management and the Credit Risk Oversight Committee periodically
 
review
our lines of business to monitor asset quality trends
 
and the appropriateness of credit policies.
 
In addition, total borrower
exposure limits are established and concentration risk
 
is monitored.
 
As part of this process, the overall composition of the
portfolio is reviewed to gauge diversification of risk,
 
client concentrations, industry group, loan type, geographic
 
area, or other
relevant classifications of loans.
 
Specific segments of the loan portfolio are monitored
 
and reported to the Board on a quarterly
basis and have strategic plans in place to supplement
 
Board approved credit policies governing exposure limits and
 
underwriting
standards.
 
Detailed below are the types of loans within the Company’s
 
loan portfolio and risk characteristics unique to each.
 
 
Commercial, Financial, and Agricultural – Loans in
 
this category are primarily made based on identified cash flows of the
borrower with consideration given to underlying collateral
 
and personal or other guarantees.
 
Lending policy establishes debt
service coverage ratio limits that require a borrower’s
 
cash flow to be sufficient to cover principal and
 
interest payments on all
new and existing debt.
 
The majority of these loans are secured by the assets being
 
financed or other business assets such as
accounts receivable, inventory,
 
or equipment.
 
Collateral values are determined based upon third party appraisals and
 
evaluations.
 
Loan to value ratios at origination are governed by established
 
policy guidelines.
 
 
Real Estate Construction – Loans in this category
 
consist of short-term construction loans, revolving and non-revolving credit
lines and construction/permanent loans made to individuals and
 
investors to finance the acquisition, development, construction or
rehabilitation of real property.
 
These loans are primarily made based on identified cash
 
flows of the borrower or project and
generally secured by the property being financed, including
 
1-4 family residential properties and commercial properties
 
that are
either owner-occupied or investment in nature.
 
These properties may include either vacant or improved property.
 
Construction
loans are generally based upon estimates of costs and value
 
associated with the completed project.
 
Collateral values are
determined based upon third party appraisals and evaluations.
 
Loan to value ratios at origination are governed by established
policy guidelines.
 
The disbursement of funds for construction loans is made
 
in relation to the progress of the project and as such
these loans are closely monitored by on-site inspections.
 
 
Real Estate Commercial Mortgage – Loans in this category
 
consists of commercial mortgage loans secured by property
 
that is
either owner-occupied or investment in nature.
 
These loans are primarily made based on identified cash
 
flows of the borrower or
project with consideration given to underlying real
 
estate collateral and personal guarantees.
 
Lending policy establishes debt
service coverage ratios and loan to value ratios specific to
 
the property type.
 
Collateral values are determined based upon third
party appraisals and evaluations.
 
 
Real Estate Residential – Residential mortgage loans held
 
in the Company’s loan portfolio
 
are made to borrowers that
demonstrate the ability to make scheduled payments
 
with full consideration to underwriting factors such as current
 
income,
employment status, current assets, and other financial resources,
 
credit history,
 
and the value of the collateral.
 
Collateral consists
of mortgage liens on 1-4 family residential properties.
 
Collateral values are determined based upon third party
 
appraisals and
evaluations.
 
The Company does not originate sub-prime loans.
 
 
Real Estate Home Equity – Home equity loans and lines are made
 
to qualified individuals for legitimate purposes generally
secured by senior or junior mortgage liens on owner-occupied
 
1-4 family homes or vacation homes.
 
Borrower qualifications
include favorable credit history combined with supportive
 
income and debt ratio requirements and combined loan to value ratios
within established policy guidelines.
 
Collateral values are determined based upon third party appraisals and
 
evaluations.
 
 
Consumer Loans – This loan portfolio includes personal
 
installment loans, direct and indirect automobile financing, and
 
overdraft
lines of credit.
 
The majority of the consumer loan portfolio consists of indirect
 
and direct automobile loans.
 
Lending policy
establishes maximum debt to income ratios, minimum
 
credit scores, and includes guidelines for verification of applicants’ income
and receipt of credit reports.
 
Credit Quality Indicators
.
 
As part of the ongoing monitoring of the Company’s
 
loan portfolio quality,
 
management categorizes
loans into risk categories based on relevant information
 
about the ability of borrowers to service their debt such
 
as: current
financial information, historical payment performance,
 
credit documentation, and current economic and market trends,
 
among
other factors.
 
Risk ratings are assigned to each loan and revised as needed
 
through established monitoring procedures for
individual loan relationships over a predetermined
 
amount and review of smaller balance homogenous loan pools.
 
The Company
uses the definitions noted below for categorizing
 
and managing its criticized loans.
 
Loans categorized as “Pass” do not meet the
criteria set forth below and are not considered criticized.
 
Special Mention – Loans in this category are presently
 
protected from loss, but weaknesses are apparent which, if
 
not corrected,
could cause future problems.
 
Loans in this category may not meet required underwriting
 
criteria and have no mitigating
factors.
 
More than the ordinary amount of attention is warranted for these
 
loans.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
90
Substandard – Loans in this category exhibit well-defined
 
weaknesses that would typically bring normal repayment into
 
jeopardy.
These loans are no longer adequately protected due
 
to well-defined weaknesses that affect the repayment
 
capacity of the
borrower.
 
The possibility of loss is much more evident and above average
 
supervision is required for these loans.
 
Doubtful – Loans in this category have all the weaknesses inherent
 
in a loan categorized as Substandard, with the characteristic
that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full,
 
on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and
 
values, highly
questionable and improbable.
 
Performing/Nonperforming – Loans within certain
 
homogenous loan pools (home equity and consumer) are not
 
individually
reviewed, but are monitored for credit quality via the aging
 
status of the loan and by payment activity.
 
The performing or
nonperforming status is updated on an on-going basis dependent
 
upon improvement and deterioration in credit quality.
 
The following table summarizes gross loans held for
 
investment at December 31, 2020 by years of origination and
 
internally
assigned credit risk ratings (refer to Credit Risk Management
 
section for detail on risk rating system).
 
Term Loans by Origination Year
Revolving
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
2017
2016
Prior
Loans
Total
Commercial, Financial,
Agricultural:
Pass
$
231,805
$
45,651
$
35,866
$
15,212
$
13,321
$
10,051
$
41,214
$
393,120
Special Mention
-
4
28
-
-
58
-
90
Substandard
 
12
 
195
 
289
 
145
 
50
 
20
 
9
 
720
Total
$
231,817
$
45,850
$
36,183
$
15,357
$
13,371
$
10,129
$
41,223
$
393,930
Real Estate -
Construction:
Pass
$
71,173
$
51,634
$
7,369
$
1,592
$
-
$
-
$
2,635
$
134,403
Substandard
 
-
 
1,428
 
-
 
-
 
-
 
-
 
-
 
1,428
Total
$
71,173
$
53,062
$
7,369
$
1,592
$
-
$
-
$
2,635
$
135,831
Real Estate - Commercial
Mortgage:
Pass
$
156,011
$
93,424
$
131,180
$
78,474
$
45,507
$
88,397
$
19,933
$
612,926
Special Mention
4,165
8,932
9,249
244
379
6,172
397
29,538
Substandard
 
570
 
130
 
137
 
2,687
 
28
 
1,883
 
494
 
5,929
Total
$
160,746
$
102,486
$
140,566
$
81,405
$
45,914
$
96,452
$
20,824
$
648,393
Real Estate - Residential:
Pass
$
100,704
$
66,893
$
42,884
$
40,205
$
19,231
$
66,119
$
6,706
$
342,742
Special Mention
141
24
126
175
236
446
-
1,148
Substandard
 
1,257
 
1,800
 
1,377
 
837
 
890
 
2,492
 
-
 
8,653
Total
 
$
102,102
$
68,717
$
44,387
$
41,217
$
20,357
$
69,057
$
6,706
$
352,543
Real Estate - Home
Equity:
Performing
$
1,385
$
313
$
244
$
830
$
183
$
2,238
$
199,591
$
204,784
Nonperforming
-
-
-
-
-
-
695
695
Total
 
$
1,385
 
313
 
244
 
830
 
183
 
2,238
 
200,286
 
205,479
Consumer:
Performing
$
105,551
$
69,941
$
51,513
$
24,613
$
10,639
$
2,472
$
5,227
$
269,956
Nonperforming
61
109
49
-
8
67
-
294
Total
 
$
105,612
 
70,050
 
51,562
 
24,613
 
10,647
 
2,539
 
5,227
 
270,250
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
91
Note 4
MORTGAGE BANKING ACTIVITIES
 
Pursuant to the Brand acquisition on March 1, 2020,
 
the Company’s mortgage banking
 
activities at its subsidiary Capital City
Homes Loans have expanded to include mandatory
 
delivery loan sales, forward sales contracts used to manage
 
residential loan
pipeline price risk, utilization of warehouse lines to fund
 
secondary market residential loan closings, and residential mortgage
servicing.
 
Information provided below reflects CCHL activities post acquisition for
 
the period March 1, 2020 to December 31,
2020 and CCB legacy residential real estate activities for the
 
period January 1, 2020 to March 1, 2020.
 
 
Residential Mortgage Loan Production
 
The Company originates, markets, and services conventional
 
and government-sponsored residential mortgage
 
loans.
 
Generally,
conforming fixed rate residential mortgage loans are held
 
for sale in the secondary market and non-conforming and
 
adjustable-
rate residential mortgage loans may be held for investment.
 
The volume of residential mortgage loans originated
 
for sale and
secondary market prices are the primary drivers of origination
 
revenue.
 
Residential mortgage loan commitments are generally outstanding
 
for 30 to 90 days, which represents the typical period from
commitment to originate a residential mortgage loan to
 
when the closed loan is sold to an investor.
 
Residential mortgage loan
commitments are subject to both credit and price risk.
 
Credit risk is managed through underwriting policies and
 
procedures,
including collateral requirements, which are generally
 
accepted by the secondary loan markets.
 
Price risk is primarily related to
interest rate fluctuations and is partially managed through
 
forward sales of residential mortgage-backed securities (primarily
 
to-be
announced securities, or TBAs) or mandatory delivery commitments
 
with investors.
 
 
The unpaid principal balance of residential mortgage loans
 
held for sale, notional amounts of derivative contracts
 
related to
residential mortgage loan commitments and forward contract sales and
 
their related fair values are set forth below.
 
December 31, 2020
Unpaid Principal
(Dollars in Thousands)
Balance/Notional
Fair Value
Residential Mortgage Loans Held for Sale
$
109,831
$
114,039
Residential Mortgage Loan Commitments ("IRLCs")
(1)
147,494
4,825
Forward Sales Contracts
(2)
158,500
(907)
$
117,957
(1)
Recorded in other assets at fair value
(2)
Recorded in other liabilities at fair value
 
Residential mortgage loans held for sale that were
 
90 days or more outstanding or on nonaccrual totaled $
0.6
 
million at December
31, 2020.
 
 
Mortgage banking revenues for the year ended December
 
31, was as follows:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
Net realized gains on sales of mortgage loans
$
59,709
Net change in unrealized gain on mortgage loans held
 
for sale
2,926
Net change in the fair value of mortgage loan commitments
 
(IRLCs)
2,625
Net change in the fair value of forward sales contracts
284
Pair-Offs on net settlement of forward
 
sales contracts
(9,602)
Mortgage servicing rights additions
3,448
Net origination fees
3,954
Total mortgage
 
banking revenues
$
63,344
 
Residential Mortgage Servicing
 
 
The Company may retain the right to service residential
 
mortgage loans sold.
 
The unpaid principal balance of loans serviced for
others is the primary driver of servicing revenue.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
92
The following represents a summary of mortgage
 
servicing rights.
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
Number of residential mortgage loans serviced for others
1,796
Outstanding principal balance of residential mortgage
 
loans serviced for others
$
456,135
Weighted average
 
interest rate
3.64%
Remaining contractual term (in months)
321
 
Conforming conventional loans serviced by the Company
 
are sold to FNMA on a non-recourse basis, whereby foreclosure
 
losses
are generally the responsibility of FNMA and not the
 
Company.
 
The government loans serviced by the Company are secured
through GNMA, whereby the Company is insured
 
against loss by the Federal Housing Administration or partially guaranteed
against loss by the Veterans
 
Administration.
 
At December 31, 2020, the servicing portfolio balance consisted
 
of the following
loan types: FNMA (
63
%), GNMA (
13
%), and private investor (
24
%).
 
FNMA and private investor loans are structured as
actual/actual payment remittance.
 
At December 31, 2020, delinquent residential mortgage
 
loans currently in GNMA pools serviced by the Company totaled $
4.9
million.
 
The right to repurchase these loans and the corresponding liability
 
has been recorded in other assets and other liabilities,
respectively, in
 
the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition.
 
 
Activity in the capitalized mortgage servicing rights for the
 
year ended December 31, was as follows:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
Beginning balance
$
910
Additions due to loans sold with servicing retained
3,448
Deletions and amortization
(656)
Valuation
 
Provision (temporary impairment)
(250)
Ending balance
$
3,452
 
The Company had
no
 
permanent impairment losses on its mortgage servicing
 
rights for the year ended December 31, 2020.
 
 
At December 31, 2020, the key unobservable inputs used
 
in determining the fair value of the Company’s
 
mortgage servicing
rights were as follows:
 
Minimum
Maximum
Discount rates
11.00%
15.00%
Annual prepayment speeds
13.08%
23.64%
Cost of servicing (basis points)
90
110
 
Changes in residential mortgage interest rates directly
 
affect the prepayment speeds used in valuing the Company’s
 
mortgage
servicing rights.
 
A separate third party model is used to estimate prepayment speeds
 
based on interest rates, housing turnover
rates, estimated loan curtailment, anticipated defaults, and
 
other relevant factors.
 
The weighted average annual prepayment speed
was
17.10
% at December 31, 2020.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
93
Warehouse
 
Line Borrowings
 
The Company has the following warehouse lines of
 
credit and master repurchase agreements with various financial institutions
 
at
December 31, 2020.
 
 
Amounts
(Dollars in Thousands)
Outstanding
$
25
 
million warehouse line of credit agreement expiring
October 2021
.
 
Interest is at LIBOR plus
2.25%
, with a
floor rate of
3.50%
.
 
A cash pledge deposit of $
0.1
 
million is required by the lender.
$
11,256
$
50
 
million master repurchase agreement without defined expiration.
 
Interest is at the LIBOR plus
2.24%
 
to
3.00%
, with a floor rate of
3.25%
.
 
A cash pledge deposit of $
0.5
 
million is required by the lender.
39,985
$
50
 
million warehouse line of credit agreement expiring in
September 2021
.
 
Interest is at the LIBOR plus
2.75%
.
23,541
$
74,782
 
Warehouse
 
line borrowings are classified as short-term borrowings.
 
At December 31, 2020, the Company had mortgage loans
held for sale pledged as collateral under the above
 
warehouse lines of credit and master repurchase agreements.
 
The above
agreements also contain covenants which include
 
certain financial requirements, including maintenance of minimum
 
tangible net
worth, minimum liquid assets, maximum debt to
 
net worth ratio and positive net income, as defined in the agreements.
 
The
Company was in compliance with all significant debt
 
covenants at December 31, 2020.
 
 
The Company intends to renew the warehouse lines of
 
credit and master repurchase agreements when they mature
 
.
 
The Company has extended a $
50
 
million warehouse line of credit to CCHL, a
51
% owned subsidiary entity.
 
Balances and
transactions under this line of credit are eliminated
 
in the Company’s consolidated
 
financial statements and thus not included in
the total short term borrowings noted on the consolidated
 
statement of financial condition.
 
The balance of this line of credit at
December 31, 2020 was $
30.0
 
million.
 
Note 5
DERIVATIVES
 
 
The Company enters into derivative financial instruments to manage
 
exposures that arise from business activities that result in the
receipt or payment of future known and uncertain cash
 
amounts, the value of which are determined by interest rates.
 
The
Company’s derivative
 
financial instruments are used to manage differences
 
in the amount, timing, and duration of the Company’s
known or expected cash receipts and its known
 
or expected cash payments principally related to the Company’s
 
subordinated
debt.
 
 
Cash Flow Hedges of Interest Rate Risk
 
Interest rate swaps with notional amounts totaling
 
$
30
 
million at December 31, 2020 were designed as a cash
 
flow hedge for
subordinated debt.
 
Under the swap arrangement, the Company will pay a
 
fixed interest rate of
2.50
% and receive a variable
interest rate based on three-month LIBOR plus a weighted
 
average margin of
1.83
%.
 
For derivatives designated and that qualify as cash
 
flow hedges of interest rate risk, the gain or loss on the
 
derivative is recorded
in accumulated other comprehensive income (“AOCI”)
 
and subsequently reclassified into interest expense in the same
 
period(s)
during which the hedged transaction affects earnings.
 
Amounts reported in accumulated other comprehensive income
 
related to
derivatives will be reclassified to interest expense as
 
interest payments are made on the Company’s
 
variable-rate subordinated
debt.
 
The following table reflects the cash flow hedges included
 
in the consolidated statements of financial condition at
 
December 31,
2020.
 
Notional
Fair
 
Balance Sheet
Weighted Ave
 
rage
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Amount
Value
Location
 
Maturity (Years)
Interest rate swaps related to subordinated debt
$
30,000
$
574
Other Assets
9.5
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
94
The following table presents the net gains (losses) recorded
 
in accumulated other comprehensive income and the
 
consolidated
statements of income related to the cash flow derivative
 
instruments (interest rate swaps related to subordinated debt) for the
 
year
ended December 31, 2020.
 
Amount of Gain
Amount of Gain
(Loss) Recognized
(Loss) Reclassified
(Dollars in Thousands)
in AOCI
Category
from AOCI to Income
December 31, 2020
$
428
 
Interest Expense
$
(64)
 
The Company estimates there will be approximately
 
$
0.1
 
million reclassified as an increase to interest expense within
 
the next 12
months.
 
At December 31, 2020, the Company had a collateral
 
liability of $
0.5
 
million.
 
Note 6
PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT
 
 
The composition of the Company's premises and equipment
 
at December 31 was as follows:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
Land
$
23,744
$
23,594
Buildings
114,306
110,774
Fixtures and Equipment
55,916
47,814
Total
193,966
182,182
Accumulated Depreciation
(107,175)
(97,639)
Premises and Equipment, Net
$
86,791
$
84,543
 
Depreciation expense for the above premises and equipment
 
was approximately $
7.0
 
million, $
6.3
 
million, and $
6.5
 
million in
2020, 2019, and 2018, respectively
.
 
Note 7
LEASES
 
Operating leases in which the Company is the lessee are
 
recorded as operating lease right of use (“ROU”) assets and operating
liabilities, included in other assets and
liabilities
, respectively,
 
on its consolidated statement of financial condition.
 
 
Operating lease ROU assets represent the Company’s
 
right to use an underlying asset during the lease term
 
and operating lease
liabilities represent the Company’s
 
obligation to make lease payments arising from the lease.
 
ROU assets and operating lease
liabilities are recognized at lease commencement based
 
on the present value of the remaining lease payments using a
 
discount rate
that represents the Company’s
 
incremental borrowing rate at the lease commencement
 
date.
 
Operating lease expense, which is
comprised of amortization of the ROU asset and the implicit
 
interest accreted on the operating lease liability,
 
is recognized on a
straight-line basis over the lease term, and is recorded
 
in occupancy expense in the consolidated statement of income.
 
 
The Company’s operating
 
leases primarily relate to banking offices with remaining
 
lease terms from
one
 
to
forty-five years
.
 
The
Company’s leases are not
 
complex and do not contain residual value guarantees, variable lease
 
payments, or significant
assumptions or judgments made in applying the requirements
 
of Topic
 
842.
 
Operating leases with an initial term of 12 months or
less are not recorded on the consolidated statements of
 
financial condition and the related lease expense is recognized
 
on a
straight-line basis over the lease term.
 
At December 31, 2020 ROU assets and liabilities were $
12.0
 
million and $
12.8
 
million,
respectively.
 
At December 31, 2019, the operating lease ROU assets and liabilities were
 
$
1.7
 
million and $
2.5
 
million,
respectively.
 
The Company does not have any finance leases or any significant
 
lessor agreements.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
95
The table below summarizes our lease expense and other
 
information at December 31, related to the Company’s
 
operating leases:
 
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
Operating lease expense
$
1,018
$
325
Short-term lease expense
530
120
Total lease expense
$
1,548
$
445
Other information:
Cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities:
Operating cash flows from operating leases
$
1,174
$
331
Right-of-use assets obtained in exchange for new operating lease liabilities
11,101
1,739
Weighted-average
 
remaining lease term — operating leases (in years)
25.4
6.8
Weighted-average
 
discount rate — operating leases
2.1
%
2.9
%
 
The table below summarizes the maturity of remaining
 
lease liabilities:
(Dollars in Thousands)
December 31, 2020
2021
$
1,530
2022
1,374
2023
980
2024
930
2025
756
2026 and thereafter
11,129
Total
$
16,699
Less: Interest
(3,899)
Present value of lease liability
$
12,800
 
At December 31, 2020, the Company had two additional operating lease obligations for banking offices (to be constructed) that
have not yet commenced.
 
The first lease has payments totaling $
1.9
 
million based on the initial contract term of
15
 
years and the
second lease has payments totaling $
2.9
 
million based on the initial contract term of
15
 
years.
 
Payments for the banking offices
are expected to commence after the construction periods
 
end, which are expected to occur during the fourth quarter of 2021
 
and
first quarter of 2022, respectively.
 
 
A related party is the lessor in an operating lease with
 
the Company.
 
The Company’s minimum
 
payment is $
0.2
 
million annually
through 2024, for an aggregate remaining obligation of
 
$
0.8
 
million at December 31, 2020.
 
Note 8
GOODWILL
 
 
At December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2019, the Company
 
had goodwill of $
89.1
 
million and $
84.8
 
million, respectively.
 
Goodwill is tested for impairment on an annual basis, or
 
more often if impairment indicators exist.
 
Testing allows for
 
a
qualitative assessment of goodwill impairment indicators.
 
If the assessment indicates that impairment has more
 
than likely
occurred, the Company must compare the estimated fair
 
value of the reporting unit to its carrying amount.
 
If the carrying amount
of the reporting unit exceeds its estimated fair value,
 
an impairment charge is recorded equal to the excess.
 
On March 1, 2020, CCB completed its acquisition of
 
a
51
% membership interest in
Brand Mortgage Group, LLC
 
(“Brand”),
which is now operated as Capital City Home Loans (“CCHL”).
 
See Note 1 – Significant Accounting Policies/Business
Combination for additional information.
 
CCB made a $
7.1
 
million cash payment for its 51% membership interest and
 
recorded
goodwill totaling $
4.3
 
million in connection with this acquisition.
 
 
During the fourth quarter of 2020, the Company performed
 
its annual goodwill impairment testing and determined
 
that
no
goodwill impairment existed at December 31, 2020.
 
The Company will continue to evaluate goodwill for impairment
 
as defined
by ASC Topic
 
350.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
96
Note 9
OTHER REAL ESTATE
 
OWNED
 
The following table presents other real estate owned
 
activity at December 31,
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
Beginning Balance
$
953
$
2,229
$
3,941
Additions
2,297
1,298
2,140
Valuation
 
Write-Downs
(792)
(300)
(1,046)
Sales
(1,650)
(2,274)
(2,793)
Other
-
-
(13)
Ending Balance
$
808
$
953
$
2,229
 
Net expenses applicable to other real estate owned for the
 
three years ended December 31, was as follows:
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
Gains from the Sale of Properties
$
(1,218)
$
(244)
$
(2,288)
Losses from the Sale of Properties
33
159
307
Rental Income from Properties
-
(4)
(12)
Property Carrying Costs
497
335
505
Valuation
 
Adjustments
792
300
1,046
Total
$
104
$
546
$
(442)
 
Note 10
DEPOSITS
 
 
The composition of the Company's interest bearing deposits at December
 
31 was as follows:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
NOW Accounts
$
1,046,408
$
902,499
Money Market Accounts
266,649
217,839
Savings Deposits
474,100
374,396
Time Deposits
101,594
106,021
Total Interest Bearing
 
Deposits
$
1,888,751
$
1,600,755
 
At December 31, 2020 and 2019, $
0.7
 
million and $
1.6
 
million, respectively,
 
in overdrawn deposit accounts were reclassified as
loans.
 
Time deposits that meet or exceed the
 
FDIC insurance limit of $250,000 totaled $
8.5
 
million and $
7.0
 
million at December 31,
2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively.
 
At December 31, the scheduled maturities of time
 
deposits were as follows:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2021
$
83,989
2022
10,282
2023
3,812
2024
1,674
2025 and thereafter
1,837
Total
$
101,594
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
97
Interest expense on deposits for the three years ended
 
December 31, was as follows:
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
NOW Accounts
$
930
$
5,502
$
3,152
Money Market Accounts
223
946
675
Savings Deposits
207
182
172
Time Deposits < $250,000
179
201
234
Time Deposits > $250,000
9
9
10
Total
$
1,548
$
6,840
$
4,243
 
Note 11
SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS
 
 
Short-term borrowings included the following:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Federal Funds
Purchased
Securities
 
Sold Under
Repurchase
Agreements
(1)
Other
 
Short-Term
Borrowings
(2)
2020
Balance at December 31
$
-
$
4,851
$
74,803
Maximum indebtedness at any month end
-
5,922
94,071
Daily average indebtedness outstanding
2
5,384
63,733
Average rate
 
paid for the year
2.56
%
0.10
%
4.36
%
Average rate
 
paid on period-end borrowings
-
%
0.04
%
3.00
%
2019
Balance at December 31
$
-
$
6,065
$
339
Maximum indebtedness at any month end
-
9,141
3,746
Daily average indebtedness outstanding
47
6,180
3,047
Average rate
 
paid for the year
2.85
%
0.91
%
1.73
%
Average rate
 
paid on period-end borrowings
-
%
0.46
%
4.11
%
2018
Balance at December 31
$
-
$
10,092
$
3,449
Maximum indebtedness at any month end
-
10,092
10,044
Daily average indebtedness outstanding
20
7,951
3,021
Average rate
 
paid for the year
2.41
%
0.49
%
2.31
%
Average rate
 
paid on period-end borrowings
-
%
0.88
%
1.61
%
(1)
Balances are fully collateralized by government treasury or agency securities held in the Company's investment portfolio.
(2)
Comprised of FHLB advances totaling $
0.1
 
million and warehouse lines of credit totaling $
74.8
 
million at December 31, 2020.
 
Note 12
LONG-TERM BORROWINGS
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank Advances.
 
FHLB long-term advances totaled $
2.2
 
million at December 31, 2020 and $
5.0
 
million at
December 31, 2019.
 
The advances mature at varying dates from 2022 through 2025 and had a weighted-average rate of 3.47%
and 3.13% at December 31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
 
The FHLB advances are collateralized by a blanket floating
 
lien on all
1-4 family residential mortgage loans, commercial real
 
estate mortgage loans, and home equity mortgage loans.
 
Interest on the
FHLB advances is paid on a monthly basis.
 
Note Payable.
 
Long-term note payable totaled $
0.9
 
million at December 31, 2020 and $
1.5
 
million at December 31, 2019.
 
The
note matures on
March 30, 2027
.
 
Interest is payable
quarterly
 
on the note equal to the prime interest rate which is adjusted
quarterly.
 
A principal payment of $
0.3
 
million is required on an annual basis.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
98
Scheduled minimum future principal payments on our
 
other long-term borrowings at December 31 were as follows:
 
 
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2021
$
1,008
2022
1,170
2023
553
2024
210
2025
116
Total
$
3,057
 
Junior Subordinated Deferrable Interest
 
Notes.
 
The Company has issued two junior subordinated deferrable
 
interest notes to
wholly owned Delaware statutory trusts.
 
The first note for $
30.9
 
million was issued to CCBG Capital Trust I.
 
The second note
for $
32.0
 
million was issued to CCBG Capital Trust II.
 
The two trusts are considered variable interest entities for which
 
the
Company is not the primary beneficiary.
 
Accordingly, the accounts
 
of the trusts are not included in the Company’s
 
consolidated
financial statements. See Note 1 - Significant Accounting
 
Policies for additional information about the Company’s
 
consolidation
policy.
 
Details of the Company’s transaction
 
with the two trusts are provided below.
 
In November 2004, CCBG Capital Trust
 
I issued $
30.0
 
million of trust preferred securities which represent interest in the assets
of the trust.
 
The interest payments are due quarterly at
3-month LIBOR
 
plus a margin of
1.90
%, adjusted quarterly.
 
The trust
preferred securities will mature on
December 31, 2034
, and are redeemable upon approval of the Federal Reserve in
 
whole or in
part at the option of the Company at any time after
 
December 31, 2009 and in whole at any time upon occurrence
 
of certain
events affecting their tax or regulatory
 
capital treatment. Distributions on the trust preferred securities are
 
payable quarterly on
March 31, June 30, September 30, and December 31 of
 
each year.
 
CCBG Capital Trust I also issued $
928,000
 
of common equity
securities to CCBG.
 
The proceeds of the offering of trust preferred
 
securities and common equity securities were used to
purchase a $
30.9
 
million junior subordinated deferrable interest note issued by the
 
Company, which has terms similar
 
to the trust
preferred securities.
 
On April 12, 2016, the Company retired $
10
 
million in face value of trust preferred securities that were
auctioned as part of a liquidation of a pooled collateralized
 
debt obligation fund.
 
The trust preferred securities were originally
issued through CCBG Capital Trust
 
I.
 
In May 2005, CCBG Capital Trust
 
II issued $
31.0
 
million of trust preferred securities which represent interest in
 
the assets of the
trust.
 
The interest payments are due quarterly at
3-month LIBOR
 
plus a margin of
1.80
%, adjusted quarterly.
 
The trust preferred
securities will mature on
June 15, 2035
, and are redeemable upon approval of the Federal Reserve in whole
 
or in part at the option
of the Company and in whole at any time upon occurrence
 
of certain events affecting their tax or regulatory capital
 
treatment.
 
Distributions on the trust preferred securities are payable
 
quarterly on March 15, June 15, September 15, and December 15
 
of
each year.
 
CCBG Capital Trust II also issued $
959,000
 
of common equity securities to CCBG.
 
The proceeds of the offering of
trust preferred securities and common equity securities were
 
used to purchase a $
32.0
 
million junior subordinated deferrable
interest note issued by the Company,
 
which has terms substantially similar to the trust preferred
 
securities.
 
 
The Company has the right to defer payments of interest
 
on the two notes at any time or from time to time for a
 
period of up to
twenty consecutive quarterly interest payment periods.
 
Under the terms of each note, in the event that under certain
circumstances there is an event of default under the
 
note or the Company has elected to defer interest on the note, the
 
Company
may not, with certain exceptions, declare or pay any dividends
 
or distributions on its capital stock or purchase or acquire any
 
of
its capital stock.
 
At December 31, 2020, the Company has paid all interest payments
 
in full.
 
 
The Company has entered into agreements to guarantee
 
the payments of distributions on the trust preferred securities and
payments of redemption of the trust preferred securities.
 
Under these agreements, the Company also agrees, on a subordinated
basis, to pay expenses and liabilities of the two trusts other
 
than those arising under the trust preferred securities.
 
The obligations
of the Company under the two junior subordinated notes, the trust
 
agreements establishing the two trusts, the guarantee and
agreement as to expenses and liabilities, in aggregate,
 
constitute a full and unconditional guarantee
 
by the Company of the two
trusts' obligations under the two trust preferred security issuances.
 
Despite the fact that the accounts of CCBG Capital Trust
 
I and CCBG Capital Trust II are
 
not included in the Company’s
consolidated financial statements, the $
20.0
 
million and $
31.0
 
million, respectively,
 
in trust preferred securities issued by these
subsidiary trusts are included in the Tier
 
1 Capital of Capital City Bank Group, Inc. as allowed by
 
Federal Reserve guidelines.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
99
Note 13
 
INCOME TAXES
 
 
The provision for income taxes reflected in the statements
 
of comprehensive income is comprised of the following components:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
Current:
Federal
$
8,625
$
8,481
$
(1,617)
State
1,658
247
201
10,283
8,728
(1,416)
Deferred:
Federal
(143)
(680)
3,620
State
130
1,913
1,285
Change in Valuation
 
Allowance
(40)
(8)
(68)
(53)
1,225
4,837
Total:
Federal
8,482
7,801
2,003
State
1,788
2,160
1,486
Change in Valuation
 
Allowance
(40)
(8)
(68)
Total
$
10,230
$
9,953
$
3,421
 
Income taxes provided were different than the
 
tax expense computed by applying the statutory federal income
 
tax rate of
21
% to
pre-tax income as a result of the following:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
Tax Expense at Federal
 
Statutory Rate
$
11,106
$
8,560
$
6,225
Increases (Decreases) Resulting From:
Tax-Exempt Interest
 
Income
(341)
(425)
(494)
2017 Provision to Return - Impact of Federal Tax
 
Reform
-
-
(3,590)
State Taxes, Net of
 
Federal Benefit
1,413
1,342
1,174
Other
601
294
348
Change in Valuation
 
Allowance
(40)
(8)
(68)
Tax-Exempt Cash
 
Surrender Value
 
Life Insurance Benefit
(173)
(175)
(174)
Expense Due to Reduction of Florida Corporate Income Tax
 
Rate
-
365
-
Noncontrolling Interest
(2,336)
-
-
Actual Tax Expense
$
10,230
$
9,953
$
3,421
 
In connection with filing its 2017 income tax returns,
 
the Company recorded a permanent net income tax benefit of
 
$
3.6
 
million.
 
This benefit was a result of deductions claimed on the
 
Company's 2017 income tax returns partially offset by repricing
 
of its
current and deferred income tax position associated
 
with the Tax Cuts and
 
Jobs Act of 2017.
 
Deferred income tax liabilities and assets result from
 
differences between assets and liabilities measured for
 
financial reporting
purposes and for income tax return purposes.
 
These assets and liabilities are measured using the enacted tax
 
rates and laws that
are currently in effect.
 
The net deferred tax asset and the temporary differences
 
comprising that balance at December 31, 2020
and 2019 are as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
100
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
Deferred Tax Assets Attributable
 
to:
Allowance for Loan Losses
$
6,037
$
3,525
Accrued Pension/SERP
16,052
9,863
State Net Operating Loss and Tax
 
Credit Carry-Forwards
2,335
2,834
Other Real Estate Owned
1,066
957
Accrued SERP Liability
2,104
2,094
Lease Liability
2,581
637
Other
2,637
2,485
Total Deferred
 
Tax Assets
$
32,812
$
22,395
Deferred Tax Liabilities
 
Attributable to:
Depreciation on Premises and Equipment
$
4,408
$
3,870
Deferred Loan Fees and Costs
2,824
2,445
Intangible Assets
3,290
3,290
Accrued Pension Liability
4,723
4,585
Right of Use Asset
2,411
441
Investments
469
469
Other
1,165
284
Total Deferred
 
Tax Liabilities
19,290
15,384
Valuation
 
Allowance
1,640
1,680
Net Deferred Tax
 
Asset
$
11,882
$
5,331
 
In the opinion of management, it is more likely than not
 
that all of the deferred tax assets, with the exception of certain
 
state net
operating loss carry-forwards and certain state tax credit
 
carry-forwards expected to expire prior to utilization, will be
 
realized.
 
Accordingly, a
 
valuation allowance of $
1.6
 
million is recorded at December 31, 2020.
 
At December 31, 2020, the Company had
state loss and tax credit carry-forwards of approximately $
2.3
 
million, which expire at various dates from
2021
 
through
2040
.
 
The Company had no unrecognized tax benefits at December
 
31, 2020, December 31, 2019, and December 31, 2018.
 
It is the Company’s
 
policy to recognize interest and penalties accrued relative to unrecognized
 
tax benefits in their respective
federal or state income taxes accounts.
 
There were
no
 
penalties and interest related to income taxes recorded in the consolidated
statements of income for the years ended December 31,
 
2020, 2019, and 2018.
 
There were no amounts accrued in the
consolidated statements of financial condition for penalties
 
and interest as of December 31, 2020 and 2019.
 
The Company and its subsidiaries file a consolidated U.S.
 
federal income tax return, as well as file various returns in states where
its banking offices are located.
 
The Company is no longer subject to U.S. federal or
 
state tax examinations for years before 2017.
 
Note 14
STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION
 
 
At December 31, 2020, the Company had three stock-based
 
compensation plans, consisting of the 2011
 
Associate Incentive Plan
(“AIP”), the 2011 Associate Stock
 
Purchase Plan (“ASPP”), and the 2011
 
Director Stock Purchase Plan (“DSPP”).
 
These plans,
which were approved by the shareowners in April 2011,
 
replaced substantially similar plans approved by the
 
shareowners in
2004.
 
Total compensation
 
expense associated with these plans for 2018 through 2020 was $
1.9
 
million, $
2.2
 
million, and $
1.6
million, respectively.
 
 
AIP.
 
The AIP allows the Company's Board of Directors to award
 
key associates various forms of equity-based incentive
compensation.
 
Under the 2011 AIP there were
875,000
 
shares reserved for issuance.
 
On an annual basis, the Company,
 
pursuant
to the terms and conditions of the AIP,
 
will create an annual incentive plan (“Plan”),
 
under which all participants are eligible to
earn performance shares.
 
Awards under
 
the 2020 Plan were tied to internally established performance
 
goals.
 
At base level
targets, the grant-date fair value of the shares eligible
 
to be awarded in 2020 was approximately $
0.9
 
million.
 
Approximately
60
% of the award is in the form of stock and
40
% in the form of a cash bonus.
 
For 2020 a total of
20,230
 
shares were eligible for
issuance, but additional shares could be earned if performance
 
exceeded established goals.
 
A total of
21,682
 
shares were earned
for 2020.
 
The Company recognized expense of $
1.0
 
million, $
0.9
 
million, and $
1.1
 
million for years ended 2020, 2019 and 2018,
respectively related to the AIP.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
101
Executive Long-Term
 
Incentive Plan (“LTIP”)
.
 
In 2007, the Company established a Performance Share
 
Unit Plan under the
provisions of the AIP that allows William
 
G. Smith, Jr., the Chairman,
 
President, and Chief Executive Officer of CCBG, Inc.
 
to
earn shares based on the compound annual growth rate
 
in diluted earnings per share over a three-year period.
 
At December 31,
2020, there were three LTIP
 
agreements in place for the years 2018-2020.
 
The Company recognized $
0.2
 
million, $
0.6
 
million,
and $
0.3
 
million in expense for years 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively,
 
under these LTIP
 
agreements.
 
In addition, the Company
entered into similar LTIP
 
agreements with Thomas A. Barron, the President of CCB for
 
the years 2018-2020 that allows shares to
be earned based on the compound annual growth
 
rate in diluted earnings per share over a three-year period.
 
At December 31,
2020, there were three LTIP
 
agreements in place for the years 2018-2020.
 
The Company recognized $
0.1
 
million, $
0.2
, and $
0.2
million in expense for years 2020, 2019 and 2018,
 
respectively.
 
Shares issued under Mr.
 
Barron’s LTIP
 
plans were
7,218
 
in
2020,
10,460
 
in 2017 and
9,810
 
in 2018.
 
The Company also entered into a similar agreement with J. Kimbrough
 
Davis, Chief
Financial Officer of the Company for the
 
years 2018-2020 that allows shares to be earned based on
 
the compound annual growth
rate in diluted earnings per share.
 
The Company recognized $
0.1
 
million, $
0.4
 
million, and $
0.2
 
million in expense for the years
ended 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively,
 
under this agreement.
 
Shares issued under Mr.
 
Davis’s LTIP
 
plan were
7,218
 
in 2020,
4,812
 
in 2019 and
2,406
 
in 2018.
 
 
After deducting the shares earned in 2020 under the
 
AIP and LTIP,
299,344
 
shares remain eligible for issuance under the 2011
AIP.
 
DSPP.
 
The Company’s DSPP allows the
 
directors to purchase the Company’s
 
common stock at a price equal to
90
% of the
closing price on the date of purchase.
 
Stock purchases under the DSPP are limited to the amount of the
 
directors' annual retainer
and meeting fees.
 
Under the 2011 DSPP there were
150,000
 
shares reserved for issuance.
 
For 2020, the Company issued
16,119
shares and recognized approximately $
36,000
 
in expense under the DSPP.
 
For 2019, the Company issued
15,332
 
shares and
recognized approximately $
38,000
 
in expense under the DSPP.
 
For 2018, the Company issued
14,470
 
shares under the DSPP and
recognized approximately $
35,000
 
in expense related to this plan.
 
At December 31, 2020, there are
2,459
 
shares eligible for
issuance under the 2011 DSPP.
 
ASPP.
 
Under the Company’s ASPP,
 
substantially all associates may purchase the Company’s
 
common stock through payroll
deductions at a price equal to
90
% of the lower of the fair market value at the beginning or end
 
of each six-month offering
period.
 
Stock purchases under the ASPP are limited to
10
% of an associate's eligible compensation, up to a maximum
 
of $
25,000
(fair market value on each enrollment date) in any
 
plan year.
 
Under the 2011 ASPP there were
593,750
 
shares of common stock
reserved for issuance.
 
For 2020,
33,910
 
shares were acquired and approximately $
160,000
 
in expense was recognized under the
ASPP.
 
For 2019,
27,304
 
shares were acquired and approximately $
100,000
 
in expense was recognized under the ASPP.
 
For
2018,
19,503
 
shares were acquired under the ASPP and approximately
 
$
70,000
 
in expense was recognized related to this plan.
 
At
December 31, 2020,
242,859
 
shares remained eligible for issuance under the ASPP.
 
Based on the Black-Scholes option pricing model, the
 
weighted average estimated fair value of each of the purchase
 
rights
granted under the ASPP was $
5.83
 
for 2020.
 
For 2019 and 2018, the weighted average fair value purchase right
 
granted was
$
3.61
 
and $
3.57
, respectively.
 
In calculating compensation, the fair value of each stock
 
purchase right was estimated on the date
of grant using the following weighted average assumptions:
 
2020
2019
2018
Dividend yield
2.4
%
2.0
%
1.4
%
Expected volatility
45.6
%
17.4
%
18.7
%
Risk-free interest rate
0.9
%
2.3
%
1.8
%
Expected life (in years)
0.5
0.5
0.5
 
Note 15
EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
 
 
Pension Plan
 
 
The Company sponsors a noncontributory pension
 
plan covering substantially all of its associates.
 
Benefits under this plan
generally are based on the associate's total years of service
 
and average of the five highest years of compensation
 
during the ten
years immediately preceding their departure.
 
The Company’s general funding
 
policy is to contribute amounts sufficient to meet
minimum funding requirements as set by law and to
 
ensure deductibility for federal income tax purposes.
 
On December 30,
2019,
 
the plan was amended to remove plan eligibility for new associates hired
 
after December 31, 2019.
 
 
The following table details on a consolidated basis the
 
changes in benefit obligation, changes in plan assets, the funded
 
status of
the plan, components of pension expense, amounts recognized
 
in the Company's consolidated statements of financial
 
condition,
and major assumptions used to determine these amounts.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
102
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
Change in Projected Benefit Obligation:
Benefit Obligation at Beginning of Year
$
180,830
$
149,347
$
165,084
Service Cost
5,828
6,114
6,884
Interest Cost
5,612
6,178
5,661
Actuarial Loss (Gain)
 
32,172
25,715
(16,349)
Benefits Paid
(11,677)
(6,255)
(11,686)
Expenses Paid
(260)
(269)
(247)
Special/Contractual Termination
 
Benefits
61
-
-
Projected Benefit Obligation at End of Year
$
212,566
$
180,830
$
149,347
Change in Plan Assets:
Fair Value
 
of Plan Assets at Beginning of Year
$
161,646
$
134,535
$
129,719
Actual Return (Loss) on Plan Assets
17,066
28,635
(6,251)
Employer Contributions
5,000
5,000
23,000
Benefits Paid
(11,677)
(6,255)
(11,686)
Expenses Paid
(260)
(269)
(247)
Fair Value
 
of Plan Assets at End of Year
$
171,775
$
161,646
$
134,535
Funded Status of Plan and Accrued Liability Recognized
 
at End of Year:
Other Liabilities
$
40,791
$
19,184
$
14,812
Accumulated Benefit Obligation at End of Year
$
177,362
$
156,327
$
130,477
Components of Net Periodic Benefit Costs:
Service Cost
$
5,828
$
6,114
$
6,884
Interest Cost
5,612
6,178
5,661
Expected Return on Plan Assets
(10,993)
(9,527)
(9,564)
Amortization of Prior Service Costs
15
15
199
Special/Contractual Termination
 
Benefits
61
-
-
Net Loss Amortization
3,933
3,862
3,673
Net Periodic Benefit Cost
$
4,456
$
6,642
$
6,853
Weighted-Average
 
Assumptions Used to Determine Benefit Obligation:
Discount Rate
2.88%
3.53%
4.43%
Rate of Compensation Increase
(1)
4.00%
4.00%
4.00%
Measurement Date
12/31/20
12/31/19
12/31/18
Weighted-Average
 
Assumptions Used to Determine Benefit Cost:
Discount Rate
3.53%
4.43%
3.71%
Expected Return on Plan Assets
7.00%
7.25%
7.25%
Rate of Compensation Increase
(1)
4.00%
4.00%
3.25%
Amortization Amounts from Accumulated Other Comprehensive
 
Income:
Net Actuarial Loss (Gain)
 
$
26,098
$
6,606
$
(533)
Prior Service Cost
(15)
(15)
(199)
Net Loss
(3,933)
(3,862)
(3,673)
Deferred Tax (Benefit)
 
Expense
 
(5,615)
(694)
1,118
Other Comprehensive Loss (Gain), net of tax
$
16,535
$
2,035
$
(3,287)
Amounts Recognized in Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income:
Net Actuarial Losses
$
59,400
$
37,235
$
34,491
Prior Service Cost
35
50
66
Deferred Tax Benefit
(15,066)
(9,451)
(8,757)
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss, net of tax
$
44,369
$
27,834
$
25,800
(1)
 
The Company utilized an age-graded approach that
 
varies the rate based on the age of the participants.
 
The service cost component of net periodic benefit cost is reflected
 
in compensation expense in the accompanying statements of
income.
 
The other components of net periodic cost are included in “other”
 
within the noninterest expense category in the
statements of income.
 
See Note 1 – Significant Accounting Policies for additional information.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
103
 
The Company expects to recognize $
6.8
 
million of the net actuarial loss reflected in accumulated other
 
comprehensive income at
December 31, 2020 as a component of net periodic
 
benefit cost during 2021.
 
Plan Assets.
The Company’s pension
 
plan asset allocation at December 31, 2020 and 2019, and
 
the target asset allocation for
2020 are as follows:
Target
Percentage of Plan
Allocation
Assets at December 31
(1)
2021
2020
2019
Equity Securities
65
%
71
%
72
%
Debt Securities
30
%
21
%
19
%
Cash and Cash Equivalents
5
%
8
%
9
%
Total
100
%
100
%
100
%
 
(1)
Represents asset allocation at December 31
 
which may differ from the average target
 
allocation for the year due to the year-
end cash contribution to the plan.
 
 
The Company’s pension
 
plan assets are overseen by the CCBG Retirement Committee.
 
Capital City Trust Company acts as the
investment manager for the plan.
 
The investment strategy is to maximize return on investments while
 
minimizing risk.
 
The
Company believes the best way to accomplish this goal
 
is to take a conservative approach to its investment strategy by
 
investing
in mutual funds that include various high-grade equity
 
securities and investment-grade debt issuances with varying
 
investment
strategies.
 
The target asset allocation will periodically be
 
adjusted based on market conditions and will operate within the
following investment policy statement allocation ranges: equity
 
securities ranging from
55
% and
81
%, debt securities ranging
from
17
% and
37
%, and cash and cash equivalents ranging from
0
% and
10
%.
 
The overall expected long-term rate of return on
assets is a weighted-average expectation for the
 
return on plan assets.
 
The Company considers historical performance
 
data and
economic/financial data to arrive at expected long-term
 
rates of return for each asset category.
 
The major categories of assets in the Company’s
 
pension plan at December 31 are presented in the following
 
table.
 
Assets are
segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within
 
the fair value hierarchy established by ASC Topic
 
820 utilized to measure
fair value (see Note 22 – Fair Value
 
Measurements).
 
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
Level 1:
U.S. Treasury Securities
$
405
$
907
Mutual Funds
155,192
142,127
Cash and Cash Equivalents
12,789
13,943
Level 2:
U.S. Government Agency
1,555
2,078
Corporate Notes/Bonds
1,834
2,591
Total Fair Value
 
of Plan Assets
$
171,775
$
161,646
 
Expected Benefit Payments.
 
At December 31, expected benefit payments related to the
 
defined benefit pension plan were as
follows:
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2021
$
16,187
2022
15,728
2023
15,280
2024
15,208
2025
14,818
2026 through 2030
61,861
Total
$
139,082
 
 
104
Contributions.
 
The following table details the amounts contributed to the pension
 
plan in 2020 and 2019, and the expected
amount to be contributed in 2021.
 
Expected
Contribution
(Dollars in Thousands)
2019
2020
2021
(1)
Actual Contributions
$
5,000
$
5,000
$
5,000
 
(1)
 
For 2021, the Company will have the option to make
 
a cash contribution to the plan or utilize pre-funding
 
balances.
 
 
Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan
 
 
The Company has a Supplemental Executive Retirement
 
Plan (“SERP”) and a Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan II
(“SERP II”) covering selected executive officers.
 
Benefits under this plan generally are based on the same service
 
and
compensation as used for the pension plan, except the benefits are
 
calculated without regard to the limits set by the
 
Internal
Revenue Code on compensation and benefits.
 
The net benefit payable
 
from the SERP is the difference between this gross benefit
and the benefit payable by the pension plan.
 
The SERP II was adopted by the Company’s
 
Board on May 21, 2020 and covers
certain executive officers that were not covered
 
by the SERP.
 
The following table details on a consolidated basis the
 
changes in benefit obligation, the funded status of the plan,
 
components of
pension expense, amounts recognized in the Company's consolida
 
ted statements of financial condition, and major assumptions
used to determine these amounts.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
105
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
Change in Projected Benefit Obligation:
Benefit Obligation at Beginning of Year
$
10,244
$
8,860
$
7,285
Service Cost
31
-
-
Interest Cost
321
349
227
Actuarial Loss
1,826
1,035
1,348
Plan Amendments
980
-
-
Projected Benefit Obligation at End of Year
$
13,402
$
10,244
$
8,860
Funded Status of Plan and Accrued Liability Recognized
 
at End of Year:
Other Liabilities
$
13,402
$
10,244
$
8,860
Accumulated Benefit Obligation at End of Year
$
12,339
$
8,778
$
7,557
Components of Net Periodic Benefit Costs:
Service Cost
$
31
$
-
$
-
Interest Cost
321
349
227
Amortization of Prior Service Cost
327
-
-
Net Loss Amortization
503
761
1,626
Net Periodic Benefit Cost
$
1,182
$
1,110
$
1,853
Weighted-Average
 
Assumptions Used to Determine Benefit Obligation:
Discount Rate
2.38%
3.16%
4.23%
Rate of Compensation Increase
(1)
4.00%
4.00%
4.00%
Measurement Date
12/31/20
12/31/19
12/31/18
Weighted-Average
 
Assumptions Used to Determine Benefit Cost:
Discount Rate
3.16%
4.23%
3.53%
Rate of Compensation Increase
(1)
3.50%
3.50%
3.25%
Amortization Amounts from Accumulated Other Comprehensive
 
Income:
Net Actuarial Loss
$
1,826
$
1,035
$
1,348
Prior Service Cost
895
-
-
Net Loss
(458)
(761)
(1,626)
Deferred Tax (Benefit)
 
Expense
 
(573)
(70)
71
Other Comprehensive Loss (Gain), net of tax
$
1,690
$
204
$
(207)
Amounts Recognized in Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income:
Net Actuarial Loss
$
2,991
$
1,622
$
1,348
Prior Service Cost
895
-
-
Deferred Tax Benefit
(985)
(411)
(341)
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss, net of tax
$
2,901
$
1,211
$
1,007
(1)
 
The Company utilized an age-graded approach that
 
varies the rate based on the age of the participants.
 
The Company expects to recognize approximately
 
$
1.2
 
million of the net actuarial loss reflected in accumulated other
comprehensive income at December 31, 2020 as
 
a component of net periodic benefit cost during 2021.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
106
Expected Benefit Payments
. As of December 31, expected benefit payments related to
 
the SERP were as follows:
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2021
$
5,218
2022
4,679
2023
2,882
2024
613
2025
48
2026 through 2030
254
Total
$
13,694
 
401(k) Plan
 
 
The Company has a 401(k) Plan which enables CCB and CCBG associates
 
to defer a portion of their salary on a pre-tax
basis.
 
The plan covers substantially all associates of the Company
 
who meet minimum age requirements.
 
The plan is designed to
enable participants to contribute any amount, up to the maximum
 
annual limit allowed by the IRS, of their compensation withheld
in any plan year placed in the 401(k) Plan trust account.
 
Matching contributions of
50
% from the Company are made up to
6
% of
the participant's compensation for eligible associates.
 
Further, in addition to the 50% match,
 
all associates hired after December
31, 2019 will receive annually a contribution by the Company
 
equal to
3
% of their compensation.
 
For 2020, the Company made
annual matching contributions of $
0.8
 
million.
 
For 2019 and 2018, the Company made annual matching contributions
 
of $
0.7
million and $
0.6
 
million, respectively.
 
The participant may choose to invest their contributions into thirty-three
 
investment
options available to 401(k) participants, including
 
the Company’s common stock.
 
A total of
50,000
 
shares of CCBG common
stock have been reserved for issuance.
 
Shares issued to participants have historically been purchased
 
in the open market.
 
 
CCHL, a
51
% owned subsidiary of the Company has a 401(k)
 
Plan available to all CCHL associates who are employed.
 
The plan
allows participants to contribute any amount, up to the maximum
 
annual limit allowed by the IRS, of their compensation withheld
in any plan year placed in the 401(k) Plan trust account.
 
A discretionary matching contribution is determined annually
 
by CCHL.
 
For 2020, matching contributions were made by CCHL up
 
to
3
% of eligible participant's compensation totaling $
0.5
 
million.
 
 
Other Plans
 
 
The Company has a Dividend Reinvestment and Optional
 
Stock Purchase Plan.
 
A total of
250,000
 
shares have been reserved for
issuance.
 
In recent years, shares for the Dividend Reinvestment and
 
Optional Stock Purchase Plan have been acquired in the open
market and, thus, the Company did not issue any shares
 
under this plan in 2020, 2019 and 2018.
 
Note 16
EARNINGS PER SHARE
 
 
The following table sets forth the computation of basic
 
and diluted earnings per share:
 
(Dollars and Per Share Data in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
Numerator:
Net Income
$
31,576
$
30,807
$
26,224
Denominator:
Denominator for Basic Earnings Per Share Weighted
 
-Average Shares
16,785
16,770
17,029
Effects of Dilutive Securities Stock Compensation
 
Plans
37
57
43
Denominator for Diluted Earnings Per Share Adjusted
 
Weighted
 
-Average
 
 
Shares and Assumed Conversions
16,822
16,827
17,072
Basic Earnings Per Share
$
1.88
$
1.84
$
1.54
Diluted Earnings Per Share
$
1.88
$
1.83
$
1.54
 
 
107
Note 17
REGULATORY
 
MATTERS
 
 
Regulatory Capital Requirements
.
 
The Company (on a consolidated basis) and the Bank
 
are subject to various regulatory capital
requirements administered by the federal banking agencies.
 
Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can
 
initiate certain
mandatory and possible additional discretionary actions
 
by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material
 
effect on
the Company and Bank’s
 
financial statements.
 
Under capital
 
adequacy guidelines
 
and the
 
regulatory framework
 
for prompt
corrective action,
 
the Company and the Bank must meet specific capital guidelines
 
that involve quantitative measures of their
assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet
 
items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices.
 
The capital amounts and
classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by
 
the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.
 
Prompt corrective action provisions are not applicable
 
to bank holding companies.
 
A detailed description of these regulatory
capital requirements is provided in the section captioned
 
“Regulatory Considerations – Capital Regulations” section on
 
page 14.
 
Management believes, at December 31, 2020 and
 
2019, that the Company and the Bank meet all capital adequacy
 
requirements to
which they are subject.
 
At December 31, 2020, the most recent notification from
 
the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
categorized the Bank as well capitalized under the regulatory
 
framework
 
for prompt corrective action.
 
To be categorized as well
capitalized, an institution must maintain minimum common
 
equity Tier 1, total risk-based, Tier
 
1 risk based and Tier 1 leverage
ratios as set forth in the following tables.
 
There are not conditions or events since the notification that management
 
believes have
changed the Bank’s category.
 
The Company and Bank’s
 
actual capital amounts and ratios at December 31, 2020 and
 
2019 are
presented in the following table.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
108
To Be Well
 
-
Capitalized Under
Required
Prompt
For Capital
Corrective
Actual
Adequacy Purposes
Action Provisions
(Dollars in Thousands)
Amount
Ratio
Amount
Ratio
Amount
Ratio
2020
Common Equity Tier 1:
CCBG
$
 
281,494
13.71%
$
92,424
4.50%
*
*
CCB
302,147
14.75%
92,177
4.50%
$
133,145
6.50%
Tier 1 Capital:
CCBG
 
332,494
16.19%
123,232
6.00%
*
*
CCB
302,147
14.75%
122,903
6.00%
163,870
8.00%
Total
 
Capital:
CCBG
355,338
17.30%
164,310
8.00%
*
*
CCB
324,991
15.87%
163,870
8.00%
204,838
10.00%
Tier 1 Leverage:
CCBG
332,494
9.33%
142,560
4.00%
*
*
CCB
302,147
8.49%
142,280
4.00%
177,850
5.00%
2019
Common Equity Tier 1:
CCBG
$
 
273,676
14.47%
$
85,131
4.50%
*
*
CCB
304,340
16.14%
84,867
4.50%
$
122,585
6.50%
Tier 1 Capital:
CCBG
324,676
17.16%
113,509
6.00%
*
*
CCB
304,340
16.14%
113,156
6.00%
150,874
8.00%
Total
 
Capital:
CCBG
338,582
17.90%
151,345
8.00%
*
*
CCB
318,245
16.87%
150,874
8.00%
188,593
10.00%
Tier 1 Leverage:
CCBG
324,676
11.25%
115,459
4.00%
*
*
CCB
304,340
10.57%
115,168
4.00%
143,960
5.00%
*
 
Not applicable to bank holding companies.
 
Dividend Restrictions
.
 
In the ordinary course of business, the Company
 
is dependent upon dividends from its banking subsidiary
to provide funds for the payment of dividends to shareowners
 
and to provide for other cash requirements.
 
Banking regulations
may limit the amount of dividends that may be paid.
 
Approval by regulatory authorities is required if the effect
 
of dividends
declared would cause the regulatory capital of the Company’s
 
banking subsidiary to fall below specified minimum levels.
 
Approval is also required if dividends declared exceed the
 
net profits of the banking subsidiary for that year combined
 
with the
retained net profits for proceeding two years.
 
In 2021, the bank subsidiary may declare dividends without
 
regulatory approval of
$
31.7
 
million plus an additional amount equal to net profits of the
 
Company’s subsidiary bank for
 
2021 up to the date of any such
dividend declaration.
 
Note 18
OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
 
 
FASB Topic
 
ASC 220, “Comprehensive Income” requires that certain
 
transactions and other economic events that bypass the
income statement be displayed as other comprehensive
 
income.
 
Total comprehensive
 
income is reported in the consolidated
statements of comprehensive income and changes in shareowners
 
 
equity.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
109
 
The following table summarizes the tax effects
 
for each component of other comprehensive income (loss) and includes
separately the reclassification adjustment for investment
 
securities and benefit plans:
 
Before
Tax
Net of
Tax
(Expense)
Tax
(Dollars in Thousands)
Amount
Benefit
Amount
2020
Investment Securities:
Change in net unrealized gain (loss) on securities available
 
for sale
$
2,437
$
(628)
$
1,809
Amortization of losses on securities transferred from available
 
for sale to
held to maturity
36
(9)
27
Total Investment
 
Securities
2,473
(637)
1,836
Derivative:
Change in net unrealized gain (loss) on effective
 
cash flow hedge
$
574
$
(146)
$
428
Benefit Plans:
Reclassification adjustment for amortization of prior service
 
cost
(880)
223
(657)
Reclassification adjustment for amortization of net loss
4,391
(1,113)
3,278
Current year actuarial loss
(27,924)
7,078
(20,846)
Total Benefit Plans
(24,413)
6,188
(18,225)
Total Other Comprehensive
 
Loss
$
(21,366)
$
5,405
$
(15,961)
2019
Investment Securities:
Change in net unrealized gain (loss) on securities available
 
for sale
$
3,790
$
(950)
$
2,840
Amortization of losses on securities transferred from available
 
for sale to
held to maturity
43
(11)
32
Total Investment
 
Securities
3,833
(961)
2,872
Benefit Plans:
Reclassification adjustment for amortization of prior service
 
cost
15
(4)
11
Reclassification adjustment for amortization of net loss
4,623
(1,170)
3,453
Current year actuarial loss
(7,642)
1,940
(5,702)
Total Benefit Plans
(3,004)
766
(2,238)
Total Other Comprehensive
 
Income
$
829
$
(195)
$
634
2018
Investment Securities:
Change in net unrealized gain (loss) on securities available
 
for sale
$
(409)
$
103
$
(306)
Amortization of losses on securities transferred from available
 
for sale to
held to maturity
55
(14)
41
Total Investment
 
Securities
(354)
89
(265)
Benefit Plans:
Reclassification adjustment for amortization of prior service
 
cost
199
(50)
149
Reclassification adjustment for amortization of net loss
5,299
(1,346)
3,953
Current year actuarial loss
(815)
207
(608)
Total Benefit Plans
4,683
(1,189)
3,494
Total Other Comprehensive
 
Income
$
4,329
$
(1,100)
$
3,229
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
110
Accumulated other comprehensive loss was comprised of
 
the following components:
Accumulated
Securities
Other
Available
Interest Rate
Retirement
Comprehensive
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
for Sale
Swap
Plans
Loss
Balance as of January 1, 2020
$
864
$
-
$
(29,045)
$
(28,181)
Other comprehensive income (loss) during the period
1,836
428
(18,225)
(15,961)
Balance as of December 31, 2020
$
2,700
$
428
$
(47,270)
$
(44,142)
Balance as of January 1, 2019
$
(2,008)
$
-
$
(26,807)
$
(28,815)
Other comprehensive income (loss) during the period
2,872
-
(2,238)
634
Balance as of December 31, 2019
$
864
$
-
$
(29,045)
$
(28,181)
Balance as of January 1, 2018
$
(1,743)
$
-
$
(30,301)
$
(32,044)
Other comprehensive (loss) income during the period
(265)
-
3,494
3,229
Balance as of December 31, 2018
$
(2,008)
$
-
$
(26,807)
$
(28,815)
 
Note 19
RELATED PARTY
 
TRANSACTIONS
 
 
At December 31, 2020 and 2019, certain officers
 
and directors were indebted to the Company’s
 
bank subsidiary in the aggregate
amount of $
4.3
 
million and $
7.7
 
million, respectively.
 
During 2020, $
3.3
 
million in new loans were made and repayments totaled
$
6.7
 
million.
 
These loans were all current at year-end.
 
Deposits from certain directors, executive officers,
 
and their related interests totaled $
41.9
 
million and $
29.7
 
million at December
31, 2020 and 2019, respectively.
 
Under a lease agreement expiring in 2024, the Bank leases land
 
from a partnership in which William G. Smith,
 
Jr. has an interest.
 
The lease agreement with Smith Interests General Partnership
 
L.L.P.
 
provides for annual lease payments of approximately
$
212,000
, to be adjusted for inflation in future years.
 
William G. Smith, III, the son
 
of our Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer,
 
William G. Smith, Jr.,
 
is employed as
President, Leon County at Capital City Bank.
 
In 2020,
 
William G. Smith, III’s
 
total compensation (consisting of annual base
salary, annual
 
bonus, and stock-based compensation) was determined
 
in accordance with the Company’s
 
standard employment
and compensation practices applicable to associates with similar
 
responsibilities and positions.
 
 
Note 20
OTHER NONINTEREST EXPENSE
 
 
Components of other noninterest expense in excess of
 
1% of the sum of total interest income and noninterest income,
 
which are
not disclosed separately elsewhere, are presented
 
below for each of the respective years.
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
Legal Fees
$
1,570
$
1,722
$
2,055
Professional Fees
4,863
4,345
5,003
Telephone
2,869
2,645
2,224
Advertising
2,998
2,056
1,611
Processing Services
5,832
5,779
5,978
Insurance – Other
1,607
1,007
1,625
Pension – Other
(216)
1,642
1,828
Other
11,396
9,079
9,197
Total
$
30,919
$
28,275
$
29,521
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
111
Note 21
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
 
Lending Commitments
.
 
The Company is a party to financial instruments with off
 
-balance sheet risks in the normal course of
business to meet the financing needs of its clients.
 
These financial instruments consist of commitments to extend
 
credit and
standby letters of credit.
 
The Company’s maximum
 
exposure to credit loss under standby letters of credit and
 
commitments to extend credit is
represented by the contractual amount of those instruments.
 
The Company uses the same credit policies in establishing
commitments and issuing letters of credit as it does for
 
on-balance sheet instruments.
 
At December 31, the amounts associated
with the Company’s off-balance
 
sheet obligations were as follows:
 
2020
2019
(Dollars in Thousands)
Fixed
Variable
Total
Fixed
Variable
Total
Commitments to Extend Credit
(1)
$
160,372
$
596,572
$
756,944
$
114,903
$
404,345
$
519,248
Standby Letters of Credit
6,550
-
6,550
5,783
-
5,783
Total
$
166,922
$
596,572
$
763,494
$
120,686
$
404,345
$
525,031
(1)
 
Includes unfunded loans, revolving lines of credit, and other unused commitments at CCB and the CCHL residential
 
loan pipeline.
 
Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend
 
to a client so long as there is no violation of any condition established in
the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration
 
dates or other termination clauses and may require payment
 
of a fee.
Since many of the commitments are expected to expire
 
without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do
 
not
necessarily represent future cash requirements.
 
Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments
 
issued by the Company to guarantee the performance
 
of a client to a third
party.
 
The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the
 
same as that involved in extending loan facilities. In
general, management does not anticipate any material
 
losses as a result of participating in these types of transactions.
 
However,
any potential losses arising from such transactions are
 
reserved for in the same manner as management reserves for
 
its other
credit facilities.
 
For both on-
 
and off-balance sheet financial instruments, the Company
 
requires collateral to support such instruments when it is
deemed necessary.
 
The Company evaluates each client’s
 
creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis.
 
The amount of collateral
obtained upon extension of credit is based on management’s
 
credit evaluation of the counterparty.
 
Collateral held varies, but
may include deposits held in financial institutions; U.S. Treasury
 
securities; other marketable securities; real estate; accounts
receivable; property,
 
plant and equipment; and inventory.
 
Other Commitments
.
 
In the normal course of business, the Company
 
enters into lease commitments which are classified as
operating leases.
 
See Note 7 – Leases for additional information on the maturity
 
of the Company’s operating
 
lease commitments.
 
Contingencies
.
 
The Company is a party to lawsuits and claims arising out of
 
the normal course of business.
 
In management's
opinion, there are no known pending claims or litigation,
 
the outcome of which would, individually or in the aggregate,
 
have a
material effect on the consolidated results of
 
operations, financial position, or cash flows of the Company.
 
Indemnification Obligation
.
 
The Company is a member of the Visa
 
U.S.A. network.
 
Visa U.S.A believes that its member
 
banks
are required to indemnify it for potential future settlement
 
of certain litigation (the “Covered Litigation”) that relates to several
antitrust lawsuits challenging the practices of Visa
 
and MasterCard International.
 
In 2008, the Company,
 
as a member of the Visa
U.S.A. network, obtained Class B shares of Visa,
 
Inc. upon its initial public
 
offering.
 
Since its initial public offering, Visa,
 
Inc.
has funded a litigation reserve for the Covered Litigation
 
resulting in a reduction in the Class B shares held by the Company.
 
During the first quarter of 2011,
 
the Company sold its remaining Class B shares.
 
Associated with this sale, the Company entered
into a swap contract with the purchaser of the shares
 
that requires a payment to the counterparty in the event that Visa,
 
Inc. makes
subsequent revisions to the conversion ratio for its Class B shares.
 
Fixed charges included in the swap liability are payable
quarterly until the litigation reserve is fully liquidated and
 
at which time the aforementioned swap contract will be terminated.
 
Payments during 2020 totaled $
711,000
.
 
Conversion ratio payments and ongoing fixed quarterly charges
 
are reflected in earnings
in the period incurred.
 
 
112
Note 22
FAIR VALUE
 
MEASUREMENTS
 
 
The fair value of an asset or liability is the price that would
 
be received to sell that asset or paid to transfer that
 
liability in an
orderly transaction occurring in the principal market (or most advantageous
 
market in the absence of a principal market) for such
asset or liability.
 
In estimating fair value, the Company utilizes valuation
 
techniques that are consistent with the market approach,
the income approach and/or the cost approach.
 
Such valuation techniques are consistently applied.
 
Inputs to valuation techniques
include the assumptions that market participants would
 
use in pricing an asset or liability.
 
ASC Topic 820
 
establishes a fair value
hierarchy for valuation inputs that gives the highest priority
 
to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities and
the lowest priority to unobservable inputs.
 
The fair value hierarchy is as follows:
 
 
Level 1 Inputs -
Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities
 
that the reporting entity has
the ability to access at the measurement date
.
 
 
 
Level 2 Inputs -
Inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that
 
are observable for the asset or liability,
 
either
directly or indirectly.
 
These might include quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active
 
markets, quoted prices
for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that
 
are not active, inputs other than quoted prices that are
observable for the asset or liability (such as interest rates,
 
volatilities, prepayment speeds, credit risks, etc.) or inputs
 
that
are derived principally from, or corroborated, by market
 
data by correlation or other means
.
 
 
 
Level 3 Inputs -
Unobservable inputs for determining the fair values of assets or
 
liabilities that reflect an entity's own
assumptions about the assumptions that market participants
 
would use in pricing the assets or liabilities.
 
Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair
 
Value on
 
a Recurring Basis
 
 
Securities Available for Sale.
 
U.S. Treasury securities are reported
 
at fair value utilizing Level 1 inputs.
 
Other securities
classified as available for sale are reported at fair
 
value utilizing Level 2 inputs.
 
For these securities, the Company obtains fair
value measurements from an independent pricing service.
 
The fair value measurements consider observable data that
 
may
include dealer quotes, market spreads, cash flows, the
 
U.S. Treasury yield curve, live trading levels,
 
trade execution data, credit
information and the bond’s
 
terms and conditions, among other things.
 
In general, the Company does not purchase securities that have
 
a complicated structure.
 
The Company’s entire portfolio
 
consists
of traditional investments, nearly all of which are U.S.
 
Treasury obligations, federal agency bullet or mortgage
 
pass-through
securities, or general obligation or revenue based municipal
 
bonds.
 
Pricing for such instruments is easily obtained.
 
At least
annually, the Company
 
will validate prices supplied by the independent pricing service
 
by comparing them to prices obtained
from an independent third-party source.
 
Loans Held for Sale
. The fair value of residential mortgage loans held for sale based
 
on Level 2 inputs is determined, when
possible, using either quoted secondary-market prices
 
or investor commitments. If no such quoted price exists, the fair
 
value is
determined using quoted prices for a similar asset or assets, adjusted
 
for the specific attributes of that loan, which would be used
by other market participants. The Company has elected
 
the fair value option accounting for its held for sale loans.
 
 
Mortgage Banking Derivative Instruments.
The fair values of interest rate lock commitments (“IRLCs”) are
 
derived by valuation
models incorporating market pricing for instruments with
 
similar characteristics, commonly referred to as best execution
 
pricing,
or investor commitment prices for best effort
 
IRLCs which have unobservable inputs, such as an estimate of the
 
fair value of the
servicing rights expected to be recorded upon sale of the
 
loans, net estimated costs to originate the loans, and the pull-through
rate, and are therefore classified as Level 3 within
 
the fair value hierarchy. The fair
 
value of forward sale commitments is based
on observable market pricing for similar instruments and
 
are therefore classified as Level 2 within the fair value hierarchy.
 
Interest Rate Swap.
The Company’s derivative
 
positions are classified as level 2 within the fair value
 
hierarchy and are valued
using models generally accepted in the financial services
 
industry and that use actively quoted or observable market
 
input values
from external market data providers. The fair value
 
derivatives are determined using discounted cash flow models.
 
Fair Value
 
Swap
.
 
The Company entered into a stand-alone derivative contract
 
with the purchaser of its Visa Class B
 
shares.
 
The
valuation represents the amount due and payable to the counterparty
 
based upon the revised share conversion rate, if any,
 
during
the period.
 
At December 31, 2020, there were no amounts payable.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
113
A summary of fair values for assets and liabilities at December
 
31 consisted of the following:
 
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total
 
Fair
Inputs
Inputs
Inputs
Value
2020
ASSETS:
Securities Available
 
for Sale:
U.S. Government Treasury
$
104,519
$
-
$
-
$
104,519
U.S. Government Agency
-
208,531
-
208,531
States and Political Subdivisions
-
3,632
-
3,632
Mortgage-Backed Securities
-
515
-
515
Equity Securities
-
7,673
-
7,673
Held for Sale Loans
-
114,039
-
114,039
Interest Rate Swap Derivative Asset
-
574
-
574
Mortgage Banking Derivative Assets
-
-
4,825
4,825
LIABILITIES:
Mortgage Banking Derivative Liabilities
-
907
-
907
2019
ASSETS:
Securities Available
 
for Sale:
U.S. Government Treasury
$
232,778
$
-
$
-
$
232,778
U.S. Government Agency
-
156,078
-
156,078
State and Political Subdivisions
-
6,319
-
6,319
Mortgage-Backed Securities
-
773
-
773
Equity Securities
-
7,653
-
7,653
 
Mortgage Banking Activities.
 
The Company had Level 3 issuances and transfers of
 
$
50.7
 
million and $
56.0
 
million for the period
March 1, 2020 to December 31, 2020 related to mortgage
 
banking activities.
 
Issuances
 
are valued based on the change in fair
value of the underlying mortgage loan from inception
 
of the IRLC to the balance sheet date, adjusted for pull
 
-through rates and
costs to originate.
 
IRLCs transferred out of Level 3 represent IRLCs that were funded
 
and moved to mortgage loans held for sale,
at fair value.
 
 
Assets Measured at Fair Value
 
on a Non-Recurring Basis
 
 
Certain assets are measured at fair value on a non-recurring
 
basis (i.e., the assets are not measured at fair value on an
 
ongoing
basis but are subject to fair value adjustments in certain
 
circumstances).
 
An example would be assets exhibiting evidence of
impairment.
 
The following is a description of valuation methodologies used for assets measured
 
on a non-recurring basis.
 
 
Collateral Dependent Loans
.
 
Impairment for collateral dependent loans is measured
 
using the fair value of the collateral less
selling costs.
 
The fair value of collateral is determined by an independent
 
valuation or professional appraisal in conformance with
banking regulations.
 
Collateral values are estimated using Level 3 inputs due
 
to the volatility in the real estate market, and the
judgment and estimation involved in the real estate appraisal
 
process.
 
Collateral dependent loans are reviewed and evaluated on
at least a quarterly basis for additional impairment and
 
adjusted accordingly.
 
Valuation
 
techniques are consistent with those
techniques applied in prior periods.
 
Collateral dependent loans had a carrying value of $
7.1
 
million with a valuation allowance of
$
0.1
 
million at December 31, 2020.
 
Other Real Estate Owned
.
 
During 2020 and 2019, certain foreclosed assets, upon initial recognition,
 
were measured and reported
at fair value through a charge-off
 
to the allowance for loan losses based on the fair value of the foreclosed
 
asset less estimated
cost to sell.
 
The fair value of the foreclosed asset is determined by
 
an independent valuation or professional appraisal in
conformance with banking regulations.
 
On an ongoing basis, we obtain updated appraisals on foreclosed
 
assets and record
valuation adjustments as necessary.
 
The fair value of foreclosed assets is estimated using Level
 
3 inputs due to the judgment and
estimation involved in the real estate valuation process.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
114
Mortgage Servicing Rights
. Residential mortgage loan servicing rights are evaluated
 
for impairment at each reporting period
based upon the fair value of the rights as compared
 
to the carrying amount.
 
Fair value is determined by a third party valuation
model using estimated prepayment speeds of the underlying
 
mortgage loans serviced and stratifications based on the
 
risk
characteristics of the underlying loans (predominantly
 
loan type and note interest rate).
 
The fair value is estimated using Level 3
inputs, including a discount rate, weighted average prepayment
 
speed, and the cost of loan servicing.
 
Further detail on the key
inputs utilized are provided in Note 4 – Mortgage
 
Banking Activities.
 
At December 31, 2020, there was a $
250,000
 
valuation
allowance for mortgage servicing rights.
 
Assets and Liabilities Disclosed at Fair Value
 
The Company is required to disclose the estimated fair value
 
of financial instruments, both assets and liabilities, for which
 
it is
practical to estimate fair value and the following
 
is a description of valuation methodologies used for those assets and liabilities.
 
Cash and Short-Term
 
Investments.
 
The carrying amount of cash and short-term investments is used
 
to approximate fair value,
given the short time frame to maturity and as such assets do
 
not present unanticipated credit concerns.
 
Securities Held to Maturity
.
 
Securities held to maturity are valued in accordance
 
with the methodology previously noted in the
caption “Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value
 
on a Recurring Basis – Securities Available
 
for Sale”.
 
Loans.
 
The loan portfolio is segregated into categories and the fair value
 
of each loan category is calculated using present value
techniques based upon projected cash flows and
 
estimated discount rates.
 
Pursuant to the adoption of ASU 2016-01,
Recognition
and Measurement of Financial Assets and
 
Financial Liabilities
, the values reported reflect the incorporation of
 
a liquidity
discount to meet the objective of “exit price” valu
 
ation.
 
 
Deposits.
 
The fair value of Noninterest Bearing Deposits, NOW Accounts,
 
Money Market Accounts and Savings Accounts are
the amounts payable on demand at the reporting date.
 
The fair value of fixed maturity certificates of deposit is estimated using
present value techniques and rates currently offered
 
for deposits of similar remaining maturities.
 
Subordinated Notes Payab
 
le.
 
The fair value of each note is calculated using present
 
value techniques, based upon projected cash
flows and estimated discount rates as well as rates being offered
 
for similar obligations.
 
Short-Term
 
and Long-Term
 
Borrowings.
 
The fair value of each note is calculated using present value
 
techniques, based upon
projected cash flows and estimated discount rates as well as rates
 
being offered for similar debt.
 
A summary of estimated fair values of significant
 
financial instruments at December 31 consisted of the following:
 
2020
(Dollars in Thousands)
Carrying
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Value
Inputs
Inputs
Inputs
ASSETS:
Cash
$
67,919
$
67,919
$
-
$
-
Short-Term
 
Investments
860,630
860,630
-
-
Investment Securities, Available
 
for Sale
324,870
104,519
220,351
-
Investment Securities, Held to Maturity
169,939
5,014
170,161
-
Loans Held for Sale
114,039
-
114,039
-
Other Equity Securities
(1)
3,589
-
3,589
-
Interest Rate Swap Derivative Asset
574
-
574
-
Mortgage Banking Derivative Asset
 
4,825
-
-
4,825
Mortgage Servicing Rights
3,452
-
-
3,451
Loans, Net of Allowance for Credit Losses
1,982,610
-
-
1,990,740
LIABILITIES:
Deposits
$
3,217,560
$
-
$
3,217,615
$
-
Short-Term
 
Borrowings
79,654
-
79,654
-
Subordinated Notes Payable
52,887
-
43,449
-
Long-Term
 
Borrowings
3,057
-
3,174
-
Mortgage Banking Derivative Liability
907
-
907
-
(1)
 
Not readily marketable securities are reflected in other assets.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
115
2019
(Dollars in Thousands)
Carrying
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Value
Inputs
Inputs
Inputs
ASSETS:
Cash
$
60,087
$
60,087
$
-
$
-
Short-Term
 
Investments
318,336
318,336
-
-
Investment Securities, Available
 
for Sale
403,601
232,778
170,823
-
Investment Securities, Held to Maturity
239,539
20,042
221,387
-
Loans Held for Sale
9,509
-
9,509
-
Other Equity Securities
3,591
-
3,591
-
Loans, Net of Allowance for Credit Losses
1,822,024
-
-
1,804,930
LIABILITIES:
Deposits
$
2,645,454
$
-
$
2,644,430
$
-
Short-Term
 
Borrowings
6,404
-
6,404
-
Subordinated Notes Payable
52,887
-
40,280
-
Long-Term
 
Borrowings
6,514
-
6,623
-
 
All non-financial instruments are excluded from the
 
above table.
 
The disclosures also do not include goodwill.
 
Accordingly, the
aggregate fair value amounts presented do not represent
 
the underlying value of the Company.
 
Note 23
PARENT COMPANY
 
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
 
The following are condensed statements of financial
 
condition of the parent company at December 31:
 
Parent Company Statements of Financial Condition
 
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Per Share
 
Data)
2020
2019
ASSETS
Cash and Due From Subsidiary Bank
$
39,718
$
28,924
Investment in Subsidiary Bank
342,958
359,577
Other Assets
6,530
5,884
Total Assets
$
389,206
$
394,385
 
LIABILITIES
Long-Term
 
Borrowings
$
900
$
1,500
Subordinated Notes Payable
52,887
52,887
Other Liabilities
14,582
12,982
Total Liabilities
68,369
67,369
 
SHAREOWNERS’ EQUITY
Common Stock, $
.01
 
par value;
90,000,000
 
shares authorized;
16,790,573
 
and
16,771,544
 
shares
issued and outstanding at December 31, 2020 and December 31,
 
2019, respectively
168
168
Additional Paid-In Capital
32,283
32,092
Retained Earnings
332,528
322,937
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss, Net of Tax
(44,142)
(28,181)
Total Shareowners’
 
Equity
320,837
327,016
Total Liabilities and
 
Shareowners’ Equity
$
389,206
$
394,385
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
116
The operating results of the parent company for the three
 
years ended December 31 are shown below:
 
Parent Company Statements of Operations
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
OPERATING INCOME
Income Received from Subsidiary Bank:
Administrative Fees
$
6,068
$
6,517
$
5,700
Dividends
21,000
19,000
15,000
Other Income
193
203
171
Total Operating
 
Income
27,261
25,720
20,871
 
OPERATING EXPENSE
Salaries and Associate Benefits
3,418
3,928
3,679
Interest on Subordinated Notes Payable
1,514
2,381
2,286
Professional Fees
1,079
1,196
1,210
Advertising
140
157
106
Legal Fees
456
391
166
Other
1,673
1,711
2,170
Total Operating
 
Expense
8,280
9,764
9,617
Earnings Before Income Taxes
 
and Equity in Undistributed
Earnings of Subsidiary Bank
18,981
15,956
11,254
Income Tax (Benefit)
 
Expense
 
(406)
(632)
(901)
Earnings Before Equity in Undistributed Earnings of Subsidiary
 
Bank
19,387
16,588
12,155
Equity in Undistributed Earnings of Subsidiary Bank
12,189
14,219
14,069
Net Income
$
31,576
$
30,807
$
26,224
 
The cash flows for the parent company for the three years
 
ended December 31 were as follows:
 
Parent Company Statements of Cash Flows
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2020
2019
2018
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING
 
ACTIVITIES:
Net Income
$
31,576
$
30,807
$
26,224
Adjustments to Reconcile Net Income to Net Cash Provided
 
By
 
Operating Activities:
Equity in Undistributed Earnings of Subsidiary Bank
(12,189)
(14,219)
(14,069)
Stock Compensation
892
1,569
1,421
(Increase) Decrease in Other Assets
(217)
(445)
(327)
Increase in Other Liabilities
1,900
1,557
1,579
Net Cash Provided By Operating Activities
21,962
19,269
14,828
CASH FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
Repayment of Long-Term
 
Borrowings
(600)
(600)
(600)
Dividends Paid
(9,567)
(8,047)
(5,457)
Issuance of Common Stock Under Compensation Plans
1,041
1,054
797
Payments to Repurchase Common Stock
(2,042)
(1,805)
(8,030)
Net Cash Used In Financing Activities
(11,168)
(9,398)
(13,290)
Net Increase in Cash
10,794
9,871
1,538
Cash at Beginning of Year
28,924
19,053
17,515
Cash at End of Year
$
39,718
$
28,924
$
19,053
 
117
Item 9.
 
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and
 
Financial Disclosure
 
 
None.
 
Item 9A. Controls
 
and Procedures
 
 
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls
 
and Procedures
.
 
At December 31, 2020, the end of the period covered by this Annual Report
on Form 10-K, our management, including our Chief Executive
 
Officer and Chief Financial Officer,
 
evaluated the effectiveness
of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in
 
Rule 13a-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934). Based upon
that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer
 
and Chief Financial Officer each concluded that at December
 
31, 2020, the end of the
period covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K,
 
we maintained effective disclosure controls and
 
procedures.
 
Management’s
 
Report on Internal Control Over Financial
 
Reporting.
 
Our management is responsible for establishing and
maintaining effective internal control over
 
financial reporting.
 
Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to
provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability
 
of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements
 
for
external purposes in accordance with U.S. generally
 
accepted accounting principles.
 
Internal control over financial reporting cannot provide
 
absolute assurance of achieving financial reporting objectives because
 
of
its inherent limitations. Internal control over financial
 
reporting is a process that involves human diligence and compliance
 
and is
subject to lapses in judgment and breakdowns resulting from human
 
failures. Internal control over financial reporting can also
 
be
circumvented by collusion or improper management override. Because
 
of such limitations, there is a risk that material
misstatements may not be prevented or detected
 
on a timely basis by internal control over financial reporting.
 
However, these
inherent limitations are known features of the financial
 
reporting process. Therefore, it is possible to design into
 
the process
safeguards to reduce, though not eliminate, this risk.
 
Management is also responsible for the preparation
 
and fair presentation of the consolidated financial statements
 
and other
financial information contained in this report. The accompanying
 
consolidated financial statements were prepared in conformity
with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles and
 
include, as necessary,
 
best estimates and judgments by management.
 
Under the supervision and with the participation of management,
 
including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief
 
Financial
Officer, we conducted
 
an evaluation of the effectiveness of internal control over
 
financial reporting based on the framework in
Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the
 
Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway
 
Commission
(2013 framework) (the COSO criteria).
 
As allowed for by the SEC under the current year acquisition scope
 
exception,
management’s assessment of
 
the effectiveness of the internal control over financial
 
reporting excluded the evaluation of internal
controls over financial reporting of Capital City Home Loans,
 
LLC, which was acquired on March 1, 2020.
 
As part of this
acquisition, we recorded approximately $52 million
 
in total assets.
 
Based on this evaluation under the framework in Internal
Control - Integrated Framework, our management has concluded
 
we maintained effective internal control over financial reporting,
as such term is defined in Securities Exchange
 
Act of 1934 Rule 13a-15(f), at December 31, 2020.
 
 
Ernst & Young
 
LLP,
 
an independent registered public accounting firm, has audited
 
our consolidated financial statements as of
and for the year ended December 31, 2020, and opined
 
as to the effectiveness of internal control over
 
financial reporting at
December 31, 2020, as stated in its attestation report, which
 
is included herein on page 118.
 
Change in Internal Control
.
 
Our management, including the Chief Executive Officer
 
and Chief Financial Officer,
 
has reviewed
our internal control.
 
There have been no changes in our internal control during
 
our most recently completed fiscal quarter that
materially affected, or are likely to materially
 
affect our internal control over financial reporting.
 
Item 9B. Other
 
Information
 
 
None.
 
118
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
 
To the Shareowners
 
and the Board of Directors of Capital City Bank Group,
 
Inc.
 
 
Opinion on Internal Control over Financial
 
Reporting
 
 
We have
 
audited Capital
 
City Bank
 
Group, Inc.’s
 
internal control
 
over financial
 
reporting as
 
of December
 
31, 2020,
 
based on
criteria established
 
in Internal
 
Control—Integrated Framework
 
issued by
 
the Committee
 
of Sponsoring
 
Organizations of
 
the
Treadway Commission
 
(2013 framework)
 
(the COSO
 
criteria). In
 
our opinion,
 
Capital City
 
Bank Group,
 
Inc. (the
 
Company)
maintained, in
 
all material
 
respects, effective
 
internal control
 
over financial
 
reporting as
 
of December
 
31, 2020,
 
based on
 
the
COSO criteria.
 
 
As indicated
 
in the
 
accompanying
Management’s
 
Report on
 
Internal Control
 
over Financial
 
Reporting
, management’s
assessment of and conclusion
 
on the effectiveness
 
of internal control over
 
financial reporting did not
 
include the internal controls
of Capital City
 
Home Loans, LLC,
 
which is included
 
in the 2020
 
consolidated financial statements
 
of Capital City
 
Bank Group,
Inc. and constituted
 
$52 million in
 
total assets as
 
of March 1,
 
2020. Our audit
 
of internal control
 
over financial reporting
 
of the
Company also did not include an evaluation of the internal
 
control over financial reporting of Capital City Home Loans,
 
LLC.
 
 
We also
 
have audited,
 
in accordance
 
with the
 
standards of
 
the Public
 
Company Accounting
 
Oversight Board
 
(United States)
(PCAOB), the consolidated
 
statements of
 
financial condition
 
of the
 
Company as
 
of December
 
31, 2020
 
and 2019,
 
the related
consolidated statements of
 
income, comprehensive income,
 
changes in shareowners’
 
equity, and
 
cash flows for
 
each of the
 
three
years in
 
the period
 
ended December
 
31, 2020,
 
and the
 
related notes
 
of the
 
Company and
 
our report
 
dated March
 
1, 2021
expressed
 
an unqualified opinion thereon
.
 
Basis for Opinion
 
The Company’s
 
management is responsible for
 
maintaining effective internal
 
control over financial reporting
 
and for its
assessment of
 
the effectiveness
 
of internal
 
control over
 
financial reporting
 
included in the
 
accompanying Management’s
 
Report
on Internal
 
Control over Financial
 
Reporting. Our responsibility
 
is to express
 
an opinion on
 
the Company’s
 
internal control over
financial reporting
 
based on
 
our audit.
 
We are
 
a public
 
accounting firm
 
registered with
 
the PCAOB
 
and are
 
required to
 
be
independent with
 
respect to
 
the Company
 
in accordance
 
with the
 
U.S. federal
 
securities laws
 
and the
 
applicable rules
 
and
regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission
 
and the PCAOB.
 
 
We conducted
 
our audit in
 
accordance with the
 
standards of the
 
PCAOB. Those standards
 
require that we
 
plan and perform
 
the
audit to
 
obtain reasonable
 
assurance about
 
whether effective
 
internal control
 
over financial
 
reporting was
 
maintained in
 
all
material respects.
 
Our audit
 
included obtaining
 
an understanding
 
of internal
 
control over
 
financial reporting,
 
assessing the
 
risk that
 
a material
weakness exists, testing
 
and evaluating the
 
design and operating
 
effectiveness of internal
 
control based on
 
the assessed risk,
 
and
performing such
 
other procedures
 
as we
 
considered necessary
 
in the
 
circumstances. We
 
believe that
 
our audit
 
provides a
reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
Definition and Limitations of Internal Control
 
Over Financial Reporting
 
A company’s
 
internal control
 
over financial
 
reporting is
 
a process
 
designed to
 
provide reasonable
 
assurance regarding
 
the
reliability of
 
financial reporting
 
and the
 
preparation of
 
financial statements
 
for external
 
purposes in
 
accordance with
 
generally
accepted accounting principles.
 
A company’s
 
internal control over
 
financial reporting includes
 
those policies and
 
procedures that
(1) pertain to the maintenance of records that,
 
in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly
 
reflect the transactions and dispositions of
the assets of
 
the company;
 
(2) provide reasonable
 
assurance that transactions
 
are recorded as
 
necessary to
 
permit preparation
 
of
financial statements
 
in accordance
 
with generally
 
accepted accounting
 
principles, and
 
that receipts
 
and expenditures
 
of the
company are
 
being made
 
only in accordan
 
ce with authorizations
 
of management
 
and directors of
 
the company;
 
and (3) provide
reasonable assurance
 
regarding prevention
 
or timely detection
 
of unauthorized
 
acquisition, use, or
 
disposition of the
 
company’s
assets that could have a material effect on
 
the financial statements.
 
Because of
 
its inherent
 
limitations, internal
 
control over
 
financial reporting
 
may not
 
prevent or
 
detect misstatements.
 
Also,
projections of
 
any evaluation
 
of effectiveness
 
to future
 
periods are
 
subject to
 
the risk
 
that controls
 
may become
 
inadequate
because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of
 
compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
 
 
/s/ Ernst & Young
 
LLP
 
Tallahassee, Florida
March 1, 2021
 
 
119
Part III
 
Item 10.
 
Directors, Executive Officers, and Corporate Governance
 
Incorporated herein by reference to the sections entitled
 
“Proposal No. 1 – Election of Directors”,
 
“Corporate Governance at
Capital City,” “Share Ownership”
 
and “Board Committee Membership” in the Registrant’s
 
Proxy Statement relating to its Annual
Meeting of Shareowners to be held April 27, 2021.
 
Item 11. Executive
 
Compensation
 
Incorporated herein by reference to the sections entitled
 
“Compensation Discussion and Analysis,” “Executive Compensation”
and “Director Compensation”
 
in the Registrant’s Proxy
 
Statement relating to its Annual Meeting of Shareowners to be held April
27, 2021.
 
Item 12. Security
 
Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management
 
and Related Shareowners Matters.
 
 
Information required by Item 12 of Form 10-K is incorporated
 
by reference from the information contained in the sections
captioned “Share
 
Ownership” and “Equity Compensation Plan Information” in
 
the Registrant’s Proxy Statement
 
relating to its
Annual Meeting of Shareowners to be held April 27, 2021.
 
 
Item 13.
 
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions,
 
and Director Independence
 
 
Incorporated herein by reference to the sections entitled
 
“Transactions With Related
 
Persons” and “Corporate Governance at
Capital City” in the Registrant’s
 
Proxy Statement relating to its Annual Meeting of
 
Shareowners to be held April 27, 2021.
 
 
Item 14.
 
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
 
 
Incorporated herein by reference to the section entitled
 
“Audit Committee Matters” in the Registrant’s
 
Proxy Statement relating to
its Annual Meeting of Shareowners to be held April 27,
 
2021.
 
 
 
 
120
PART
 
IV
 
 
Item 15.
 
Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
 
 
The following documents are filed as part of this report
 
 
1. Financial Statements
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting
 
Firm
 
Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition at the End
 
of Fiscal Years
 
2020 and 2019
 
Consolidated Statements of Income for Fiscal Years
 
2020, 2019, and 2018
 
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for
 
Fiscal Years
 
2020, 2019, and 2018
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareowners’
 
Equity for Fiscal Years
 
2020, 2019, and 2018
 
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for Fiscal Years
 
2020, 2019, and 2018
 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
 
2. Financial Statement Schedules
 
Other schedules and exhibits are omitted because the required
 
information either is not applicable or is shown in the
financial statements or the notes thereto.
 
3. Exhibits Required to
 
be Filed by Item 601 of Regulation S-K
 
Reg. S-K
Exhibit
 
Table
Item No.
 
Description of Exhibit
 
3.1
 
 
3.2
 
 
4.1
 
See Exhibits 3.1 and 3.2 for provisions of Amended and
 
Restated Articles of Incorporation and
Amended and Restated Bylaws, which define the rights
 
of the Registrant’s shareowners.
4.2
 
 
4.3
 
 
4.4
 
 
 
4.5
 
In accordance with Regulation S-K, Item 601(b)(4)(iii)(A)
 
certain instruments defining the rights of
holders of long-term debt of Capital City Bank Group,
 
Inc. not exceeding 10% of the total assets of
Capital City Bank Group, Inc. and its consolidated
 
subsidiaries have been omitted; the Registrant
agrees to furnish a copy of any such instruments to the
 
Commission upon request.
10.1
 
 
10.2
 
 
10.3
 
 
10.6
 
 
10.7
 
 
 
121
10.8
 
 
 
11
 
 
14
 
 
 
21
**
23.1
**
31.1
 
**
31.2
 
**
32.1
 
**
32.2
 
**
101.SCH
 
XBRL Taxonomy
 
Extension Schema Document**
101.CAL
 
XBRL Taxonomy
 
Extension Calculation Linkbase Document**
101.LAB
 
XBRL Taxonomy
 
Extension Label Linkbase Document**
101.PRE
 
XBRL Taxonomy
 
Extension Presentation Linkbase Document**
101.DEF
 
XBRL Taxonomy
 
Extension Definition Linkbase Document**
 
*
Information required to be presented in Exhibit 11
 
is provided in Note 14 to the consolidated financial statements under
Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K in accordance with
 
the provisions of U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
**
Filed electronically herewith.
 
 
 
 
Item 16.
 
Form 10-K Summary
 
None.
 
 
 
 
 
 
122
Signatures
 
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the
 
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused
 
this
report to be signed on March 1, 2021, on its behalf
 
by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
CAPITAL CITY BANK
 
GROUP,
 
INC.
 
 
/s/ William G. Smith, Jr.
 
William G. Smith, Jr.
Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange
 
Act of 1934, this report has been signed on March 1, 2021 by
 
the
following persons in the capacities indicated.
 
 
/s/ William G. Smith, Jr.
 
William G. Smith, Jr.
Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
 
/s/ J. Kimbrough Davis
 
J. Kimbrough Davis
Executive Vice President
 
and Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
123
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the
 
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused
 
this
report to be signed on March 1, 2021, on its behalf
 
by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
Directors:
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Robert Antoine
 
/s/ Marshall M. Criser III
 
Robert Antoine
 
 
Marshall M. Criser III
 
 
/s/ Thomas A. Barron
 
/s/ J. Everitt Drew
 
Thomas A. Barron
 
 
J. Everitt Drew
 
 
 
/s/ Allan G. Bense
 
/s/ Eric Grant
 
Allan G. Bense
 
Eric Grant
 
 
/s/ Frederick Carroll III
 
/s/ Laura Johnson
 
Frederick Carroll III
 
 
Laura Johnson
/s/ Stanley W.
 
Connally, Jr.
/s/ John G. Sample, Jr
 
Stanley W.
 
Connally, Jr
 
John G. Sample, Jr
/s/ Cader B. Cox, III
/s/ William G. Smith, Jr.
 
Cader B. Cox, III
 
William G. Smith, Jr.